AV
AV
AV
AV-1
DRIVER INFORMATION & MULTIMEDIA
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
SECTION AV
A
O
P
CONTENTS
AUDIO, VISUAL & NAVIGATION SYSTEM
BASE AUDIO
PRECAUTION ........................................... ...12
PRECAUTIONS .............................................. ....12
Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System
(SRS) "AIR BAG" and "SEAT BELT PRE-TEN-
SIONER" ............................................................. .... 12
Precaution for Trouble Diagnosis ............................ 12
Precaution for Harness Repair ............................ .... 12
Precaution for Work ............................................ .... 13
PREPARATION ........................................ ...14
PREPARATION .............................................. ....14
Special Service Tool ............................................... 14
Commercial Service Tools ...................................... 14
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION .......................... ...15
COMPONENT PARTS ................................... ....15
Component Parts Location ...................................... 15
Component Description ........................................... 15
SYSTEM ......................................................... ....17
AUDIO SYSTEM .................................................... .... 17
AUDIO SYSTEM : System Diagram ................... .... 17
AUDIO SYSTEM : System Description ............... .... 17
ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION ........... ...18
AUDIO UNIT ................................................... ....18
Reference Value ..................................................... 18
DISPLAY UNIT ............................................... ....20
Reference Value ..................................................... 20
WIRING DIAGRAM ................................... ...21
BASE AUDIO ................................................. ....21
Wiring Diagram ....................................................... 21
BASIC INSPECTION ................................ ...31
DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORKFLOW ........31
Work Flow ............................................................ ....31
DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS ...................... ...33
POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT ....33
AUDIO UNIT ........................................................... ....33
AUDIO UNIT : Diagnosis Procedure ................... ....33
DISPLAY UNIT ....................................................... ....33
DISPLAY UNIT : Diagnosis Procedure ....................33
FRONT DOOR SPEAKER ................................35
Diagnosis Procedure ...............................................35
INSTRUMENT PANEL SPEAKER/TWEETER ...37
Diagnosis Procedure ...............................................37
REAR DOOR SPEAKER ..................................39
Diagnosis Procedure ...............................................39
STEERING SWITCH .........................................41
Diagnosis Procedure ...............................................41
SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS ........................... ...43
AUDIO SYSTEM ...............................................43
Symptom Table .......................................................43
NORMAL OPERATING CONDITION ...............45
Description ........................................................... ....45
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION ............ ...46
AUDIO UNIT ......................................................46
Exploded View .........................................................46
Removal and Installation ..................................... ....46
STEERING SWITCH .........................................48
Exploded View .........................................................48
Removal and Installation ..................................... ....48
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-2
DISPLAY UNIT ............................................... ... 49
Exploded View ..................................................... ... 49
Removal and Installation ..................................... ... 49
FRONT DOOR SPEAKER .............................. ... 50
Exploded View ..................................................... ... 50
Removal and Installation ..................................... ... 50
INSTRUMENT PANEL SPEAKER/TWEETER ... 51
Removal and Installation ..................................... ... 51
REAR DOOR SPEAKER ................................ ... 52
Exploded View ..................................................... ... 52
Removal and Installation ..................................... ... 52
AUDIO ANTENNA .......................................... ... 53
Location of Antennas .............................................. 53
Window Antenna Repair ......................................... 53
MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE
PRECAUTION .......................................... ... 55
PRECAUTIONS .............................................. ... 55
Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System
(SRS) "AIR BAG" and "SEAT BELT PRE-TEN-
SIONER" .............................................................. ... 55
Cautions in Removing Battery Terminal and AV
Control Unit (Models with AV Control Unit) ............. 55
Precaution for Trouble Diagnosis ........................ ... 55
Precaution for Harness Repair ............................... 55
Precaution for Work ............................................. ... 56
PREPARATION ........................................ ... 57
PREPARATION .............................................. ... 57
Special Service Tool ............................................... 57
Commercial Service Tools ................................... ... 57
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION ......................... ... 58
COMPONENT PARTS .................................... ... 58
Component Parts Location ..................................... 58
Component Description .......................................... 59
SYSTEM .......................................................... ... 60
MULTI AV SYSTEM ............................................... ... 60
MULTI AV SYSTEM : System Diagram .................. 60
MULTI AV SYSTEM : System Description ............. 60
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (AV CONTROL UNIT) ... 63
Description ........................................................... ... 63
On Board Diagnosis Function ................................. 63
CONSULT Function ................................................ 70
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (BLUETOOTH CON-
TROL UNIT) .................................................... ... 72
Diagnosis Description ............................................. 72
Work Flow ............................................................ ... 72
ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION .............. 73
AV CONTROL UNIT ....................................... ... 73
Reference Value ..................................................... 73
DTC Index ............................................................ ... 79
DISPLAY UNIT ............................................... ... 81
Reference Value ..................................................... 81
SATELLITE RADIO TUNER ........................... ... 84
Reference Value ..................................................... 84
BLUETOOTH CONTROL UNIT ................... ... 86
Reference Value ..................................................... 86
WIRING DIAGRAM .................................... 88
MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE ........................ ... 88
Wiring Diagram ....................................................... 88
BASIC INSPECTION ................................. 114
DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORKFLOW ...... ..114
Work Flow ............................................................ . 114
INSPECTION AND ADJUSTMENT ................ ..116
ADDITIONAL SERVICE WHEN REPLACING AV
CONTROL UNIT ..................................................... . 116
ADDITIONAL SERVICE WHEN REPLACING AV
CONTROL UNIT : Description .............................. 116
ADDITIONAL SERVICE WHEN REPLACING AV
CONTROL UNIT : Work Procedure ..................... . 116
CONFIGURATION (AV CONTROL UNIT) .............. 116
CONFIGURATION (AV CONTROL UNIT) : De-
scription ................................................................ . 117
CONFIGURATION (AV CONTROL UNIT) : Work
Procedure ............................................................ . 117
CONFIGURATION (AV CONTROL UNIT) : Con-
figuration List ........................................................ . 118
DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS ....................... 119
U1000 CAN COMM CIRCUIT ......................... ..119
DTC Logic ............................................................ . 119
Diagnosis Procedure ............................................ 119
U1010 CONTROL UNIT (CAN) ...................... ..120
DTC Logic ............................................................ . 120
U1200 AV CONTROL UNIT ........................... ..121
DTC Logic ............................................................ . 121
U1216 AV CONTROL UNIT ........................... ..122
DTC Logic ............................................................ . 122
U1218 AV CONTROL UNIT ........................... ..123
DTC Logic ............................................................ . 123
U1219 AV CONTROL UNIT ........................... ..124
DTC Logic ............................................................ . 124
U121A AV CONTROL UNIT ........................... ..125
DTC Logic ............................................................ . 125
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
AV-3
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
U121B AV CONTROL UNIT ........................... .. 126
DTC Logic ........................................................... .. 126
U121C AV CONTROL UNIT ........................... .. 127
DTC Logic ........................................................... .. 127
U121D AV CONTROL UNIT ........................... .. 128
DTC Logic ........................................................... .. 128
Diagnosis Procedure ............................................. 128
U121E AV CONTROL UNIT ........................... .. 129
DTC Logic ........................................................... .. 129
Diagnosis Procedure ............................................. 129
U1225 AV CONTROL UNIT ........................... .. 130
DTC Logic ........................................................... .. 130
U1227 AV CONTROL UNIT ........................... .. 131
DTC Logic ........................................................... .. 131
Diagnosis Procedure ............................................. 131
U1228 AV CONTROL UNIT ........................... .. 132
DTC Logic ........................................................... .. 132
U1229 AV CONTROL UNIT ........................... .. 133
DTC Logic ........................................................... .. 133
U122A AV CONTROL UNIT ........................... .. 134
DTC Logic ........................................................... .. 134
Diagnosis Procedure ............................................. 134
U122E AV CONTROL UNIT ........................... .. 135
DTC Logic ........................................................... .. 135
U1243 DISPLAY UNIT ................................... .. 136
DTC Logic ........................................................... .. 136
Diagnosis Procedure ............................................. 136
U1255 SATELLITE RADIO TUNER ............... .. 138
DTC Logic ........................................................... .. 138
Diagnosis Procedure ............................................. 138
U1263 USB ..................................................... .. 140
DTC Logic ........................................................... .. 140
Diagnosis Procedure ............................................. 140
U1264 ANTENNA AMP. ................................. .. 141
DTC Logic ........................................................... .. 141
Diagnosis Procedure ............................................. 141
U1300 AV COMM CIRCUIT ........................... .. 142
Description .......................................................... .. 142
U1310 AV CONTROL UNIT ........................... .. 143
DTC Logic ........................................................... .. 143
POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT .... 144
AV CONTROL UNIT .............................................. .. 144
AV CONTROL UNIT : Diagnosis Procedure ......... 144
DISPLAY UNIT ...................................................... .. 144
DISPLAY UNIT : Diagnosis Procedure ................. 144
SATELLITE RADIO TUNER ....................................146
SATELLITE RADIO TUNER : Diagnosis Proce-
dure ..................................................................... ..146
BLUETOOTH CONTROL UNIT .......................... ..147
BLUETOOTH CONTROL UNIT : Diagnosis Pro-
cedure .................................................................. ..147
A/C AND AV SWITCH ASSEMBLY ........................148
A/C AND AV SWITCH ASSEMBLY : Diagnosis
Procedure ............................................................ ..148
FRONT DOOR SPEAKER .............................. 149
Diagnosis Procedure .............................................149
INSTRUMENT PANEL SPEAKER/TWEETER . 151
Diagnosis Procedure .............................................151
REAR DOOR SPEAKER ................................ 153
Diagnosis Procedure .............................................153
FRONT AUXILIARY INPUT JACK AUDIO
SIGNAL CIRCUIT ............................................ 155
Diagnosis Procedure .............................................155
SATELLITE AUDIO SIGNAL CIRCUIT .......... 157
Diagnosis Procedure .............................................157
BLUETOOTH VOICE SIGNAL CIRCUIT ..... 159
Diagnosis Procedure .............................................159
RGB (R: RED) SIGNAL CIRCUIT ................... 161
Diagnosis Procedure .............................................161
RGB (G: GREEN) SIGNAL CIRCUIT ............. 162
Diagnosis Procedure .............................................162
RGB (B: BLUE) SIGNAL CIRCUIT ................. 163
Diagnosis Procedure .............................................163
RGB SYNCHRONIZING SIGNAL CIRCUIT ... 164
Diagnosis Procedure .............................................164
RGB AREA (YS) SIGNAL CIRCUIT ............... 165
Diagnosis Procedure .............................................165
HORIZONTAL SYNCHRONIZING (HP) SIG-
NAL CIRCUIT .................................................. 166
Diagnosis Procedure .............................................166
VERTICAL SYNCHRONIZING (VP) SIGNAL
CIRCUIT .......................................................... 167
Diagnosis Procedure .............................................167
COMPOSITE IMAGE SIGNAL CIRCUIT ........ 168
Diagnosis Procedure .............................................168
AUX IMAGE SIGNAL CIRCUIT ...................... 170
Diagnosis Procedure .............................................170
CAMERA IMAGE SIGNAL CIRCUIT .............. 172
Diagnosis Procedure .............................................172
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-4
DISK EJECT SIGNAL CIRCUIT ..................... . 174
Diagnosis Procedure .............................................174
MICROPHONE SIGNAL CIRCUIT ................. . 175
Diagnosis Procedure .............................................175
BLUETOOTH CONTROL SIGNAL CIRCUIT . 177
Diagnosis Procedure .............................................177
STEERING SWITCH ....................................... . 178
Diagnosis Procedure .............................................178
USB CONNECTOR ......................................... . 180
Diagnosis Procedure .............................................180
SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS .......................... ..181
MULTI AV SYSTEM ........................................ . 181
Symptom Table ................................................... ..181
NORMAL OPERATING CONDITION ............. . 185
Description ........................................................... ..185
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION ............ ..187
AV CONTROL UNIT ....................................... . 187
Exploded View ..................................................... ..187
Removal and Installation ..................................... ..187
A/C AND AV SWITCH ASSEMBLY ............... . 189
Removal and Installation ..................................... ..189
STEERING SWITCH ....................................... . 190
Exploded View ..................................................... ..190
Removal and Installation ..................................... ..190
DISPLAY UNIT ............................................... . 191
Exploded View ..................................................... ..191
Removal and Installation ..................................... ..191
FRONT DOOR SPEAKER .............................. . 192
Exploded View ..................................................... ..192
Removal and Installation ..................................... ..192
INSTRUMENT PANEL SPEAKER/TWEETER . 193
Removal and Installation ..................................... ..193
REAR DOOR SPEAKER ................................ . 194
Exploded View ..................................................... ..194
Removal and Installation ..................................... ..194
USB INTERFACE ........................................... . 195
Removal and Installation ..................................... ..195
FRONT AUXILIARY INPUT JACKS ............... . 196
Removal and Installation ..................................... ..196
BLUETOOTH CONTROL UNIT ...................... . 197
Exploded View ..................................................... ..197
Removal and Installation ..................................... ..197
MICROPHONE ................................................ . 198
Removal and Installation ..................................... ..198
SATELLITE RADIO TUNER ........................... ..199
Exploded View ...................................................... 199
Removal and Installation ...................................... . 199
REAR VIEW CAMERA ................................... ..200
Removal and Installation ...................................... . 200
AUDIO ANTENNA .......................................... ..201
Location of Antennas ............................................ 201
Window Antenna Repair ....................................... 201
BLUETOOTH ANTENNA ............................. ..203
Removal and Installation ...................................... . 203
SATELLITE RADIO ANTENNA ..................... ..204
Removal and Installation ...................................... . 204
Disassembly and Assembly .................................. 204
MID AUDIO WITH BOSE
PRECAUTION ........................................... 205
PRECAUTIONS .............................................. ..205
Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System
(SRS) "AIR BAG" and "SEAT BELT PRE-TEN-
SIONER" .............................................................. . 205
Cautions in Removing Battery Terminal and AV
Control Unit (Models with AV Control Unit) ........... 205
Precaution for Trouble Diagnosis ......................... . 205
Precaution for Harness Repair ............................. . 205
Precaution for Work ............................................. . 206
PREPARATION ......................................... 207
PREPARATION .............................................. ..207
Special Service Tool ............................................. 207
Commercial Service Tools .................................... 207
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION .......................... 208
COMPONENT PARTS .................................... ..208
Component Parts Location ................................... 208
Component Description ........................................ 209
SYSTEM ......................................................... ..211
MULTI AV SYSTEM ................................................ 211
MULTI AV SYSTEM : System Diagram ............... . 211
MULTI AV SYSTEM : System Description ........... . 211
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (AV CONTROL UNIT) ..214
Description ........................................................... . 214
On Board Diagnosis Function .............................. . 214
CONSULT Function .............................................. 221
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (BLUETOOTH CON-
TROL UNIT) .................................................... ..223
Diagnosis Description ........................................... 223
Work Flow ............................................................ . 223
ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION ............ 224
AV CONTROL UNIT ....................................... ..224
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
AV-5
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
Reference Value ................................................... 224
DTC Index ........................................................... .. 230
DISPLAY UNIT ............................................... .. 232
Reference Value ................................................... 232
BOSE AMP. .................................................... .. 235
Reference Value ................................................... 235
SATELLITE RADIO TUNER ............................ 238
Reference Value ................................................... 238
BLUETOOTH CONTROL UNIT ................... .. 240
Reference Value ................................................... 240
WIRING DIAGRAM ................................... . 242
MID AUDIO WITH BOSE ............................... .. 242
Wiring Diagram ..................................................... 242
BASIC INSPECTION ................................ . 273
DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORKFLOW ..... .. 273
Work Flow ........................................................... .. 273
INSPECTION AND ADJUSTMENT ................ .. 275
ADDITIONAL SERVICE WHEN REPLACING AV
CONTROL UNIT .................................................... .. 275
ADDITIONAL SERVICE WHEN REPLACING AV
CONTROL UNIT : Description ............................ .. 275
ADDITIONAL SERVICE WHEN REPLACING AV
CONTROL UNIT : Work Procedure .................... .. 275
CONFIGURATION (AV CONTROL UNIT) ............ .. 275
CONFIGURATION (AV CONTROL UNIT) : De-
scription ............................................................... .. 276
CONFIGURATION (AV CONTROL UNIT) : Work
Procedure ............................................................ .. 276
CONFIGURATION (AV CONTROL UNIT) : Con-
figuration List ....................................................... .. 277
DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS ...................... . 278
U1000 CAN COMM CIRCUIT ......................... .. 278
DTC Logic ........................................................... .. 278
Diagnosis Procedure ............................................ 278
U1010 CONTROL UNIT (CAN) ...................... .. 279
DTC Logic ........................................................... .. 279
U1200 AV CONTROL UNIT ........................... .. 280
DTC Logic ........................................................... .. 280
U1216 AV CONTROL UNIT ........................... .. 281
DTC Logic ........................................................... .. 281
U1218 AV CONTROL UNIT ........................... .. 282
DTC Logic ........................................................... .. 282
U1219 AV CONTROL UNIT ........................... .. 283
DTC Logic ........................................................... .. 283
U121A AV CONTROL UNIT ........................... 284
DTC Logic ............................................................ ..284
U121B AV CONTROL UNIT ........................... 285
DTC Logic ............................................................ ..285
U121C AV CONTROL UNIT ........................... 286
DTC Logic ............................................................ ..286
U121D AV CONTROL UNIT ........................... 287
DTC Logic ............................................................ ..287
Diagnosis Procedure .............................................287
U121E AV CONTROL UNIT ............................ 288
DTC Logic ............................................................ ..288
Diagnosis Procedure .............................................288
U1225 AV CONTROL UNIT ............................ 289
DTC Logic ............................................................ ..289
U1227 AV CONTROL UNIT ............................ 290
DTC Logic ............................................................ ..290
Diagnosis Procedure .............................................290
U1228 AV CONTROL UNIT ............................ 291
DTC Logic ............................................................ ..291
U1229 AV CONTROL UNIT ............................ 292
DTC Logic ............................................................ ..292
U122A AV CONTROL UNIT ........................... 293
DTC Logic ............................................................ ..293
Diagnosis Procedure .............................................293
U122E AV CONTROL UNIT ............................ 294
DTC Logic ............................................................ ..294
U1231 BOSE AMP. ......................................... 295
DTC Logic ............................................................ ..295
U1243 DISPLAY UNIT .................................... 296
DTC Logic ............................................................ ..296
Diagnosis Procedure .............................................296
U1255 SATELLITE RADIO TUNER ................ 298
DTC Logic ............................................................ ..298
Diagnosis Procedure .............................................298
U1263 USB ...................................................... 300
DTC Logic ............................................................ ..300
Diagnosis Procedure .............................................300
U1264 ANTENNA AMP. .................................. 301
DTC Logic ............................................................ ..301
Diagnosis Procedure .............................................301
U1265 BOSE AMP. ......................................... 302
DTC Logic ............................................................ ..302
Diagnosis Procedure .............................................302
U1300 AV COMM CIRCUIT ............................ 303
Description ........................................................... ..303
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-6
U1310 AV CONTROL UNIT ............................ . 304
DTC Logic ............................................................ ..304
POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT ... 305
AV CONTROL UNIT ............................................... ..305
AV CONTROL UNIT : Diagnosis Procedure ..........305
DISPLAY UNIT ....................................................... ..305
DISPLAY UNIT : Diagnosis Procedure ..................305
BOSE AMP. ............................................................ ..307
BOSE AMP. : Diagnosis Procedure ......................307
SUBWOOFER ........................................................ ..308
SUBWOOFER : Diagnosis Procedure ................. ..308
SATELLITE RADIO TUNER ....................................308
SATELLITE RADIO TUNER : Diagnosis Proce-
dure ..................................................................... ..308
BLUETOOTH CONTROL UNIT ........................... ..309
BLUETOOTH CONTROL UNIT : Diagnosis Pro-
cedure .................................................................. ..309
A/C AND AV SWITCH ASSEMBLY ....................... ..310
A/C AND AV SWITCH ASSEMBLY : Diagnosis
Procedure ............................................................ ..310
CENTER SPEAKER ....................................... . 312
Diagnosis Procedure .............................................312
INSTRUMENT PANEL SPEAKER/TWEETER . 314
Diagnosis Procedure .............................................314
FRONT TWEETER ......................................... . 317
Diagnosis Procedure .............................................317
FRONT DOOR SPEAKER .............................. . 320
Diagnosis Procedure .............................................320
REAR DOOR SPEAKER ................................ . 323
Diagnosis Procedure .............................................323
REAR SPEAKER ............................................ . 326
Diagnosis Procedure .............................................326
SUBWOOFER ................................................. . 329
Diagnosis Procedure .............................................329
FRONT AUXILIARY INPUT JACK AUDIO
SIGNAL CIRCUIT ........................................... . 332
Diagnosis Procedure .............................................332
SATELLITE AUDIO SIGNAL CIRCUIT .......... . 334
Diagnosis Procedure .............................................334
BLUETOOTH VOICE SIGNAL CIRCUIT ..... . 336
Diagnosis Procedure .............................................336
RGB (R: RED) SIGNAL CIRCUIT .................. . 338
Diagnosis Procedure .............................................338
RGB (G: GREEN) SIGNAL CIRCUIT ............. . 339
Diagnosis Procedure ............................................. 339
RGB (B: BLUE) SIGNAL CIRCUIT ................ ..340
Diagnosis Procedure ............................................. 340
RGB SYNCHRONIZING SIGNAL CIRCUIT ... ..341
Diagnosis Procedure ............................................. 341
RGB AREA (YS) SIGNAL CIRCUIT ............... ..342
Diagnosis Procedure ............................................. 342
HORIZONTAL SYNCHRONIZING (HP) SIG-
NAL CIRCUIT ................................................. ..343
Diagnosis Procedure ............................................. 343
VERTICAL SYNCHRONIZING (VP) SIGNAL
CIRCUIT .......................................................... ..344
Diagnosis Procedure ............................................. 344
COMPOSITE IMAGE SIGNAL CIRCUIT ........ ..345
Diagnosis Procedure ............................................. 345
AUX IMAGE SIGNAL CIRCUIT ...................... ..347
Diagnosis Procedure ............................................. 347
CAMERA IMAGE SIGNAL CIRCUIT ............. ..349
Diagnosis Procedure ............................................. 349
DISK EJECT SIGNAL CIRCUIT ..................... ..351
Diagnosis Procedure ............................................. 351
MICROPHONE SIGNAL CIRCUIT ................. ..352
Diagnosis Procedure ............................................. 352
BLUETOOTH CONTROL SIGNAL CIRCUIT ..354
Diagnosis Procedure ............................................. 354
STEERING SWITCH ....................................... ..355
Diagnosis Procedure ............................................. 355
USB CONNECTOR ........................................ ..357
Diagnosis Procedure ............................................. 357
SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS ........................... 358
MULTI AV SYSTEM ....................................... ..358
Symptom Table .................................................... . 358
NORMAL OPERATING CONDITION ............. ..363
Description ........................................................... . 363
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION ............. 365
AV CONTROL UNIT ....................................... ..365
Exploded View ...................................................... 365
Removal and Installation ...................................... . 365
A/C AND AV SWITCH ASSEMBLY ............... ..367
Removal and Installation ...................................... . 367
STEERING SWITCH ....................................... ..368
Exploded View ...................................................... 368
Removal and Installation ...................................... . 368
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
AV-7
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
DISPLAY UNIT ............................................... .. 369
Exploded View ...................................................... 369
Removal and Installation ..................................... .. 369
HEADREST DISPLAY UNIT ............................ 370
Removal and Installation ..................................... .. 370
BOSE SPEAKER AMP .................................. .. 372
Removal and Installation ..................................... .. 372
FRONT DOOR SPEAKER ............................. .. 373
Exploded View ...................................................... 373
Removal and Installation ..................................... .. 373
FRONT TWEETER ......................................... .. 374
Removal and Installation ..................................... .. 374
INSTRUMENT PANEL SPEAKER/TWEETER .. 375
Removal and Installation ..................................... .. 375
CENTER SPEAKER ....................................... .. 376
Removal and Installation ..................................... .. 376
REAR DOOR SPEAKER ................................ .. 377
Exploded View ...................................................... 377
Removal and Installation ..................................... .. 377
REAR SPEAKERS ......................................... .. 378
Removal and Installation ..................................... .. 378
SUBWOOFER ................................................ .. 379
Exploded View ...................................................... 379
Removal and Installation ..................................... .. 379
USB INTERFACE ........................................... .. 380
Removal and Installation ..................................... .. 380
FRONT AUXILIARY INPUT JACKS .............. .. 381
Removal and Installation ..................................... .. 381
BLUETOOTH CONTROL UNIT ..................... .. 382
Exploded View ...................................................... 382
Removal and Installation ..................................... .. 382
MICROPHONE ............................................... .. 383
Removal and Installation ..................................... .. 383
SATELLITE RADIO TUNER ............................ 384
Exploded View ...................................................... 384
Removal and Installation ..................................... .. 384
REAR VIEW CAMERA ................................... .. 385
Removal and Installation ..................................... .. 385
AUDIO ANTENNA .......................................... .. 386
Location of Antennas ............................................ 386
Window Antenna Repair ..................................... .. 386
BLUETOOTH ANTENNA ............................ .. 388
Removal and Installation ..................................... .. 388
SATELLITE RADIO ANTENNA ....................... 389
Removal and Installation ..................................... .. 389
Disassembly and Assembly ...................................389
PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION
PRECAUTION ........................................... . 390
PRECAUTIONS ............................................... 390
Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System
(SRS) "AIR BAG" and "SEAT BELT PRE-TEN-
SIONER" ............................................................. ..390
Cautions in Removing Battery Terminal and AV
Control Unit (Models with AV Control Unit) ...........390
Precaution for Trouble Diagnosis ..........................390
Precaution for Harness Repair ............................ ..390
Precaution for Work ............................................. ..391
PREPARATION ........................................ . 392
PREPARATION ............................................... 392
Special Service Tool ..............................................392
Commercial Service Tools .....................................392
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION .......................... . 393
COMPONENT PARTS .................................... 393
Component Parts Location ....................................393
Component Description .........................................395
SYSTEM .......................................................... 397
MULTI AV SYSTEM ............................................... ..397
MULTI AV SYSTEM : System Diagram ............... ..397
MULTI AV SYSTEM : System Description .......... ..397
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (AV CONTROL UNIT) . 403
Description ........................................................... ..403
On Board Diagnosis Function ................................403
CONSULT Function ...............................................413
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (AROUND VIEW MON-
ITOR CONTROL UNIT) ................................... 415
CONSULT Function ...............................................415
ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION ........... . 417
AV CONTROL UNIT ........................................ 417
Reference Value ....................................................417
Fail-Safe .............................................................. ..422
DTC Index ........................................................... ..423
DISPLAY UNIT ................................................ 426
Reference Value ....................................................426
BOSE AMP. ..................................................... 428
Reference Value ....................................................428
VIDEO DISTRIBUTOR .................................... 431
Reference Value ....................................................431
HEADREST DISPLAY UNIT ........................... 435
Reference Value ....................................................435
AROUND VIEW MONITOR CONTROL UNIT . 439
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-8
Reference Value .................................................. ..439
DTC Index ........................................................... ..441
WIRING DIAGRAM .................................. ..442
PREMIUM AUDIO SYSTEM ........................... . 442
Wiring Diagram .................................................... ..442
BASIC INSPECTION ................................ ..487
DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORKFLOW ...... . 487
Work Flow ............................................................ ..487
INSPECTION AND ADJUSTMENT ................ . 489
ADDITIONAL SERVICE WHEN REPLACING AV
CONTROL UNIT ..................................................... ..489
ADDITIONAL SERVICE WHEN REPLACING AV
CONTROL UNIT : Description ...............................489
ADDITIONAL SERVICE WHEN REPLACING AV
CONTROL UNIT : Work Procedure ..................... ..489
CONFIGURATION (AV CONTROL UNIT) ...............489
CONFIGURATION (AV CONTROL UNIT) : De-
scription ............................................................... ..490
CONFIGURATION (AV CONTROL UNIT) : Work
Procedure ............................................................ ..490
CONFIGURATION (AV CONTROL UNIT) : Con-
figuration List ....................................................... ..491
ADDITIONAL SERVICE WHEN REPLACING
AROUND VIEW MONITOR CONTROL UNIT ........ ..491
ADDITIONAL SERVICE WHEN REPLACING
AROUND VIEW MONITOR CONTROL UNIT :
Description ........................................................... ..491
ADDITIONAL SERVICE WHEN REPLACING
AROUND VIEW MONITOR CONTROL UNIT :
Work Procedure ................................................... ..491
CONFIGURATION (AROUND VIEW MONITOR
CONTROL UNIT) ................................................... ..492
CONFIGURATION (AROUND VIEW MONITOR
CONTROL UNIT) : Description ..............................492
CONFIGURATION (AROUND VIEW MONITOR
CONTROL UNIT) : Work Procedure ......................492
CONFIGURATION (AROUND VIEW MONITOR
CONTROL UNIT) : Configuration List ....................493
PREDICTED COURSE LINE CENTER POSITION
ADJUSTMENT ....................................................... ..493
PREDICTED COURSE LINE CENTER POSI-
TION ADJUSTMENT : Description ........................493
PREDICTED COURSE LINE CENTER POSI-
TION ADJUSTMENT : Work Procedure ................493
CALIBRATING CAMERA IMAGE (AROUND VIEW
MONITOR) .............................................................. ..493
CALIBRATING CAMERA IMAGE (AROUND
VIEW MONITOR) : Description .............................493
CALIBRATING CAMERA IMAGE (AROUND
VIEW MONITOR) : Work Procedure .....................494
DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS ....................... 499
U1000 CAN COMM CIRCUIT ......................... ..499
DTC Logic ............................................................ . 499
Diagnosis Procedure ............................................ 499
U1010 CONTROL UNIT (CAN) ...................... ..500
DTC Logic ............................................................ . 500
U1200 AV CONTROL UNIT ........................... ..501
DTC Logic ............................................................ . 501
U1201 AV CONTROL UNIT ........................... ..502
DTC Logic ............................................................ . 502
U1202 AV CONTROL UNIT ........................... ..503
DTC Logic ............................................................ . 503
U1204 AV CONTROL UNIT ........................... ..504
DTC Logic ............................................................ . 504
Diagnosis Procedure ............................................. 504
U1205 AV CONTROL UNIT ........................... ..505
DTC Logic ............................................................ . 505
Diagnosis Procedure ............................................. 505
U1206 AV CONTROL UNIT ........................... ..506
DTC Logic ............................................................ . 506
Diagnosis Procedure ............................................. 506
U1207 AV CONTROL UNIT ........................... ..507
DTC Logic ............................................................ . 507
Diagnosis Procedure ............................................. 507
U1216 AV CONTROL UNIT ........................... ..508
DTC Logic ............................................................ . 508
U1217 AV CONTROL UNIT ........................... ..509
DTC Logic ............................................................ . 509
U1218 AV CONTROL UNIT ........................... ..510
DTC Logic ............................................................ . 510
U1219 AV CONTROL UNIT ........................... ..511
DTC Logic ............................................................ . 511
U121A AV CONTROL UNIT ........................... ..512
DTC Logic ............................................................ . 512
U121B AV CONTROL UNIT ........................... ..513
DTC Logic ............................................................ . 513
U121C AV CONTROL UNIT ........................... ..514
DTC Logic ............................................................ . 514
U121D AV CONTROL UNIT ........................... ..515
DTC Logic ............................................................ . 515
Diagnosis Procedure ............................................. 515
U121E AV CONTROL UNIT ........................... ..516
DTC Logic ............................................................ . 516
Diagnosis Procedure ............................................. 516
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
AV-9
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
U1225 AV CONTROL UNIT ........................... .. 517
DTC Logic ........................................................... .. 517
U1227 AV CONTROL UNIT ........................... .. 518
DTC Logic ........................................................... .. 518
Diagnosis Procedure ............................................. 518
U1228 AV CONTROL UNIT ........................... .. 519
DTC Logic ........................................................... .. 519
U1229 AV CONTROL UNIT ........................... .. 520
DTC Logic ........................................................... .. 520
U122A AV CONTROL UNIT ........................... .. 521
DTC Logic ........................................................... .. 521
Diagnosis Procedure ............................................. 521
U122E AV CONTROL UNIT ........................... .. 522
DTC Logic ........................................................... .. 522
U1231 BOSE AMP. ........................................ .. 523
DTC Logic ........................................................... .. 523
U1232 STEERING ANGLE SENSOR ............ .. 524
DTC Logic ........................................................... .. 524
Diagnosis Procedure ............................................. 524
U1243 DISPLAY UNIT ................................... .. 525
DTC Logic ........................................................... .. 525
Diagnosis Procedure ............................................. 525
U1244 GPS ANTENNA .................................. .. 527
DTC Logic ........................................................... .. 527
Diagnosis Procedure ............................................. 527
U1258 SATELLITE RADIO ANTENNA .......... .. 528
DTC Logic ........................................................... .. 528
Diagnosis Procedure ............................................. 528
U125A HEADREST DISPLAY UNIT .............. .. 529
DTC Logic ........................................................... .. 529
Diagnosis Procedure ............................................. 529
U1263 USB ..................................................... .. 530
DTC Logic ........................................................... .. 530
Diagnosis Procedure ............................................. 530
U1264 ANTENNA AMP. ................................. .. 531
DTC Logic ........................................................... .. 531
Diagnosis Procedure ............................................. 531
U1265 BOSE AMP. ........................................ .. 532
DTC Logic ........................................................... .. 532
Diagnosis Procedure ............................................. 532
U1300 AV COMM CIRCUIT ........................... .. 533
Description .......................................................... .. 533
U1302 CAMERA POWER VOLT ................... .. 534
DTC Logic ........................................................... .. 534
Diagnosis Procedure ............................................. 534
U1303 LED POWER SUPPLY VOLT ............. .. 538
DTC Logic ............................................................ ..538
Diagnosis Procedure .............................................538
U1304 CAMERA IMAGE CALIBRATION ....... 540
DTC Logic ............................................................ ..540
U1305 CONFIG UNFINISH ............................. 541
DTC Logic ............................................................ ..541
U1310 AV CONTROL UNIT ............................ 542
DTC Logic ............................................................ ..542
U1601, U1603, U1609, U160B FRONT DOOR
SPEAKER/TWEETER ..................................... 543
DTC Logic ............................................................ ..543
Diagnosis Procedure .............................................543
U1627, U162F TWEETER ............................... 544
DTC Logic ............................................................ ..544
Diagnosis Procedure .............................................544
U162A CENTER SPEAKER ........................... 545
DTC Logic ............................................................ ..545
Diagnosis Procedure .............................................545
U1684, U1687, U168C, U168F REAR DOOR
SPEAKER/TWEETER ..................................... 546
DTC Logic ............................................................ ..546
Diagnosis Procedure .............................................546
U175D WOOFER ............................................ 547
DTC Logic ............................................................ ..547
Diagnosis Procedure .............................................547
U176A, U1772 ROOF SPEAKER ................... 548
DTC Logic ............................................................ ..548
Diagnosis Procedure .............................................548
POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT .. 549
AV CONTROL UNIT .............................................. ..549
AV CONTROL UNIT : Diagnosis Procedure .........549
DISPLAY UNIT ....................................................... ..549
DISPLAY UNIT : Diagnosis Procedure ..................549
BOSE AMP. ........................................................... ..550
BOSE AMP. : Diagnosis Procedure .................... ..550
SUBWOOFER ........................................................ ..551
SUBWOOFER : Diagnosis Procedure ...................551
A/C AND AV SWITCH ASSEMBLY ........................552
A/C AND AV SWITCH ASSEMBLY : Diagnosis
Procedure ............................................................ ..552
VIDEO DISTRIBUTOR ........................................... ..553
VIDEO DISTRIBUTOR : Diagnosis Procedure ......553
HEADREST DISPLAY UNIT ....................................553
HEADREST DISPLAY UNIT : Diagnosis Proce-
dure ..................................................................... ..554
AROUND VIEW MONITOR CONTROL UNIT ....... ..554
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-10
AROUND VIEW MONITOR CONTROL UNIT : Di-
agnosis Procedure .................................................554
CENTER SPEAKER ....................................... . 556
Diagnosis Procedure .............................................556
INSTRUMENT PANEL SPEAKER/TWEETER . 558
Diagnosis Procedure .............................................558
FRONT TWEETER ......................................... . 561
Diagnosis Procedure .............................................561
FRONT DOOR SPEAKER .............................. . 564
Diagnosis Procedure .............................................564
REAR DOOR SPEAKER ................................ . 567
Diagnosis Procedure .............................................567
REAR SPEAKER ............................................ . 570
Diagnosis Procedure .............................................570
SUBWOOFER ................................................. . 573
Diagnosis Procedure .............................................573
FRONT AUXILIARY INPUT JACK AUDIO
SIGNAL CIRCUIT ........................................... . 576
Diagnosis Procedure .............................................576
COMPOSITE IMAGE SIGNAL CIRCUIT (AV
CONTROL UNIT TO FRONT DISPLAY UNIT) . 578
Diagnosis Procedure .............................................578
COMPOSITE IMAGE SIGNAL CIRCUIT (AV
CONTROL UNIT TO VIDEO DISTRIBUTOR) . 579
Diagnosis Procedure .............................................579
COMPOSITE IMAGE SIGNAL CIRCUIT (VID-
EO DISTRIBUTOR TO HEADREST DISPLAY
UNIT) ............................................................... . 580
Diagnosis Procedure .............................................580
AUX IMAGE SIGNAL CIRCUIT (FRONT AUX-
ILIARY INPUT JACKS TO AV CONTROL
UNIT) ............................................................... . 581
Diagnosis Procedure .............................................581
IMAGE SWITCH SIGNAL CIRCUIT ............... . 582
Diagnosis Procedure .............................................582
DISK EJECT SIGNAL CIRCUIT ..................... . 583
Diagnosis Procedure .............................................583
MICROPHONE SIGNAL CIRCUIT ................. . 584
Diagnosis Procedure .............................................584
STEERING SWITCH ....................................... . 586
Diagnosis Procedure .............................................586
USB CONNECTOR ......................................... . 588
Diagnosis Procedure .............................................588
FRONT CAMERA IMAGE SIGNAL CIRCUIT . 589
Diagnosis Procedure .............................................589
REAR CAMERA IMAGE SIGNAL CIRCUIT ....590
Diagnosis Procedure ............................................. 590
SIDE CAMERA LH IMAGE SIGNAL CIRCUIT ..593
Diagnosis Procedure ............................................. 593
SIDE CAMERA RH IMAGE SIGNAL CIRCUIT ..594
Diagnosis Procedure ............................................. 594
SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS ........................... 595
MULTI AV SYSTEM ....................................... ..595
Symptom Table .................................................... . 595
NORMAL OPERATING CONDITION ............. ..602
Description ........................................................... . 602
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION ............. 611
AV CONTROL UNIT ....................................... ..611
Exploded View ...................................................... 611
Removal and Installation ...................................... . 611
A/C AND AV SWITCH ASSEMBLY ............... ..613
Removal and Installation ...................................... . 613
STEERING SWITCH ....................................... ..614
Exploded View ...................................................... 614
Removal and Installation ...................................... . 614
DISPLAY UNIT ............................................... ..615
Exploded View ...................................................... 615
Removal and Installation ...................................... . 615
HEADREST DISPLAY UNIT .......................... ..616
Removal and Installation ...................................... . 616
BOSE SPEAKER AMP ................................... ..618
Removal and Installation ...................................... . 618
FRONT DOOR SPEAKER .............................. ..619
Exploded View ...................................................... 619
Removal and Installation ...................................... . 619
FRONT TWEETER ......................................... ..620
Removal and Installation ...................................... . 620
INSTRUMENT PANEL SPEAKER/TWEETER ..621
Removal and Installation ...................................... . 621
CENTER SPEAKER ....................................... ..622
Removal and Installation ...................................... . 622
REAR DOOR SPEAKER ................................ ..623
Exploded View ...................................................... 623
Removal and Installation ...................................... . 623
REAR SPEAKERS ......................................... ..624
Removal and Installation ...................................... . 624
SUBWOOFER ................................................ ..625
Exploded View ...................................................... 625
Removal and Installation ...................................... . 625
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
AV-11
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
USB INTERFACE ........................................... .. 626
Removal and Installation ..................................... .. 626
FRONT AUXILIARY INPUT JACKS .............. .. 627
Removal and Installation ..................................... .. 627
MICROPHONE ............................................... .. 628
Removal and Installation ..................................... .. 628
AROUND VIEW MONITOR CONTROL UNIT .. 629
Exploded View ...................................................... 629
Removal and Installation ..................................... .. 629
FRONT CAMERA ........................................... .. 630
Removal and Installation ..................................... .. 630
REAR VIEW CAMERA ................................... .. 631
Removal and Installation ..................................... .. 631
SIDE CAMERA ................................................ 632
Removal and Installation ..................................... ..632
VIDEO DISTRIBUTOR .................................... 633
Removal and Installation ..................................... ..633
REAR AUXILIARY INPUT JACKS ................. 634
Removal and Installation ..................................... ..634
AUDIO ANTENNA ........................................... 635
Location of Antennas .............................................635
Window Antenna Repair ........................................635
GPS ANTENNA ............................................... 637
Removal and Installation ..................................... ..637
SATELLITE RADIO ANTENNA ...................... 638
Removal and Installation ..................................... ..638
Disassembly and Assembly ...................................638
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-12
< PRECAUTION >
[BASE AUDIO]
PRECAUTIONS
PRECAUTION
PRECAUTIONS
Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) "AIR BAG" and "SEAT BELT
PRE-TENSIONER" INFOID:0000000009174373
The Supplemental Restraint System such as AIR BAG and SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER, used along
with a front seat belt, helps to reduce the risk or severity of injury to the driver and front passenger for certain
types of collision. Information necessary to service the system safely is included in the SR and SB section of
this Service Manual.
WARNING:
To avoid rendering the SRS inoperative, which could increase the risk of personal injury or death in
the event of a collision which would result in air bag inflation, all maintenance must be performed by
an authorized NISSAN/INFINITI dealer.
Improper maintenance, including incorrect removal and installation of the SRS, can lead to personal
injury caused by unintentional activation of the system. For removal of Spiral Cable and Air Bag
Module, see the SR section.
Do not use electrical test equipment on any circuit related to the SRS unless instructed to in this
Service Manual. SRS wiring harnesses can be identified by yellow and/or orange harnesses or har-
ness connectors.
PRECAUTIONS WHEN USING POWER TOOLS (AIR OR ELECTRIC) AND HAMMERS
WARNING:
When working near the Airbag Diagnosis Sensor Unit or other Airbag System sensors with the Igni-
tion ON or engine running, DO NOT use air or electric power tools or strike near the sensor(s) with a
hammer. Heavy vibration could activate the sensor(s) and deploy the air bag(s), possibly causing
serious injury.
When using air or electric power tools or hammers, always switch the Ignition OFF, disconnect the
battery and wait at least three minutes before performing any service.
Precaution for Trouble Diagnosis INFOID:0000000009174375
AV COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
Do not apply voltage of 7.0 V or higher to the measurement terminals.
Use the tester with its open terminal voltage being 7.0 V or less.
Be sure to turn ignition switch OFF and disconnect the battery cable from the negative terminal before
checking the circuit.
Precaution for Harness Repair INFOID:0000000009174376
AV COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
Solder the repaired parts, and wrap with tape. [Frays of twisted line
must be within 110 mm (4.33 in).]
PKIA0306E
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
PRECAUTIONS
AV-13
< PRECAUTION >
[BASE AUDIO]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
Do not perform bypass wire connections for the repair parts. (The
spliced wire will become separated and the characteristics of
twisted line will be lost.)
Precaution for Work INFOID:0000000009174377
When removing or disassembling each component, be careful not to damage or deform it. If a component
may be subject to interference, be sure to protect it with a shop cloth.
When removing (disengaging) components with a screwdriver or similar tool, be sure to wrap the component
with a shop cloth or vinyl tape to protect it.
Protect the removed parts with a shop cloth and prevent them from being dropped.
Replace a deformed or damaged clip.
If a part is specified as a non-reusable part, always replace it with a new one.
Be sure to tighten bolts and nuts securely to the specified torque.
After installation is complete, be sure to check that each part works properly.
Follow the steps below to clean components:
- Water soluble dirt:
Dip a soft cloth into lukewarm water, wring the water out of the cloth and wipe the dirty area.
Then rub with a soft, dry cloth.
- Oily dirt:
Dip a soft cloth into lukewarm water with mild detergent (concentration: within 2 to 3%) and wipe the dirty
area.
Then dip a cloth into fresh water, wring the water out of the cloth and wipe the detergent off.
Then rub with a soft, dry cloth.
- Do not use organic solvent such as thinner, benzene, alcohol or gasoline.
- For genuine leather seats, use a genuine leather seat cleaner.
PKIA0307E
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-14
< PREPARATION >
[BASE AUDIO]
PREPARATION
PREPARATION
PREPARATION
Special Service Tool INFOID:0000000009174378
The actual shapes of Kent-Moore tools may differ from those of special service tools illustrated here.
Commercial Service Tools INFOID:0000000009174379
Tool number
(Kent-Moore No.)
Tool name
Description
(J-46534)
Trim tool set
Removing trim components
AWJIA0483ZZ
(Kent-Moore No.)
Tool name
Description
( )
Power tools
Loosening nuts, screws and bolts
PIIB1407E
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
COMPONENT PARTS
AV-15
< SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
[BASE AUDIO]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
COMPONENT PARTS
Component Parts Location INFOID:0000000009174380
Component Description INFOID:0000000009174381
1. Instrument panel tweeter LH 2. Steering switches 3. Audio unit
4. Instrument panel tweeter RH 5. Display unit 6. Front door speaker LH
7. Front door speaker RH 8. Rear door speaker LH 9. Rear door speaker RH
ALNIA1441ZZ
Part name Description
Audio unit Controls audio and AUX IN functions.
Display unit Display image is controlled by audio unit via serial communication.
Front door speaker Outputs low and mid range sounds.
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-16
< SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
[BASE AUDIO]
COMPONENT PARTS
Instrument panel tweeter Outputs high range sounds.
Rear door speaker Outputs low, mid and high range sounds.
Steering switches
Operations for audio are possible.
Steering switch signal (operation signal) is output to audio unit.
Antenna amp.
Radio signal received by antenna base is amplified and transmitted to audio unit.
Power (antenna amp. ON signal) is supplied from audio unit.
Part name Description
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
SYSTEM
AV-17
< SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
[BASE AUDIO]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
SYSTEM
AUDIO SYSTEM
AUDIO SYSTEM : System Diagram INFOID:0000000009174382
AUDIO SYSTEM : System Description INFOID:0000000009174383
AUDIO SYSTEM
The audio system consists of the following components
Audio unit
Display unit
Steering switches
Front door speakers
Instrument panel tweeters
Rear door speakers
Antenna
When the audio system is on, radio signals are received by the antenna. The audio unit then sends audio sig-
nals to the front door speakers, instrument panel tweeters and rear door speakers.
Refer to Owner's Manual for audio system operating instructions.
ALNIA1444GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-18
< ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
[BASE AUDIO]
AUDIO UNIT
ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION
AUDIO UNIT
Reference Value INFOID:0000000009174384
TERMINAL LAYOUT
PHYSICAL VALUES
AWNIA3160ZZ
Terminal No.
(Wire color)
Description
Condition
Value
(Approx.)
+ Signal name
Input/
Output
2
(SB)
3
(V)
Sound signal front door
speaker and instrument
panel tweeter LH
Output
Ignition
switch
ON
Audio output
4
(BR)
5
(Y)
Sound signal rear door
speaker LH
Output
Ignition
switch
ON
Audio output
6
(Y)
15
(G)
Steering switch signal A Input
Ignition
switch
ON
Press SOURCE switch 0V
Press switch
1.0V
Press switch
2.0V
Press ENTER switch 4.0V
Except above 5.0V
7
(P)
Ground ACC power supply Input Ignition switch ACC Battery voltage
9
(R)
8
(P)
Illumination control signal Input
Ignition
switch
ON
Headlamps ON Battery voltage
SKIB3609E
SKIB3609E
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
AUDIO UNIT
AV-19
< ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
[BASE AUDIO]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
11
(BR)
12
(Y)
Sound signal front door
speaker and instrument
panel tweeter RH
Output
Ignition
switch
ON
Audio output
13
(L)
14
(SB)
Sound signal rear door
speaker RH
Output
Ignition
switch
ON
Audio output
16
(BR)
15
(G)
Steering switch signal B Input
Ignition
switch
ON
Press switch
0V
Press switch
1.0V
Press switch
3.0V
Press DISP switch 4.0V
Except above 5.0V
19
(Y)
Ground Battery power supply Input Ignition switch OFF Battery voltage
21
(LG)
AV communication signal
(L)
Input/
Output
22
(SB)
AV communication signal
(H)
Input/
Output
33
(B)
Antenna amp. ON signal Output Ignition switch ON Battery voltage
34
(B)
AM - FM main Input
35
(B)
FM sub Input
Terminal No.
(Wire color)
Description
Condition
Value
(Approx.)
+ Signal name
Input/
Output
SKIB3609E
SKIB3609E
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-20
< ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
[BASE AUDIO]
DISPLAY UNIT
DISPLAY UNIT
Reference Value INFOID:0000000009174385
TERMINAL LAYOUT
PHYSICAL VALUES
ALNIA1443ZZ
Terminal
(Wire color)
Description
Condition
Reference value
(Approx.)
+ Signal name
Input/
Output
1
(LG)
AV communication signal
(L)
Input/
Output
2
(SB)
AV communication signal
(H)
Input/
Output
3
(B)
Ground Ground
Ignition
switch
ON
0V
8
(P)
Ground ACC power supply Input Ignition switch ACC Battery voltage
9
(Y)
Ground Battery power supply Input Ignition switch OFF Battery voltage
10
(R)
11
(B)
Illumination control signal Input
Ignition
switch
ON
Headlamps ON Battery voltage
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
BASE AUDIO
AV-21
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[BASE AUDIO]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
WIRING DIAGRAM
BASE AUDIO
Wiring Diagram INFOID:0000000009174386
ABNWA1833GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-22
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[BASE AUDIO]
BASE AUDIO
AANIA1166GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
BASE AUDIO
AV-23
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[BASE AUDIO]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
ABNIA4760GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-24
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[BASE AUDIO]
BASE AUDIO
ABNIA4761GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
BASE AUDIO
AV-25
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[BASE AUDIO]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
ABNIA4762GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-26
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[BASE AUDIO]
BASE AUDIO
ABNIA4763GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
BASE AUDIO
AV-27
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[BASE AUDIO]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
AANIA1171GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-28
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[BASE AUDIO]
BASE AUDIO
ABNIA4764GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
BASE AUDIO
AV-29
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[BASE AUDIO]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
ABNIA4765GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-30
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[BASE AUDIO]
BASE AUDIO
ABNIA4766GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORKFLOW
AV-31
< BASIC INSPECTION >
[BASE AUDIO]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
BASIC INSPECTION
DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORKFLOW
Work Flow INFOID:0000000009174387
OVERALL SEQUENCE
DETAILED FLOW
1.GET INFORMATION FOR SYMPTOM
Get detailed information from the customer about the symptom (the condition and the environment when the
incident/malfunction occurred).
>> GO TO 2
2.CONFIRM THE SYMPTOM
Try to confirm the symptom described by the customer. Verify relation between the symptom and the condition
when the symptom is detected.
>> GO TO 3
3.DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART BY DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE
Inspect according to Diagnostic Procedure of the system.
ALNIA0182GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-32
< BASIC INSPECTION >
[BASE AUDIO]
DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORKFLOW
Is malfunctioning part detected?
YES >> GO TO 4
NO >> GO TO 2
4.REPAIR OR REPLACE THE MALFUNCTIONING PART
1. Repair or replace the malfunctioning part.
2. Reconnect parts or connectors disconnected during Diagnostic Procedure.
>> GO TO 5
5.FINAL CHECK
Refer to confirmed symptom in step 2, and make sure that the symptom is not detected.
Has the symptom been repaired?
YES >> Inspection End.
NO >> GO TO 2
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT
AV-33
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[BASE AUDIO]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS
POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT
AUDIO UNIT
AUDIO UNIT : Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174388
Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-21, "Wiring Diagram".
1.CHECK FUSE
Check that the following fuses are not blown.
Are the fuses blown?
YES >> Replace the blown fuse after repairing the affected circuit.
NO >> GO TO 2.
2.CHECK POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect audio unit connector M123.
3. Check voltage between audio unit connector and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> Inspection End.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
DISPLAY UNIT
DISPLAY UNIT : Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174389
Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-21, "Wiring Diagram".
1.CHECK FUSE
Check that the following fuses are not blown.
Are the fuses blown?
YES >> Replace the blown fuse after repairing the affected circuit.
NO >> GO TO 2.
2.CHECK POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
Terminal No. Signal name Fuse No.
19 Battery power supply 15 (15A)
7 ACC power supply 65 (10A)
Audio unit
Ground Condition
Voltage
(Approx.)
Connector Terminal
M123
19
(J-46534)
Trim tool set
Removing trim components
AWJIA0483ZZ
(Kent-Moore No.)
Tool name
Description
( )
Power tools
Loosening nuts, screws and bolts
PIIB1407E
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-58
< SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
COMPONENT PARTS
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
COMPONENT PARTS
Component Parts Location INFOID:0000000009174416
ALNIA1445ZZ
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
COMPONENT PARTS
AV-59
< SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
Component Description INFOID:0000000009174417
1. Instrument panel tweeter LH 2. Steering switches 3. A/C and AV switch assembly
4. Instrument panel tweeter RH 5. Display unit 6. AV control unit (view with center stack
removed)
7. Microphone 8. USB interface 9. Front auxiliary input jacks
10. Front door speaker LH 11. Front door speaker RH 12. Rear door speaker LH
13. Rear door speaker RH 14. Rear view camera 15.
Bluetooth
control unit
16. Satellite radio tuner 17.
Bluetooth
antenna
Part name Description
AV control unit
Master unit of MULTI AV system.
AV control unit includes audio, USB connection and vehicle status functions.
Connected to MULTI AV system control units via AV communication.
Connected to other vehicle control units via CAN communication to obtain neces-
sary information for vehicle information function.
Inputs signals for driving status recognition (vehicle speed, reverse and parking
brake).
TEL voice signal and voice guidance signal are input from Bluetooth
control unit.
Camera image signal is received and transmitted to display unit.
Display unit
Display image is controlled by AV control unit via serial communication.
Receives power (signal VCC and inverter VCC) from AV control unit.
RGB image signals (RGB image, RGB area and RGB synchronizing) are input
from AV control unit.
Composite image signals are input from AV control unit.
Synchronizing signals (HP, VP) are output to AV control unit.
Front door speaker Outputs low and mid range sounds.
Instrument panel tweeter Outputs high range sounds.
Rear door speaker Outputs low, mid and high range sounds.
A/C and AV switch assembly
Operation panels are equipped with switches for audio and air conditioner opera-
tions.
Operation signal is transmitted via AV communication to AV control unit.
Disk eject operation signal is performed via hardwire.
Rear view camera
Camera power supply is input from AV control unit.
Vehicle rear view image is transmitted to display unit via AV control unit.
Steering switches
Operations for audio and hands-free phone are possible.
Steering switch signal (operation signal) is output to AV control unit.
Microphone
Used for hands-free phone and voice recognition operation.
Microphone signal is transmitted to Bluetooth
control unit.
Power (Microphone VCC) is supplied from Bluetooth
control unit.
Antenna amp.
Radio signal received by window antenna is amplified and transmitted to AV con-
trol unit.
Power (antenna amp. ON signal) is supplied from AV control unit.
Satellite radio tuner
Inputs satellite radio signal from satellite radio antenna and outputs sound signal
to AV control unit.
Controlled via serial communication (communication signal and request signal) by
AV control unit.
Satellite radio antenna Satellite radio signal is received and transmitted to satellite radio tuner.
Bluetooth
control unit
Inputs TEL voice signal from Bluetooth
control unit.
USB connector USB sound and data input signals are transmitted to AV control unit.
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-60
< SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
SYSTEM
SYSTEM
MULTI AV SYSTEM
MULTI AV SYSTEM : System Diagram INFOID:0000000009174418
MULTI AV SYSTEM : System Description INFOID:0000000009174419
AUDIO SYSTEM
AWNIA2803GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
SYSTEM
AV-61
< SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
The audio system consists of the following components
AV control unit
A/C and AV switch assembly
Display unit
Steering switches
Front door speakers
Instrument panel tweeters
Rear door speakers
Antenna
When the audio system is on, radio signals are received by the antenna. The AV control unit then sends audio
signals to the front door speakers, instrument panel tweeters and rear door speakers.
Refer to Owner's Manual for audio system operating instructions.
SATELLITE RADIO SYSTEM
The satellite radio system consists of the following components
Satellite antenna
Satellite radio tuner
When the satellite radio system is on, radio signals are supplied to the satellite radio tuner from the satellite
antenna. The satellite radio tuner then sends audio signals to the AV control unit.
Refer to Owner's Manual for satellite radio system operating instructions.
HANDS-FREE PHONE SYSTEM
System Operation
NOTE:
Cellular telephones must have their wireless connection set up (paired) before using the Bluetooth
telephone
system.
The Bluetooth
control unit. Different cellular telephones may have different pairing procedures, refer to
the cellular telephone operating manual.
Refer to the Owner's Manual for Bluetooth
Control Unit
When the ignition switch is turned to ACC or ON, the Bluetooth
control unit is initialized and performs various self-checks. Initialization may take up to 20 sec-
onds.
Steering Switches
When buttons on the steering switches are pushed, the resistance in steering switch circuits change, depend-
ing on which button is pushed.
The following functions can be performed using the steering switches:
Initiate self-diagnosis of the Bluetooth
telephone system
Answer and end telephone calls
Adjust the volume of calls
Microphone
The microphone is located in the roof console assembly. The microphone sends a signal to the Bluetooth
control unit.
Bluetooth
control unit.
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-66
< SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (AV CONTROL UNIT)
2. Select each switch on the Confirmation/Adjustment screen to
display the relevant trouble diagnosis screen. Press the BACK
switch to return to the initial Confirmation/Adjustment screen.
Display Diagnosis
Vehicle Signals
A comparison check can be made of each actual vehicle signal and
the signals recognized by the system.
Speaker Test
AWNIA2562GB
JSNIA2233GB
JSNIA0149GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (AV CONTROL UNIT)
AV-67
< SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
Select Speaker Test to display the Speaker Diagnosis screen. Press
Start to generate a test tone in a speaker. Press Start again to gener-
ate a test tone in the next speaker. Press End to stop the test tones.
Error History
The self diagnosis results are judged depending on whether any error occurs from when Self diagnosis is
selected until the self diagnosis results are displayed.
However, the diagnosis results are judged normal if an error has occurred before the ignition switch is turned
ON and then no error has occurred until the self
diagnosis start. Check the Error Record to detect any error that may have occurred before the self diagnosis
start because of this situation.
The frequency of occurrence is displayed in a count up manner. The actual count up method differs depending
on the error item.
Count up method A
The counter resets to 0 if an error occurs when ignition switch is turned ON. The counter increases by 1 if
the condition is normal at a next ignition ON cycle.
The counter upper limit is 39. Any counts exceeding 39 are ignored. The counter can be reset (no error
record display) with the Delete log switch or CONSULT.
Count up method B
The counter increases by 1 if an error occurs when ignition switch is ON. The counter will not decrease even
if the condition is normal at the next ignition ON cycle.
The counter upper limit is 50. Any counts exceeding 50 are ignored. The counter can be reset (no error
record display) with the Delete log switch or CONSULT.
Error item
Some error items may be displayed simultaneously according to the cause. If some error items are displayed
simultaneously, the detection of the cause can be performed by the combination of display items
JSNIA0150GB
Display type of occur-
rence frequency
Error history display item
Count up method A CAN communication line, control unit (CAN), AV communication line, control unit (AV)
Count up method B Other than the above
JSNIA0151GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-68
< SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (AV CONTROL UNIT)
Camera Cont.
The two functions of Correct Draw Line of Rear view Cam, Con-
firm Configuration are available.
Adjust Offset of Rear view Camera
Error item Description Possible cause
CAN COMM CIRCUIT
CAN communication malfunction is detect-
ed.
Perform diagnosis with CONSULT, then re-
pair the malfunctioning components ac-
cording to diagnosis results. Refer to AV-
70, "CONSULT Function"
CONTROL UNIT (CAN)
CAN initial diagnosis malfunction is detect-
ed.
Replace the AV control unit if the malfunc-
tion occurs constantly. Refer to AV-187,
"Removal and Installation".
CONTROL UNIT (AV)
AV communication circuit initial diagnosis
malfunction is detected.
FLASH-ROM Error Of Control Unit
AV control unit malfunction is detected.
CAN Controller Memory Error
Display Connection Error
When any of the following is detected:
display unit power supply or ground cir-
cuits malfunction.
communication circuit malfunction be-
tween AV control unit and display unit.
Display unit power supply or ground cir-
cuits. Refer to AV-144, "DISPLAY UNIT :
Diagnosis Procedure".
Communication circuits between AV con-
trol unit and display unit. Refer to AV-136,
"Diagnosis Procedure".
XM Connection Error
When any of the following is detected:
satellite radio tuner power supply or
ground circuit malfunction.
communication circuit malfunction be-
tween AV control unit and satellite radio
tuner.
request signal circuit malfunction be-
tween AV control unit and satellite radio
tuner.
Satellite radio tuner power supply or
ground circuits. Refer to AV-146, "SAT-
ELLITE RADIO TUNER : Diagnosis Pro-
cedure".
Communication circuit between AV con-
trol unit and satellite radio tuner. Refer to
AV-138, "Diagnosis Procedure".
Request signal circuit between AV con-
trol unit and satellite radio tuner. Refer to
AV-138, "Diagnosis Procedure".
AV COMM CIRCUIT
Switches Connection Error
When any of the following is detected:
A/C and AV switch assembly power sup-
ply or ground circuit malfunction.
AV communication circuit malfunction
between AV control unit and A/C and AV
switch assembly.
A/C and AV switch assembly power sup-
ply or ground circuits. Refer to AV-148,
"A/C AND AV SWITCH ASSEMBLY : Di-
agnosis Procedure".
AV communication circuits between AV
control unit and A/C and AV switch as-
sembly.
AV COMM CIRCUIT
BTHF Unit Connection Error
When any of the following is detected:
Bluetooth
control unit.
Bluetooth
control unit.
AV COMM CIRCUIT
Switches Connection Error
BTHF Unit Connection Error
AV communication circuit malfunction be-
tween AV control unit and A/C and AV
switch assembly.
AV communication circuits between AV
control unit and A/C and AV switch assem-
bly.
JSNIA2230ZZ
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (AV CONTROL UNIT)
AV-69
< SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
Use this mode to adjust the guide line display position of the rear
view monitor if necessary after removing the rear view monitor
camera.
CAUTION:
After the adjustment, never perform other operations for one
minute.
Factory Configuration Confirmation
Configuration stored in the AV control unit can be checked.
Vehicle CAN Diagnosis
CAN communication status and error counter is displayed.
The error counter displays OK if any malfunction was not
detected in the past and displays 0 if a malfunction is detected. It
increases by 1 if the condition is normal at the next ignition switch
ON cycle. The upper limit of the counter is 39.
The error counter is erased if Reset is pressed.
NOTE:
??? indicates UNKWN.
AV COMM Diagnosis
JSNIA2231ZZ
JSNIA2234ZZ
Items Display (Current)
Malfunction counter
(Past)
Tx(HVAC) OK / ??? OK / 0 39
Rx(ECM) OK / ??? OK / 0 39
Rx(Cluster) OK / ??? OK / 0 39
Rx(BCM) OK / ??? OK / 0 39
Rx(HVAC) OK / ??? OK / 0 39
Rx(USM) OK / ??? OK / 0 39
Rx(VDC) OK / ??? OK / 0 39
Rx(STRG) OK / ??? OK / 0 39
JSNIA2235ZZ
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-70
< SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (AV CONTROL UNIT)
Displays the communication status between AV control unit and
each unit.
The error counter displays OK if any malfunction was not
detected in the past and displays 0 if a malfunction is detected. It
increases by 1 if the condition is normal at the next ignition switch
ON cycle. The upper limit of the counter is 39.
The error counter is erased if Reset is pressed.
NOTE:
??? indicates UNKWN.
Delete Unit Connection Log
Deletes any unit connection records and error records from the AV
control unit memory. (Clear the records of the unit that has been
removed.)
Initialize Settings
User Data Initialization and Accessory Number Initialization are
possible.
CAUTION:
Never perform Accessory Number Initialization except when
configuration is unsuccessful.
Accessory Number Initialization requires configuration. For
details, refer to AV-117, "CONFIGURATION (AV CONTROL
UNIT) : Description".
CONSULT Function INFOID:0000000009174422
CAUTION:
After disconnecting the CONSULT vehicle interface (VI) from the data link connector, the ignition must
be cycled OFF ON (for at least 5 seconds) OFF. If this step is not performed, the BCM may not go
to sleep mode, potentially causing a discharged battery and no-start condition.
CONSULT FUNCTIONS
CONSULT performs the following functions via communication with the AV control unit.
Items
Status
(Current)
Counter
(Past)
C Tx(ITM-SW) OK / ??? OK / 0 39
C Rx(PrimarySW-ITM) OK / ??? OK / 0 39
C Rx(BTHF-ITM) OK / ??? OK / 0 39
JSNIA2505ZZ
JSNIA0154GB
JSNIA2237ZZ
Direct Diagnostic Mode Description
Ecu Identification The AV control unit part number is displayed.
Self Diagnostic Result The AV control unit self diagnostic results are displayed.
Data Monitor The AV control unit input/output data is displayed in real time.
Work support The settings for AV control unit functions can be changed.
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (AV CONTROL UNIT)
AV-71
< SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
ECU IDENTIFICATION
The part number of AV control unit is displayed.
SELF DIAGNOSTIC RESULT
Refer to AV-79, "DTC Index".
DATA MONITOR
CONFIGURATION
Refer to AV-117, "CONFIGURATION (AV CONTROL UNIT) : Description".
CAN DIAG SUPPORT MNTR
Refer to LAN-17, "CAN Diagnostic Support Monitor".
Configuration
The vehicle specification can be read and saved.
The vehicle specification can be written when replacing AV control unit.
CAN Diag Support Mntr
The result of transmit/receive diagnosis of AV communication is displayed.
The result of transmit/receive diagnosis of CAN communication is displayed.
Direct Diagnostic Mode Description
Monitor Item [Unit] Description
VHCL SPD SIG [On/Off]
On: vehicle speed > 0 km/h (0 MPH).
Off: vehicle speed = 0 km/h (0 MPH).
PKB SIG [On/Off]
On: parking brake applied.
Off: parking brake released.
ILLUM SIG [On/Off]
On: optical sensor signal is received.
Off: optical sensor signal is not received.
IGN SIG [On/Off]
On: ignition switch ON.
Off: ignition switch ACC.
REV SIG [On/Off]
On: selector lever in R position.
Off: selector lever in any position other than R.
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-72
< SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (BLUETOOTH CONTROL UNIT)
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (BLUETOOTH CONTROL UNIT)
Diagnosis Description INFOID:0000000009174423
The Bluetooth
control unit has two diagnostic checks. The first diagnostic check is performed automatically
every ignition cycle during control unit initialization. The second diagnostic check is performed by the techni-
cian using the steering wheel audio control switches prior to trouble diagnosis.
Bluetooth
inquiry check
OPERATION PROCEDURE
1. Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON.
2. Wait for the Bluetooth
antenna open
1. Inspect harness connection.
2. Replace Bluetooth
antenna shorted
Phone/Send for Hands Free System is stuck
Check steering wheel audio control switches. Refer to AV-178, "Diagnosis Proce-
dure".
Phone/End for the Hands Free System is stuck
Microphone test (failed interactive test)
1. Inspect harness between Bluetooth
voice signal
Input
Ignition
switch
ON
During voice guide output
with switch pressed.
6 Shield
10
(V)
Ground Eject ground Ignition switch ON 0 V
SKIB3609E
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-74
< ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
AV CONTROL UNIT
11
(L)
CANH
Input/
Output
12
(P)
CANL
Input/
Output
13
(SB)
AV communication signal
(H)
Input/
Output
14
(LG)
AV communication signal
(L)
Input/
Output
15
(SB)
AV communication signal
(H)
Input/
Output
16
(LG)
AV communication signal
(L)
Input/
Output
20
(W)
22
(B)
AUX sound signal RH Input
Ignition
switch
ON
AUX mode selected.
21
(R)
22
(B)
AUX sound signal LH Input
Ignition
switch
ON
AUX mode selected.
25 Shield
28
(Y)
Ground CD (DVD) eject signal Input
Ignition
switch
ON
Pressing eject switch. 0 V
Except above. 5.0 V
29
(LG)
Ground Ignition signal Input Ignition switch ON Battery voltage
30
(R)
Ground Reverse signal Input
Ignition
switch
ON
Selector lever in R position. Battery voltage
Selector lever in any posi-
tion other than R.
0 V
31
(G)
Ground Parking brake signal Input
Ignition
switch
ON
Parking brake applied. 4.5 V
Parking brake released. 0 V
32
(GR)
Ground Vehicle speed signal Input
Ignition
switch
ON
Vehicle speed approx. 40
km/h (25 MPH)
NOTE:
The maximum voltage varies de-
pending on the specification
(destination unit).
Terminal No.
(Wire color)
Description
Condition
Value
(Approx.)
+ Signal name
Input/
Output
SKIB3609E
SKIB3609E
JSNIA0012GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
AV CONTROL UNIT
AV-75
< ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
34
(SB)
35
(V)
Sound signal front door
speaker and instrument
panel tweeter LH
Output
Ignition
switch
ON
Audio output
36
(BR)
37
(Y)
Sound signal rear door
speaker LH
Output
Ignition
switch
ON
Audio output
38
(G)
47
(B)
Steering switch signal A Input
Ignition
switch
ON
Press SOURCE switch 0V
Press switch
1.0V
Press switch
2.0V
Press switch
3.0V
Press ENTER switch 4.0V
Except above 5.0V
39
(P)
Ground ACC power supply Input Ignition switch ACC Battery voltage
41
(R)
Ground Illumination signal Input
Ignition
switch
OFF
Lighting switch OFF 0 V
Lighting switch ON Battery voltage
43
(BR)
44
(Y)
Sound signal front door
speaker and instrument
panel tweeter RH
Output
Ignition
switch
ON
Audio output
45
(L)
46
(SB)
Sound signal rear door
speaker RH
Output
Ignition
switch
ON
Audio output
48
(W)
47
(B)
Steering switch signal B Input
Ignition
switch
ON
Press switch
0V
Press switch
1.0V
Press switch
2.0V
Press switch
3.0V
Press DISP switch 4.0V
Except above 5.0V
Terminal No.
(Wire color)
Description
Condition
Value
(Approx.)
+ Signal name
Input/
Output
SKIB3609E
SKIB3609E
SKIB3609E
SKIB3609E
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-76
< ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
AV CONTROL UNIT
51
(Y)
Ground Battery power supply Input Ignition switch OFF Battery voltage
52
(B)
Ground Ground Ignition switch ON 0 V
53
(B)
Ground Composite image signal Output
Ignition
switch
ON
Camera image or AUX im-
age displayed
54
(W)
Ground
Composite image signal
ground
Ignition switch ON 0 V
55
(W)
Ground RGB signal (B: blue) Output
Ignition
switch
ON
Begin Confirmation/Adjust-
ment mode, then select
Color Spectrum Bar
56
(B)
Ground RGB signal (G: green) Output
Ignition
switch
ON
Begin Confirmation/Adjust-
ment mode, then select
Color Spectrum Bar
57
(R)
Ground RGB signal (R: red) Output
Ignition
switch
ON
Begin Confirmation/Adjust-
ment mode, then select
Color Spectrum Bar
58
(B)
Ground RGB synchronizing signal Output Ignition switch ON
59 Shield (RGB SYN GND)
Terminal No.
(Wire color)
Description
Condition
Value
(Approx.)
+ Signal name
Input/
Output
SKIB2251J
SKIB2237J
SKIB2236J
SKIB2238J
SKIB3603E
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
AV CONTROL UNIT
AV-77
< ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
60
(W)
Ground RGB area (YS) signal Output
Ignition
switch
ON
RGB image displayed 5.0 V
AUX image displayed
61
(B)
Ground
Communication signal
(DISPCONT)
Input
Ignition
switch
ON
Adjusting display bright-
ness
62
(G)
Ground
Horizontal synchronizing
(HP) signal
Input Ignition switch ON
63
(B)
Ground Signal ground Ignition switch OFF 0 V
64
(V)
Ground Signal VCC Output Ignition switch ACC 9.0 V
66 Shield
67 Shield
72 Shield
73
(W)
Ground
Communication signal
(CONTDISP)
Output
Ignition
switch
ON
Adjusting display bright-
ness
74
(R)
Ground
Vertical synchronizing (VP)
signal
Input Ignition switch ON
75
(LG)
Ground Inverter ground Ignition switch OFF 0 V
76
(L)
Ground Inverter VCC Output Ignition switch ACC 9.0 V
Terminal No.
(Wire color)
Description
Condition
Value
(Approx.)
+ Signal name
Input/
Output
PKIB4948J
PKIB5039J
SKIB3601E
PKIB5039J
SKIB3598E
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-78
< ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
AV CONTROL UNIT
82
(B)
Ground Camera image signal Input
Ignition
switch
ON
Camera image displayed
83
(W)
Ground AUX image signal Input
Ignition
switch
ON
AUX image displayed
87
(R)
Ground Camera power supply Output
Ignition
switch
ON
Selector lever in R posi-
tion
6.0 V
88
(W)
Ground Camera ground Ignition switch ON 0 V
89 Shield
90 Shield
91
(B)
Ground AUX image signal ground Ignition switch ON 0 V
94
(B)
93
(W)
Satellite radio sound signal
LH
Input
Ignition
switch
ON
Satellite radio mode select-
ed
96
(G)
95
(R)
Satellite radio sound signal
RH
Input
Ignition
switch
ON
Satellite radio mode select-
ed
97 Shield
98 Shield
100
(W)
Ground
Request signal
(SATCONT)
Input
Ignition
switch
ON
Satellite radio mode select-
ed
Terminal No.
(Wire color)
Description
Condition
Value
(Approx.)
+ Signal name
Input/
Output
SKIB2251J
SKIB2251J
SKIB3609E
SKIB3609E
SKIA9299J
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
AV CONTROL UNIT
AV-79
< ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
DTC Index INFOID:0000000009174426
101
(B)
Ground
Communication signal
(SATCONT)
Input
Ignition
switch
ON
Satellite radio mode select-
ed
102
(R)
Ground
Communication signal
(CONTSAT)
Output
Ignition
switch
ON
Satellite radio mode select-
ed
121
(W)
V BUS signal
122
(G)
USB ground
123
(L)
USB D+ signal
124
(R)
USB D signal
125 Shield
126
(B)
Antenna amp. ON signal Output Ignition switch ON Battery voltage
127
(B)
AM - FM main Input
128
(B)
FM sub Input
Terminal No.
(Wire color)
Description
Condition
Value
(Approx.)
+ Signal name
Input/
Output
SKIA9300J
SKIA9301J
CONSULT Display Reference Page
U1000: CAN COMM CIRCUIT AV-119, "DTC Logic"
U1010: CONTROL UNIT AV-120, "DTC Logic"
U1200: CONT UNIT AV-121, "DTC Logic"
U1216: CAN CONT AV-122, "DTC Logic"
U1218: HDD CONN AV-123, "DTC Logic"
U1219: HDD READ AV-124, "DTC Logic"
U121A: HDD WRITE AV-125, "DTC Logic"
U121B: HDD COMM AV-126, "DTC Logic"
U121C: HDD ACCESS AV-127, "DTC Logic"
U121D: DSP CONN AV-128, "DTC Logic"
U121E: DSP COMM AV-129, "DTC Logic"
U1225: USB CONTROLLER AV-130, "DTC Logic"
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-80
< ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
AV CONTROL UNIT
U1227: DVD COMM AV-131, "DTC Logic"
U1228: SUB CPU CONN AV-132, "DTC Logic"
U1229: iPod CERTIFICATION AV-133, "DTC Logic"
U122A: CONFIG UNFINISH AV-134, "DTC Logic"
U122E: Built-in AUDIO CONN AV-135, "DTC Logic"
U1240: SWITCH CONN AV-142, "Description"
U1243: FRONT DISP CONN AV-136, "DTC Logic"
U1255: SAT CONN AV-138, "DTC Logic"
U1256: HAND FREE CONN AV-142, "Description"
U1263: USB OVERCURRENT AV-140, "DTC Logic"
U1264: ANTENNA AMP TERMINAL (OPEN or SHORT) AV-141, "DTC Logic"
U1300: AV COMM CIRCUIT AV-142, "Description"
U1310: CONTROL UNIT AV-143, "DTC Logic"
CONSULT Display Reference Page
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
DISPLAY UNIT
AV-81
< ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
DISPLAY UNIT
Reference Value INFOID:0000000009174427
TERMINAL LAYOUT
PHYSICAL VALUES
AWNIA1727ZZ
Terminal
(Wire color)
Description
Condition
Reference value
(Approx.)
+ Signal name
Input/
Output
1
(B)
Ground Ground
Ignition
switch
ON
0V
2
(L)
Ground Inverter VCC Input
Ignition
switch
ACC
9V
3
(V)
Ground Signal VCC Input
Ignition
switch
ACC
9V
4
(W)
Ground Composite image ground
Ignition
switch
ON
0V
5 Shield
6
(B)
Ground RGB signal (G: green) Input
Ignition
switch
ON
Start Confirmation/Adjust-
ment mode, and then dis-
play color bar by selecting
Color Spectrum Bar on
Display Diagnosis screen.
7 Shield (RGB GND)
8
(G)
Ground
Horizontal synchronizing
(HP) signal
Output
Ignition
switch
ON
JSNIA1030ZZ
SKIB3601E
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-82
< ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
DISPLAY UNIT
9
(W)
Ground RGB area (YS) signal Input
Ignition
switch
ON
At RGB image is displayed. 5V
At DVD image is displayed.
11
(W)
Ground
Communication signal
(CONTDISP)
Input
Ignition
switch
ON
When adjusting display
brightness.
13
(LG)
Ground Inverter ground
Ignition
switch
ON
0V
14
(B)
Ground Signal ground
Ignition
switch
ON
0V
15
(B)
Ground Composite image signal Input
Ignition
switch
ON
At rear view camera image
is displayed.
17
(R)
Ground RGB signal (R: red) Input
Ignition
switch
ON
Start Confirmation/Adjust-
ment mode, and then dis-
play color bar by selecting
Color Spectrum Bar on
Display Diagnosis screen.
18
(W)
Ground RGB signal (B: blue) Input
Ignition
switch
ON
Start Confirmation/Adjust-
ment mode, and then dis-
play color bar by selecting
Color Spectrum Bar on
Display Diagnosis screen.
Terminal
(Wire color)
Description
Condition
Reference value
(Approx.)
+ Signal name
Input/
Output
PKIB4948J
PKIB5039J
SKIB2251J
JSNIA1029ZZ
JSNIA1031ZZ
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
DISPLAY UNIT
AV-83
< ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
19
(B)
Ground RGB synchronizing signal Input
Ignition
switch
ON
20
(R)
Ground
Vertical synchronizing (VP)
signal
Output
Ignition
switch
On
21 Shield
22
(B)
Ground
Communication signal
(DISPCONT)
Output
Ignition
switch
ON
When adjusting display
brightness.
23 Shield
Terminal
(Wire color)
Description
Condition
Reference value
(Approx.)
+ Signal name
Input/
Output
SKIB3603E
SKIB3598E
PKIB5039J
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-84
< ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
SATELLITE RADIO TUNER
SATELLITE RADIO TUNER
Reference Value INFOID:0000000009174428
PHYSICAL VALUES
AWNIA2563ZZ
Terminal Description
Condition
Reference value
(Approx.)
+ Signal name
Input/
Output
22
(B)
21
(W)
Satellite radio sound signal
LH
Output
Ignition
switch
ON
When satellite radio
mode is selected
24
(G)
23
(R)
Satellite radio sound signal
RH
Output
Ignition
switch
ON
When satellite radio
mode is selected
25 Shield
26 Shield (DATA GND)
28
(W)
Ground
Request signal
(SATCONT)
Output
Ignition
switch
ON
When satellite radio
mode is selected
29
(R)
Ground
Communication signal
(SATCONT)
Output
Ignition
switch
ON
When satellite radio
mode is selected
SKIB3609E
SKIB3609E
SKIA9299J
SKIA9300J
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
SATELLITE RADIO TUNER
AV-85
< ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
30
(B)
Ground
Communication signal
(CONTSAT)
Input
Ignition
switch
ON
When satellite radio
mode is selected
32
(SB)
Ground Battery power supply Input
Ignition
switch
OFF
Battery voltage
35
(GR)
Ground Ground
Ignition
switch
ON
0V
36
(BG)
Ground ACC power supply Input
Ignition
switch
ACC
Battery voltage
37
(B)
Satellite antenna
Terminal Description
Condition
Reference value
(Approx.)
+ Signal name
Input/
Output
SKIA9301J
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-86
< ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
BLUETOOTH CONTROL UNIT
BLUETOOTH CONTROL UNIT
Reference Value INFOID:0000000009174429
TERMINAL LAYOUT
PHYSICAL VALUES
AWNIA2564ZZ
Terminal
(wire color)
Description
Condition
Reference value
(Approx.)
+ Signal name
Input/out-
put
1
(Y)
Ground Battery power Input Battery voltage
2
(R)
Ground ACC power Input
Ignition
switch
ACC/ON
Battery voltage
3
(P)
Ground IGN power Input
Ignition
switch
ON/
START
Battery voltage
4
(B)
Ground Ground
Ignition
switch ON
0V
5 Shield
7
(B)
8 MIC in signal Input
9
(W)
10
(B)
Audio out Output
Ignition
switch
ACC/ON
Bluetooth
control
unit sends audio sig-
nal
20
(B)
Ground Ground
Ignition
switch ON
0V
22
(B)
Ground Ground
Ignition
switch ON
0V
24
(B)
Ground Ground
Ignition
switch ON
0V
27
(B)
Ground Ground
Ignition
switch ON
0V
SKIB3609E
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
BLUETOOTH CONTROL UNIT
AV-87
< ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
28
(V)
Ground
Vehicle speed signal
(8-pulse)
Input
Ignition
switch ON
When vehicle speed
is approx. 40 km/h
(25 MPH)
29
(W)
Ground Microphone power Output
Ignition
switch ON
5V
35
(SB)
M-CAN1 (H)
36
(LG)
M-CAN1 (L)
43
(B)
Bluetooth
antenna
44 Shield
Terminal
(wire color)
Description
Condition
Reference value
(Approx.)
+ Signal name
Input/out-
put
PKIA1935E
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-88
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE
WIRING DIAGRAM
MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE
Wiring Diagram INFOID:0000000009174430
ABNWA1835GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE
AV-89
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
ABNWA1836GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-90
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE
ABNWA1837GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE
AV-91
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
ABNWA1838GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-92
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE
ABNWA1839GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE
AV-93
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
ABNIA4768GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-94
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE
ABNIA4769GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE
AV-95
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
ABNIA4770GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-96
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE
ABNIA4771GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE
AV-97
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
ABNIA4772GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-98
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE
ABNIA4773GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE
AV-99
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
ABNIA4774GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-100
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE
ABNIA4775GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE
AV-101
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
ABNIA4776GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-102
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE
ABNIA4777GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE
AV-103
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
AANIA1185GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-104
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE
ABNIA4778GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE
AV-105
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
ABNIA4779GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-106
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE
ABNIA4780GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE
AV-107
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
ABNIA4781GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-108
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE
ABNIA4782GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE
AV-109
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
ABNIA4783GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-110
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE
ABNIA4784GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE
AV-111
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
ABNIA4785GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-112
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE
ABNIA4786GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE
AV-113
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
ABNIA4787GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-114
< BASIC INSPECTION >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORKFLOW
BASIC INSPECTION
DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORKFLOW
Work Flow INFOID:0000000009174431
OVERALL SEQUENCE
Reference 1: Refer to AV-70, "CONSULT Function".
Reference 2: Refer to AV-181, "Symptom Table".
DETAILED FLOW
1.CHECK SYMPTOM
Check the malfunction symptoms by performing the following items:
Interview the customer to obtain the malfunction information (conditions and environment when the malfunc-
tion occurred).
Check the symptom.
>> GO TO 2
2.SELF-DIAGNOSIS (CONSULT)
1. Connect CONSULT and perform SELF-DIAGNOSIS for MULTI AV.
NOTE:
Skip to step 4 of the diagnosis procedure if MULTI AV is not displayed.
2. Check if any DTC No. is displayed in the self-diagnosis results.
AWNIA2486GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORKFLOW
AV-115
< BASIC INSPECTION >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
Is any DTC No. displayed?
YES >> GO TO 3
NO >> GO TO 4
3.CHECK SELF-DIAGNOSIS RESULTS (CONSULT)
1. Check the DTC No. indicated in the self-diagnosis results.
2. Perform the relevant diagnosis referring to the DTC No. list. Refer to AV-79, "DTC Index".
NOTE:
Start with the diagnosis for the CAN communication system if CAN COMM CIRCUIT [U1000] or CONTROL
UNIT (CAN) [U1010] is displayed.
>> GO TO 5
4.PERFORM DIAGNOSIS BY SYMPTOM
Perform the relevant diagnosis referring to the diagnosis chart by symptom. Refer to AV-181, "Symptom
Table".
>> GO TO 5
5.REPAIR OR REPLACE MALFUNCTIONING PARTS
Repair or replace the identified malfunctioning parts.
NOTE:
Erase the stored self-diagnosis results after repairing or replacing the relevant components if any DTC No. has
been indicated in the self-diagnosis results.
>> GO TO 6
6.CHECK AFTER REPAIR
1. Perform self-diagnosis for MULTI AV with CONSULT after repairing or replacing the malfunctioning
parts.
2. Check if any DTC No. is displayed in the self-diagnosis results.
Is any DTC No. displayed?
YES >> GO TO 3
NO >> GO TO 7
7.FINAL CHECK
Perform the operation check to confirm that the malfunction symptom is solved or that any other symptoms
are present.
Are any symptoms present?
YES >> GO TO 4
NO >> Inspection End.
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-116
< BASIC INSPECTION >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
INSPECTION AND ADJUSTMENT
INSPECTION AND ADJUSTMENT
ADDITIONAL SERVICE WHEN REPLACING AV CONTROL UNIT
ADDITIONAL SERVICE WHEN REPLACING AV CONTROL UNIT : Description
INFOID:0000000009174432
BEFORE REPLACEMENT
When replacing AV control unit, save or print current vehicle specification with CONSULT configuration before
replacement.
NOTE:
If Before Replace ECU cannot be used, use the After Replace ECU or Manual Configuration after replac-
ing AV control unit.
AFTER REPLACEMENT
CAUTION:
When replacing AV control unit, you must perform After Replace ECU with CONSULT.
Complete the procedure of After Replace ECU in order.
If you set incorrect After Replace ECU, incidents might occur.
Configuration is different for each vehicle model. Confirm configuration of each vehicle model.
ADDITIONAL SERVICE WHEN REPLACING AV CONTROL UNIT : Work Procedure
INFOID:0000000009174433
1.SAVING VEHICLE SPECIFICATION
-CONSULT
Enter Re/Programming, Configuration and perform Before Replace ECU to save or print current vehicle
specification.
NOTE:
If Before Replace ECU cannot be used, use the After Replace ECU or Manual Configuration after replac-
ing AV control unit.
>> GO TO 2.
2.REPLACE AV CONTROL UNIT
Replace AV control unit. Refer to AV-187, "Removal and Installation".
>> GO TO 3.
3.WRITING VEHICLE SPECIFICATION
CONSULT
1. Enter "Re/Programming, Configuration".
2. If Before Replace ECU operation was performed, automatically an "Operation Log Selection" screen will
be displayed. Select the applicable file from the "Saved Data List" and press Confirm to write vehicle
specification. Refer to AV-117, "CONFIGURATION (AV CONTROL UNIT) : Work Procedure".
3. If Before Replace ECU operation was not performed, select "After Replace ECU" or "Manual Configura-
tion" to write vehicle specification. Refer to AV-117, "CONFIGURATION (AV CONTROL UNIT) : Work Pro-
cedure".
>> GO TO 4.
4.OPERATION CHECK
Check that the operation of the AV control unit and camera images (fixed guide lines and predictive course
lines) are normal.
>> Work End.
CONFIGURATION (AV CONTROL UNIT)
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
INSPECTION AND ADJUSTMENT
AV-117
< BASIC INSPECTION >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
CONFIGURATION (AV CONTROL UNIT) : Description INFOID:0000000009174434
Vehicle specification needs to be written with CONSULT because it is not written after replacing AV control
unit.
Configuration has three functions as follows:
CAUTION:
When replacing AV control unit, you must perform Select Saved Data List or "After Replace ECU"
with CONSULT.
Complete the procedure of Select Saved Data List or "After Replace ECU" in order.
If you set incorrect Select Saved Data List or "After Replace ECU", incidents might occur.
Configuration is different for each vehicle model. Confirm configuration of each vehicle model.
Never perform Select Saved Data List or "After Replace ECU" except for new AV control unit.
CONFIGURATION (AV CONTROL UNIT) : Work Procedure INFOID:0000000009174435
1.WRITING MODE SELECTION
CONSULT
Select Reprogramming, Configuration of AV control unit.
When writing saved data>>GO TO 2.
When writing manually>>GO TO 3.
2.PERFORM SAVED DATA LIST
CONSULT
Automatically Operation Log Selection window will display if Before Replace ECU was performed. Select
applicable file from the Save Data List and press Confirm.
>> Work End.
3.PERFORM AFTER REPLACE ECU OR MANUAL CONFIGURATION
CONSULT
1. Select After Replace ECU or Manual Configuration.
2. Identify the correct model and configuration list. Refer to AV-118, "CONFIGURATION (AV CONTROL
UNIT) : Configuration List".
3. Confirm and/or change setting value for each item.
CAUTION:
Thoroughly read and understand the vehicle specification. ECU control may not operate normally
if the setting is not correct.
4. Select Next.
CAUTION:
Make sure to select Next, confirm each setting value and press OK even if the indicated con-
figuration of brand new AV control unit is same as the desirable configuration. If not, configuration
which is set automatically by selecting vehicle model can not be memorized.
5. When "Completed", select "End".
>> GO TO 4.
4.OPERATION CHECK
Confirm that each function controlled by AV control unit operates normally.
Function Description
"Before Replace ECU"
Reads the vehicle configuration of current AV control unit.
Saves the read vehicle configuration.
"After Replace ECU" Writes the vehicle configuration with manual selection.
"Select Saved Data List" Writes the vehicle configuration with saved data.
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-118
< BASIC INSPECTION >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
INSPECTION AND ADJUSTMENT
>> Work End.
CONFIGURATION (AV CONTROL UNIT) : Configuration List INFOID:0000000009174436
CAUTION:
Thoroughly read and understand the vehicle specification. Incorrect settings may result in abnormal
control of ECU.
: Items which confirm vehicle specifications
MANUAL SETTING ITEM
Items Setting value
CAMERA SYSTEM NONE/AVM REAR CAMERA
SOUND SYSTEM BASE BOSE
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
U1000 CAN COMM CIRCUIT
AV-119
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS
U1000 CAN COMM CIRCUIT
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174437
DTC DETECTION LOGIC
Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174438
1.PERFORM SELF DIAGNOSTIC RESULT
1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait for 2 seconds or more.
2. Perform Self Diagnostic Result for MULTI AV.
Is CAN COMM CIRCUIT displayed?
YES >> Refer to LAN-20, "Trouble Diagnosis Flow Chart".
NO >> Refer to GI-49, "Intermittent Incident".
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
CAN COMM CIRCUIT
[U1000]
AV control unit is not transmitting or receiving
CAN communication signal for 2 seconds or
more.
CAN communication system.
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-120
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
U1010 CONTROL UNIT (CAN)
U1010 CONTROL UNIT (CAN)
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174439
DTC DETECTION LOGIC
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
CONTROL UNIT (CAN)
[U1010]
CAN initial diagnosis malfunction is detected.
Replace the AV control unit if the malfunction oc-
curs constantly.
Refer to AV-187, "Removal and Installation".
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
U1200 AV CONTROL UNIT
AV-121
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
U1200 AV CONTROL UNIT
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174440
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
CONT UNIT
[U1200]
AV control unit malfunction is detected.
Replace the AV control unit if the malfunction oc-
curs constantly.
Refer to AV-187, "Removal and Installation".
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-122
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
U1216 AV CONTROL UNIT
U1216 AV CONTROL UNIT
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174441
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
CAN CONT
[U1216]
AV control unit malfunction is detected.
Replace the AV control unit if the malfunction occurs
constantly.
Refer to AV-187, "Removal and Installation".
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
U1218 AV CONTROL UNIT
AV-123
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
U1218 AV CONTROL UNIT
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174442
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
HDD CONN
[U1218]
AV control unit malfunction is detected.
If the hard disk drive (HDD) is functioning normal-
ly, there is a possibility of an intermittent malfunc-
tion.
Replace AV control unit if malfunction occurs con-
stantly.
Refer to AV-187, "Removal and Installation".
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-124
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
U1219 AV CONTROL UNIT
U1219 AV CONTROL UNIT
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174443
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
HDD READ
[U1219]
AV control unit malfunction is detected.
If the hard disk drive (HDD) is functioning normal-
ly, there is a possibility of an intermittent malfunc-
tion.
Replace AV control unit if malfunction occurs con-
stantly.
Refer to AV-187, "Removal and Installation".
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
U121A AV CONTROL UNIT
AV-125
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
U121A AV CONTROL UNIT
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174444
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
HDD WRITE
[U121A]
AV control unit malfunction is detected.
If the hard disk drive (HDD) is functioning normal-
ly, there is a possibility of an intermittent malfunc-
tion.
Replace AV control unit if malfunction occurs con-
stantly.
Refer to AV-187, "Removal and Installation".
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-126
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
U121B AV CONTROL UNIT
U121B AV CONTROL UNIT
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174445
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
HDD COMM
[U121B]
AV control unit malfunction is detected.
If the hard disk drive (HDD) is functioning normal-
ly, there is a possibility of an intermittent malfunc-
tion.
Replace AV control unit if malfunction occurs con-
stantly.
Refer to AV-187, "Removal and Installation".
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
U121C AV CONTROL UNIT
AV-127
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
U121C AV CONTROL UNIT
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174446
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
HDD ACCESS
[U121C]
AV control unit malfunction is detected.
If the hard disk drive (HDD) is functioning normal-
ly, there is a possibility of an intermittent malfunc-
tion.
Replace AV control unit if malfunction occurs con-
stantly.
Refer to AV-187, "Removal and Installation".
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-128
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
U121D AV CONTROL UNIT
U121D AV CONTROL UNIT
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174447
Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174448
1.CHECK CD PLAYBACK
Check the CD playback operation of the AV control unit. Refer to Owners Manual for audio system operating
instructions.
Is the CD playback function of the AV control unit operating normally?
YES >> Refer to GI-49, "Intermittent Incident".
NO >> Replace AV control unit. Refer to AV-187, "Removal and Installation".
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
DSP CONN
[U121D]
AV control unit malfunction is detected.
An intermittent error causing disc player malfunc-
tion may be detected.
Replace AV control unit if malfunction occurs con-
stantly.
Refer to AV-187, "Removal and Installation".
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
U121E AV CONTROL UNIT
AV-129
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
U121E AV CONTROL UNIT
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174449
Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174450
1.CHECK CD PLAYBACK
Check the CD playback operation of the AV control unit. Refer to Owners Manual for audio system operating
instructions.
Is the CD playback function of the AV control unit operating normally?
YES >> Refer to GI-49, "Intermittent Incident".
NO >> Replace AV control unit. Refer to AV-187, "Removal and Installation".
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
DSP COMM
[U121E]
AV control unit malfunction is detected.
An intermittent error causing disc player malfunc-
tion may be detected.
Replace AV control unit if malfunction occurs con-
stantly.
Refer to AV-187, "Removal and Installation".
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-130
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
U1225 AV CONTROL UNIT
U1225 AV CONTROL UNIT
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174451
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
USB CONTROLLER
[U1225]
USB connection malfunction is detected.
Check that connection to USB connector is nor-
mal.
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
U1227 AV CONTROL UNIT
AV-131
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
U1227 AV CONTROL UNIT
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174452
Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174453
1.CHECK DVD PLAYBACK
Check the DVD playback operation of the AV control unit. Refer to Owners Manual for audio system operating
instructions.
Is the DVD playback function of the AV control unit operating normally?
YES >> Refer to GI-49, "Intermittent Incident".
NO >> Replace AV control unit. Refer to AV-187, "Removal and Installation".
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
DVD COMM
[U1227]
AV control unit malfunction is detected.
An intermittent error causing disc player malfunc-
tion may be detected.
Replace AV control unit if malfunction occurs con-
stantly.
Refer to AV-187, "Removal and Installation".
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-132
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
U1228 AV CONTROL UNIT
U1228 AV CONTROL UNIT
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174454
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
SUB CPU CONN
[U1228]
AV control unit malfunction is detected.
Replace AV control unit if malfunction occurs con-
stantly.
Refer to AV-187, "Removal and Installation".
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
U1229 AV CONTROL UNIT
AV-133
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
U1229 AV CONTROL UNIT
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174455
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
iPod CERTIFICATION
[U1229]
AV control unit malfunction is detected.
Replace AV control unit if malfunction occurs con-
stantly.
Refer to AV-187, "Removal and Installation".
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-134
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
U122A AV CONTROL UNIT
U122A AV CONTROL UNIT
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174456
Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174457
1.PERFORM CONFIGURATION
When U122A is detected, configuration data must be written.
>> Write configuration data with CONSULT. Refer to AV-117, "CONFIGURATION (AV CONTROL
UNIT) : Work Procedure".
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
CONFIG UNFINISH
[U122A]
Configuration data is incomplete.
Write configuration data.
Refer to AV-117, "CONFIGURATION (AV CON-
TROL UNIT) : Work Procedure".
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
U122E AV CONTROL UNIT
AV-135
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
U122E AV CONTROL UNIT
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174458
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
Built-in AUDIO CONN
[U122E]
AV control unit malfunction is detected.
Replace AV control unit if malfunction occurs con-
stantly.
Refer to AV-187, "Removal and Installation".
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-136
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
U1243 DISPLAY UNIT
U1243 DISPLAY UNIT
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174459
Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174460
Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-88, "Wiring Diagram".
1.CHECK DISPLAY UNIT POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT
Check display unit power supply and ground circuits. Refer to AV-144, "AV CONTROL UNIT : Diagnosis Pro-
cedure".
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 2.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
2.CHECK COMMUNICATION CIRCUIT CONTINUITY
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect display unit connector and AV control unit connector M136.
3. Check continuity between display unit connector M93 terminals 11, 22 and AV control unit connector
M136 terminals 73, 61.
4. Check continuity between display unit connector M93 terminals 11, 22 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 3.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
3.CHECK COMMUNICATION SIGNAL (DISPCONT)
1. Connect display unit connector and AV control unit connector M136.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check signal between display unit connector M93 terminal 11 and ground.
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
FRONT DISP CONN
[U1243]
When any of the following is detected:
display unit power supply or ground circuit mal-
function.
serial communication circuit malfunction be-
tween display unit and AV control unit.
Display unit power supply and ground circuits.
Serial communication circuits between display
unit and AV control unit.
Display unit AV control unit
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
M93
11
M136
73
Yes
22 61
Display unit
Ground Continuity
Connector Terminal
M93
11
No
22
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
U1243 DISPLAY UNIT
AV-137
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 4.
NO >> Replace AV control unit. Refer to AV-187, "Removal and Installation".
4.CHECK COMMUNICATION SIGNAL (CONTDISP)
Check signal between display unit connector M93 terminal 22 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> Inspection End.
NO >> Replace display unit. Refer to AV-191, "Removal and Installation".
Display unit Ground
Condition Reference value (+)
()
Connector Terminal
M93 11
When adjusting dis-
play brightness.
PKIB5039J
Display unit Ground
Condition Reference value (+)
()
Connector Terminal
M93 22
When adjusting dis-
play brightness.
PKIB5039J
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-138
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
U1255 SATELLITE RADIO TUNER
U1255 SATELLITE RADIO TUNER
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174461
Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174462
Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-88, "Wiring Diagram".
1.CHECK SATELLITE RADIO TUNER POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT
Check satellite radio tuner power supply and ground circuit. Refer to AV-146, "SATELLITE RADIO TUNER :
Diagnosis Procedure".
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 2.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
2.CHECK COMMUNICATION CIRCUIT AND REQUEST SIGNAL CIRCUIT CONTINUITY
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect AV control unit connector M138 and satellite radio tuner connector B2.
3. Check continuity between AV control unit connector M138 terminals 100, 101, 102 and satellite radio
tuner connector B2 terminals 28, 29, 30.
4. Check continuity between AV control unit connector M138 terminals 100, 101, 102 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 3.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
3.CHECK AV CONTROL UNIT VOLTAGE
1. Connect AV control unit connector M138.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check voltage between AV control unit connector M138 terminals 100, 101 and ground.
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
SAT CONN
[U1255]
When any of the following is detected:
satellite radio tuner power supply or ground circuit
malfunction.
communication circuit malfunction between AV
control unit and satellite radio tuner.
request signal circuit malfunction between AV
control unit and satellite radio tuner.
Satellite radio tuner power supply and ground cir-
cuits.
Communication circuits between AV control unit
and satellite radio tuner.
Request signal circuits between AV control unit
and satellite radio tuner.
AV control unit Satellite radio tuner
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
M138
100
B2
28
Yes 101 29
102 30
AV control unit
Ground
Continuity
Connector Terminal
M138
100
No 101
102
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
U1255 SATELLITE RADIO TUNER
AV-139
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 4.
NO >> Replace AV control unit. Refer to AV-187, "Removal and Installation".
4.CHECK SATELLITE RADIO TUNER VOLTAGE
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect AV control unit connector M138.
3. Connect satellite radio tuner connector B2.
4. Turn ignition switch ON.
5. Check voltage between satellite radio tuner connector B2 terminal 32 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> Inspection End.
NO >> Replace satellite radio tuner. Refer to AV-199, "Removal and Installation".
AV control unit Ground
Voltage
(Approx.)
(+)
()
Connector Terminal
M138
100
7.0 V
101
Satellite radio tuner Ground
Voltage
(Approx.)
(+)
()
Connector Terminal
B2 32 7.0 V
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-140
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
U1263 USB
U1263 USB
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174463
Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174464
1.CHECK USB INTERFACE HARNESS
Visually inspect USB interface harness.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 2.
NO >> Replace USB interface harness. Refer to AV-195, "Removal and Installation".
2.CHECK USB INTERFACE HARNESS CONTINUITY
Check USB interface harness continuity. Refer to AV-140, "Diagnosis Procedure".
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> Replace AV control unit. Refer to AV-187, "Removal and Installation".
NO >> Replace USB interface harness. Refer to AV-195, "Removal and Installation".
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
USB OVERCURRENT
[U126]
Overcurrent in USB connector is detected.
Check USB harness between the AV control unit
and USB connector.
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
U1264 ANTENNA AMP.
AV-141
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
U1264 ANTENNA AMP.
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174465
Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174466
Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-88, "Wiring Diagram".
1.CHECK CONTINUITY BETWEEN AV CONTROL UNIT AND ANTENNA BASE
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect AV control unit connector M155 and antenna base connector M502.
3. Check continuity between AV control unit connector M155 and antenna base connector M502.
4. Check continuity between AV control unit connector M155 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 2.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
2.CHECK AV CONTROL UNIT VOLTAGE
1. Connect AV control unit connector M155.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check voltage between AV control unit connector M155 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> Replace antenna base. Refer to AV-204, "Removal and Installation".
NO >> Replace AV control unit. Refer to AV-187, "Removal and Installation".
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
ANTENNA AMP TERMINAL
[U1264]
Antenna amp. ON signal circuit open or short cir-
cuited.
Antenna amp. ON signal circuit between AV con-
trol unit and antenna amp.
AV control unit Antenna base
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
M155 126 M502 1 Yes
AV control unit
Ground Continuity
Connector Terminal
M155 126 No
AV control unit Ground
Voltage
(Approx.)
(+)
()
Connector Terminal
M155 126 Battery voltage
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-142
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
U1300 AV COMM CIRCUIT
U1300 AV COMM CIRCUIT
Description INFOID:0000000009174467
U1300 is indicated when a malfunction occurs in the communication signal of the multi AV system. Indicated
simultaneously, without fail, the malfunction of control units connected to the AV control unit through communi-
cation circuits. Determine the possible malfunction cause from the table below.
SELF-DIAGNOSIS RESULTS DISPLAY ITEM
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
AV COMM CIRCUIT
[U1300]
SWITCH CONN
[U1240]
When any of the following is detected:
A/C and AV switch assembly power supply or
ground circuit malfunction.
AV communication circuit malfunction between
AV control unit and A/C and AV switch assem-
bly.
A/C and AV switch assembly power supply and
ground circuits.
AV communication circuits between AV control
unit and A/C and AV switch assembly.
AV COMM CIRCUIT
[U1300]
HAND FREE CONN
[U1256]
When any of the following is detected:
Bluetooth
control unit.
Bluetooth
control unit.
AV COMM CIRCUIT
[U1300]
SWITCH CONN
[U1240]
HAND FREE CONN
[U1256]
AV communication circuit malfunction between AV
control unit and A/C and AV switch assembly.
AV communication circuits between AV control unit
and A/C and AV switch assembly.
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
U1310 AV CONTROL UNIT
AV-143
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
U1310 AV CONTROL UNIT
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174468
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
CONTROL UNIT (AV)
[U1310]
An initial diagnosis error is detected in AV com-
munication circuit.
Replace the AV control unit if the malfunction occurs
constantly.
Refer to AV-187, "Removal and Installation".
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-144
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT
POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT
AV CONTROL UNIT
AV CONTROL UNIT : Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174469
Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-88, "Wiring Diagram".
1.CHECK FUSE
Check that the following fuses are not blown.
Are the fuses blown?
YES >> Replace the blown fuse after repairing the affected circuit.
NO >> GO TO 2.
2.CHECK POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect AV control unit connectors M124 and M125.
3. Check voltage between AV control unit connectors and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 3.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
3.CHECK GROUND CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Check continuity between AV control unit connector M125 terminal 52 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> Inspection End.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
DISPLAY UNIT
DISPLAY UNIT : Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174470
Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-88, "Wiring Diagram".
1.CHECK INVERTER VCC AND SIGNAL VCC (POWER SUPPLY) CIRCUIT 1
Terminal No. Signal name Fuse No.
29 Ignition signal 29 (5A)
39 ACC power supply 65 (10A)
51 Battery power supply 15 (15A)
AV control unit
Ground Condition
Voltage
(Approx.)
Connector Terminal
M124 29
Ignition switch: ON
Battery voltage
M125
39 Ignition switch: ACC
51 Ignition switch: OFF
AV control unit
Ground Continuity
Connector Terminal
M125 52 Yes
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT
AV-145
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
Check voltage between display unit harness connector M93 terminals 2, 3 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 4.
NO >> GO TO 2.
2.CHECK INVERTER VCC AND SIGNAL VCC (POWER SUPPLY) CIRCUIT CONTINUITY
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect AV control unit connector M136 and display unit connector.
3. Check continuity between AV control unit connector M136 terminals 64, 76 and display unit connector
M93 terminals 3, 2.
4. Check continuity between AV control unit connector M136 terminals 64, 76 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 3.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
3.CHECK INVERTER VCC AND SIGNAL VCC (POWER SUPPLY) CIRCUIT 2
1. Connect the AV control unit connector M45.
2. Check voltage between AV control unit connector M136 terminals 64, 76 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> Inspection End.
NO >> Replace AV control unit. Refer to AV-187, "Removal and Installation".
4.CHECK INVERTER GROUND AND SIGNAL GROUND CIRCUIT CONTINUITY
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect AV control unit connector M45 and display unit connector.
3. Check continuity between AV control unit connector M136 terminals 63, 75 and display unit connector
M93 terminals 14, 13.
Display unit
Ground Condition
Voltage
(Approx.)
Connector Terminal
M93
2
Ignition switch: ACC 9.0 V
3
AV control unit Display unit
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
M136
64
M93
3
Yes
76 2
AV control unit
Ground Continuity
Connector Terminal
M136
64
No
76
AV control unit Ground
Condition
Voltage
(Approx.)
(+)
()
Connector Terminal
M136
64
Ignition switch: ACC 9.0 V
76
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-146
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 5.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
5.CHECK DISPLAY UNIT GROUND CIRCUIT
Check continuity between display unit connector M93 terminal 1 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> Inspection End.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
SATELLITE RADIO TUNER
SATELLITE RADIO TUNER : Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174471
Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-88, "Wiring Diagram".
1.CHECK FUSE
Check that the following fuses are not blown.
Are the fuses blown?
YES >> Replace the blown fuse after repairing the affected circuit.
NO >> GO TO 2.
2.CHECK POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect satellite radio tuner connector B2.
3. Check voltage between satellite radio tuner connector B2 terminal 32, 36 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 3.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
3.CHECK GROUND CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Check continuity between satellite radio tuner connector B2 terminal 35 and ground.
AV control unit Display unit
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
M136
63
M93
14
Yes
75 13
Display unit
Ground Continuity
Connector Terminal
M93 1 Yes
Terminal No. Signal name Fuse No.
32 Battery power supply 15 (15A)
36 ACC power supply 65 (10A)
Satellite radio tuner
Ground Condition
Voltage
(Approx.)
Connector Terminal
B2
32
control unit
Ground Condition
Voltage
(Approx.)
Connector Terminal
B3
1
control unit
Ground Continuity
Connector Terminal
B3
4
Yes
20
22
24
27
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-148
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> Inspection End.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
A/C AND AV SWITCH ASSEMBLY
A/C AND AV SWITCH ASSEMBLY : Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174473
Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-88, "Wiring Diagram".
1.CHECK FUSE
Check that the following fuse is not blown.
Is the fuse blown?
YES >> Replace the blown fuse after repairing the affected circuit.
NO >> GO TO 2.
2.CHECK POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect A/C and AV switch assembly connector.
3. Check voltage between A/C and AV switch assembly connector M98 terminal 3 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 3.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
3.CHECK CONTROL UNIT GROUND CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect AV control unit connector M124.
3. Check continuity between A/C and AV switch assembly connector M98 terminal 9 and AV control unit con-
nector M124 terminal 10.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 4.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
4.CHECK SWITCH GROUND CIRCUIT
Check continuity between A/C and AV switch assembly connector M98 terminal 1 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> Inspection End.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
Terminal No. Signal name Fuse No.
3 ACC power supply 65 (10A)
A/C and AV switch assembly
Ground Condition
Voltage
(Approx.)
Connector Terminal
M98 3 Ignition switch: ACC Battery voltage
A/C and AV switch assembly AV control unit
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
M98 9 M124 10 Yes
A/C and AV switch assembly
Ground Continuity
Connector Terminal
M98 1 Yes
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
FRONT DOOR SPEAKER
AV-149
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
FRONT DOOR SPEAKER
Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174474
Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-88, "Wiring Diagram".
1.CONNECTOR CHECK
Check the AV control unit and speaker connectors for the following:
Proper connection
Damage
Disconnected or loose terminals
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 2
NO >> Repair the terminals or connectors.
2.CHECK FRONT DOOR SPEAKER SIGNAL CIRCUIT CONTINUITY
1. Disconnect AV control unit connector M125 and suspect front door speaker connector.
2. Check continuity between AV control unit connector M125 and suspect front door speaker connector.
3. Check continuity between AV control unit connector M125 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 3
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
3.CHECK FRONT DOOR SPEAKER SIGNAL
1. Connect AV control unit connector M125 and suspect front door speaker connector.
2. Turn ignition switch to ACC.
3. Push AV control unit POWER switch.
4. Check the signal between the terminals of AV control unit connector M125.
AV control unit Front door speaker
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
M125
34
D12 (LH)
1
Yes
35 2
43
D112 (RH)
1
44 2
AV control unit
Ground Continuity
Connector Terminal
M125
34
No
35
43
44
AV control unit connector M125
Condition Reference value (+) ()
Terminal Terminal
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-150
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
FRONT DOOR SPEAKER
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> Replace front door speaker. Refer to AV-192, "Removal and Installation".
NO >> Replace AV control unit. Refer to AV-187, "Removal and Installation".
34 35
Audio signal output
43 44
SKIB3609E
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
INSTRUMENT PANEL SPEAKER/TWEETER
AV-151
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
INSTRUMENT PANEL SPEAKER/TWEETER
Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174475
Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-88, "Wiring Diagram".
1.CONNECTOR CHECK
Check the AV control unit and speaker connectors for the following:
Proper connection
Damage
Disconnected or loose terminals
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 2
NO >> Repair the terminals or connectors.
2.CHECK INSTRUMENT PANEL TWEETER SIGNAL CIRCUIT CONTINUITY
1. Disconnect AV control unit connector M125 and suspect instrument panel tweeter connector.
2. Check continuity between AV control unit connector M125 and suspect instrument panel tweeter connec-
tor.
3. Check continuity between AV control unit connector M125 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 3
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
3.CHECK INSTRUMENT PANEL TWEETER SIGNAL
1. Connect AV control unit connector M125 and suspect instrument panel tweeter connector.
2. Turn ignition switch to ACC.
3. Push AV control unit POWER switch.
4. Check the signal between the terminals of AV control unit connector M125.
AV control unit Instrument panel tweeter
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
M125
34
M62 (LH)
1
Yes
35 2
43
M73 (RH)
1
44 2
AV control unit
Ground Continuity
Connector Terminal
M125
34
No
35
43
44
AV control unit connector M125
Condition Reference value (+) ()
Terminal Terminal
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-152
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
INSTRUMENT PANEL SPEAKER/TWEETER
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> Replace instrument panel tweeter. Refer to AV-193, "Removal and Installation".
NO >> Replace AV control unit. Refer to AV-187, "Removal and Installation".
34 35
Audio signal output
43 44
SKIB3609E
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
REAR DOOR SPEAKER
AV-153
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
REAR DOOR SPEAKER
Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174476
Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-88, "Wiring Diagram".
1.CONNECTOR CHECK
Check the AV control unit and speaker connectors for the following:
Proper connection
Damage
Disconnected or loose terminals
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 2
NO >> Repair the terminals or connectors.
2.CHECK REAR DOOR SPEAKER SIGNAL CIRCUIT CONTINUITY
1. Disconnect AV control unit connector M125 and suspect rear door speaker connector.
2. Check continuity between AV control unit connector M125 and suspect rear door speaker connector.
3. Check continuity between AV control unit connector M125 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 3
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
3.CHECK REAR DOOR SPEAKER SIGNAL
1. Connect AV control unit connector M125 and suspect rear door speaker connector.
2. Turn ignition switch to ACC.
3. Push AV control unit POWER switch.
4. Check the signal between the terminals of AV control unit connector M125.
AV control unit Rear door speaker
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
M125
36
D206 (LH)
1
Yes
37 2
45
D306 (RH)
1
46 2
AV control unit
Ground Continuity
Connector Terminal
M125
36
No
37
45
46
AV control unit connector M125
Condition Reference value (+) ()
Terminal Terminal
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-154
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
REAR DOOR SPEAKER
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> Replace rear door speaker. Refer to AV-194, "Removal and Installation".
NO >> Replace AV control unit. Refer to AV-187, "Removal and Installation".
36 37
Audio signal output
45 46
SKIB3609E
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
FRONT AUXILIARY INPUT JACK AUDIO SIGNAL CIRCUIT
AV-155
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
FRONT AUXILIARY INPUT JACK AUDIO SIGNAL CIRCUIT
Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174477
Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-88, "Wiring Diagram".
1.CHECK AUX SOUND SIGNAL CIRCUIT CONTINUITY
1. Turn ignition OFF.
2. Disconnect AV control unit connector M124 and front auxiliary input jacks connector.
3. Check continuity between AV control unit connector M124 and front auxiliary input jacks connector.
4. Check continuity between AV control unit connector M124 and ground.
Is inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 2.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
2.CHECK AUX SOUND SIGNAL GROUND CIRCUIT CONTINUITY
Check continuity between AV control unit connector M124 and front auxiliary input jacks connector.
Is inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 3.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
3.CHECK AUX SOUND SIGNAL
1. Connect AV control unit connector M124 and front auxiliary input jacks connector.
2. Turn ignition switch to ACC.
3. Select AUX mode.
4. Check signals between AV control unit connector M124 and ground.
AV control unit Front auxiliary input jacks
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
M124
20
M205
1
Yes
21 3
AV control unit
Ground Continuity
Connector Terminal
M124
20
No
21
AV control unit Front auxiliary input jacks
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
M124 22 M205 2 Yes
AV control unit connector M124 Condition Reference value
(+) ()
Terminal Terminal
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-156
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
FRONT AUXILIARY INPUT JACK AUDIO SIGNAL CIRCUIT
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> Replace front auxiliary input jacks. Refer to AV-196, "Removal and Installation".
NO >> Replace AV control unit. Refer to AV-187, "Removal and Installation".
20 22
AUX mode selected
21 22
SKIB3609E
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
SATELLITE AUDIO SIGNAL CIRCUIT
AV-157
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
SATELLITE AUDIO SIGNAL CIRCUIT
Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174478
Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-88, "Wiring Diagram".
1.CHECK SATELLITE SOUND SIGNAL CIRCUIT CONTINUITY
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect AV control unit connector M138 and satellite radio tuner connector B2.
3. Check continuity between AV control unit connector M138 and satellite radio tuner connector B2.
4. Check continuity between AV control unit connector M138 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 2.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
2.CHECK SATELLITE SOUND SIGNAL GROUND CIRCUIT CONTINUITY
Check continuity between AV control unit connector M138 and satellite radio tuner connector B2.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 3.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
3.CHECK SATELLITE SOUND SIGNAL
1. Connect AV control unit connector M138 and satellite radio tuner connector B2.
2. Turn ignition switch to ACC.
3. Select satellite radio mode.
4. Check the signal between the terminals of AV control unit connector M138.
AV control unit Satellite radio tuner
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
M138
94
B2
22
Yes
96 24
AV control unit
Ground
Continuity
Connector Terminal
M138
94
No
96
AV control unit Satellite radio tuner
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
M138
93
B2
21
Yes
95 23
AV control unit connector M138
Condition Reference value (+) ()
Terminal Terminal
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-158
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
SATELLITE AUDIO SIGNAL CIRCUIT
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> Replace satellite radio tuner. Refer to AV-199, "Removal and Installation".
NO >> Replace AV control unit. Refer to AV-187, "Removal and Installation".
94 93
Satellite radio mode selected
96 95
SKIB3609E
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
BLUETOOTH VOICE SIGNAL CIRCUIT
AV-159
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
BLUETOOTH VOICE SIGNAL CIRCUIT
Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174479
Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-88, "Wiring Diagram".
1.CHECK BLUETOOTH
VOICE SIGNAL
1. Connect AV control unit connector M124 and Bluetooth
control unit
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
M124 5 B3 9 Yes
AV control unit
Ground Continuity
Connector Terminal
M124 5 No
AV control unit
Bluetooth
control unit
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
M124 4 B3 10 Yes
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-160
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
BLUETOOTH VOICE SIGNAL CIRCUIT
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> Replace Bluetooth
control unit
Microphone
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
B3
7
R109
6
Yes 8 5
29 3
Bluetooth
control unit
Ground Continuity
Connector Terminal
B3
7
No 8
29
Bluetooth
control unit
Ground Continuity
Connector Terminal
B3
20
Yes
24
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-178
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
STEERING SWITCH
STEERING SWITCH
Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174493
Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-88, "Wiring Diagram".
1.CHECK STEERING WHEEL AUDIO CONTROL SWITCH RESISTANCE
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect combination switch connector M149.
3. Check the resistance between the terminals of combination switch connector M149.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 2.
NO >> Replace steering wheel audio control switch. Refer to AV-190, "Removal and Installation".
2.CHECK HARNESS BETWEEN COMBINATION SWITCH AND COMBINATION METER
1. Disconnect combination meter connector M24 and combination switch connector M30.
2. Check continuity between combination meter connector M24 and combination switch connector M30.
3. Check continuity between combination meter connector M24 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
Combination switch connector M149
Condition
Resistance
(Approx.)
Terminal Terminal
14
17
Depress SOURCE switch. 1
Depress switch.
121
Depress switch.
321
Depress switch.
723
Depress ENTER switch. 2023
15
Depress switch.
1
Depress switch.
121
Depress switch.
321
Depress switch.
723
Depress DISP switch. 2023
Combination meter Combination switch
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
M24
3
M30
24
Yes 24 33
4 31
Combination meter
Ground Continuity
Connector Terminal
M24
3
No 24
4
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
STEERING SWITCH
AV-179
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
YES >> GO TO 3.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
3.CHECK COMBINATION SWITCH
Check continuity between combination switch connectors M30 and M149.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 4.
NO >> Replace spiral cable. Refer to SR-15, "Removal and Installation".
4.CHECK HARNESS BETWEEN COMBINATION METER AND AV CONTROL UNIT
1. Disconnect AV control unit connector M125.
2. Check continuity between combination meter connector M24 and AV control unit connector M125.
3. Check continuity between combination meter connector M24 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 5.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
5.CHECK AV CONTROL UNIT VOLTAGE
1. Connect combination meter connector M125 and AV control unit connector M125.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check the voltage between the terminals of AV control unit connector M125.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> Replace combination meter. Refer to MWI-82, "Removal and Installation".
NO >> Replace AV control unit. Refer to AV-187, "Removal and Installation".
Combination switch
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
M30
24
M149
14
Yes 31 15
33 17
Combination meter AV control unit
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
M24
14
M125
38
Yes 15 48
16 47
Combination meter
Ground Continuity
Connector Terminal
M24
14
No 15
16
AV control unit M125
Voltage
(Approx.)
(+) ()
Terminal Terminal
38
47 5.0 V
48
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-180
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
USB CONNECTOR
USB CONNECTOR
Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174494
Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-88, "Wiring Diagram".
1.CHECK USB INTERFACE HARNESS CONTINUITY
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect AV control unit connector M145 and USB interface connector M209.
3. Check continuity between AV control unit connector M145 and USB interface connector M209.
4. Check continuity between AV control unit connector M145 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> Replace the USB interface. Refer to AV-195, "Removal and Installation".
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
AV control unit USB interface
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
M145
121
M209
2
Yes
122 1
123 4
124 3
125 5
AV control unit
Continuity
Connector Terminal
M145
121
Ground No
123
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
MULTI AV SYSTEM
AV-181
< SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS
MULTI AV SYSTEM
Symptom Table INFOID:0000000009174495
RELATED TO AUDIO
Symptoms Check items Probable malfunction location
The disk cannot be removed. AV control unit
Malfunction in AV control unit.
Refer to AV-63, "On Board Diagnosis Func-
tion".
No sound comes out or the level of the
sound is low.
No sound from all speakers.
Speaker circuit shorted to ground.
Refer to AV-88, "Wiring Diagram".
AV control unit power supply and ground
circuits malfunction.
Refer to AV-149, "Diagnosis Procedure".
Only a certain speaker (front door speaker
LH, front door speaker RH, front instrument
panel tweeter LH, front instrument panel
tweeter RH, rear door speaker LH, rear
door speaker RH) does not output sound.
Poor connector connection of speaker.
Sound signal circuit malfunction between
AV control unit and speaker.
Refer to:
- AV-149, "Diagnosis Procedure" (front
door speaker).
- AV-151, "Diagnosis Procedure" (front in-
strument panel tweeter).
- AV-153, "Diagnosis Procedure" (rear
door speaker).
Malfunction in speaker.
Refer to:
- AV-192, "Removal and Installation" (front
door speaker).
- AV-193, "Removal and Installation" (front
instrument panel tweeter).
- AV-194, "Removal and Installation" (rear
door speaker).
Malfunction in AV control unit.
Refer to AV-63, "On Board Diagnosis
Function".
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-182
< SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
MULTI AV SYSTEM
RELATED TO HANDS-FREE PHONE
Before performing diagnosis, confirm that the cellular phone being used by the customer is compatible with
the vehicle.
It is possible that a malfunction is occurring due to a version change of the phone even though the phone is
a compatible type. This can be confirmed by changing the cellular phone to another compatible type, and
check that it operates normally. It is important to determine whether the cause of the malfunction is the vehi-
cle or the cellular phone.
Noise is mixed with audio.
Noise comes out from all speakers.
Malfunction in AV control unit.
Refer to AV-63, "On Board Diagnosis Func-
tion".
Noise comes out only from a certain speak-
er (front door speaker LH, front door speak-
er RH, front instrument panel tweeter LH,
front instrument panel tweeter RH, rear
door speaker LH, rear door speaker RH).
Poor connector connection of speaker.
Sound signal circuit malfunction between
AV control unit and speaker.
Refer to:
- AV-149, "Diagnosis Procedure" (front
door speaker).
- AV-151, "Diagnosis Procedure" (front in-
strument panel tweeter).
- AV-153, "Diagnosis Procedure" (rear
door speaker).
Malfunction in speaker.
Poor Installation of speaker (e.g. back-
lash and looseness).
Refer to:
- AV-192, "Removal and Installation" (front
door speaker).
- AV-193, "Removal and Installation" (front
instrument panel tweeter).
- AV-194, "Removal and Installation" (rear
door speaker).
Malfunction in AV control unit.
Refer to AV-63, "On Board Diagnosis
Function".
Noise is mixed with radio only (when the ve-
hicle hits a bump or while driving over bad
roads)
Poor connector connection of antenna or
antenna feeder.
Refer to AV-201, "Location of Antennas".
No radio reception or poor reception.
Other audio sounds are normal.
Any radio station cannot be received or
poor reception is caused even after mov-
ing to a service area with good reception
(e.g. a place with clear view and no ob-
stacles generating external noises).
Antenna amp. ON signal circuit malfunc-
tion.
Poor connector connection of antenna or
antenna feeder.
Refer to AV-201, "Location of Antennas".
No satellite radio reception.
There is malfunction in the CONSULT self
diagnosis result.
Refer to AV-70, "CONSULT Function".
Malfunction in antenna, antenna feeder
or AV control unit. Perform DTC diagno-
sis.
Refer to AV-70, "CONSULT Function".
Poor continuity in antenna feeder.
Poor connector connection of antenna or
antenna feeder.
Refer to AV-201, "Location of Antennas".
There is no malfunction in the CONSULT
self diagnosis result.
Refer to AV-70, "CONSULT Function".
Poor continuity in antenna feeder.
Poor connector connection of antenna or
antenna feeder.
Loose satellite radio antenna mounting
nut.
Refer to AV-201, "Location of Antennas".
Buzz/rattle sound from speaker
The majority of buzz/rattle sounds are not
indicative of an issue with the speaker, usu-
ally something nearby the speaker is caus-
ing the buzz/rattle.
Refer to "SQUEAK AND RATTLE TROU-
BLE DIAGNOSIS" in the appropriate interi-
or trim section.
Symptoms Check items Probable malfunction location
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
MULTI AV SYSTEM
AV-183
< SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
Check Compatibility
1. Make sure the customers Bluetooth
wire-
less connection, the battery power of the cellular phone may dis-
charge quicker than usual. The Bluetooth
Hands-Free Phone
System cannot charge cellular phones.
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-186
< SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
NORMAL OPERATING CONDITION
The other partys voice cannot be heard by hands-free phone.
When the radio wave condition is not ideal or ambient sound is too
loud, it may be difficult to hear the other persons voice during a
call.
Poor sound quality.
Do not place the cellular phone in an area surrounded by metal or
far away from the in-vehicle phone module to prevent tone quality
degradation and wireless connection disruption.
Symptom Cause and Counter measure
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
AV CONTROL UNIT
AV-187
< REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
AV CONTROL UNIT
Exploded View INFOID:0000000009174497
Removal and Installation INFOID:0000000009174498
REMOVAL
CAUTION:
Remove battery terminal and AV control unit after a lapse of 30 seconds or more after turning the
ignition switch OFF.
Before replacing AV control unit, perform "READ CONFIGURATION" to save current vehicle specifi-
cation. Refer to AV-118, "CONFIGURATION (AV CONTROL UNIT) : Configuration List".
NOTE:
After the ignition switch is turned OFF, the AV control unit continues operating for approximately 30 seconds.
Therefore, data corruption may occur if battery voltage is cut off within 30 seconds.
1. Disconnect the negative battery terminal. Refer to PG-90, "Removal and Installation".
2. Remove cluster lid C. Refer to IP-22, "CLUSTER LID C : Removal and Installation".
3. Remove the screws, then pull out the AV control unit.
4. Disconnect the harness connectors from the AV control unit and remove.
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
CAUTION:
1. AV control unit bracket (LH) 2. A/C auto amp. 3. AV control unit
4. AV control unit bracket (RH)
ALNIA1436ZZ
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-188
< REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
AV CONTROL UNIT
When replacing AV control unit, perform "WRITE CONFIGURATION". Refer to AV-118, "CONFIGURA-
TION (AV CONTROL UNIT) : Configuration List".
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
A/C AND AV SWITCH ASSEMBLY
AV-189
< REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
A/C AND AV SWITCH ASSEMBLY
Removal and Installation INFOID:0000000009174499
REMOVAL
1. Remove cluster lid C lower. Refer to IP-22, "CLUSTER LID C LOWER : Removal and Installation".
2. Remove the A/C and AV switch assembly lower screws.
3. Release upper pawls and remove A/C and AV switch assembly.
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-190
< REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
STEERING SWITCH
STEERING SWITCH
Exploded View INFOID:0000000009174500
Removal and Installation INFOID:0000000009174501
REMOVAL
NOTE:
The steering switches are serviced as an assembly.
1. Remove steering wheel. Refer to ST-44, "Removal and Installation".
2. Release pawls and remove steering wheel rear finisher (1) from
steering wheel (2).
3. Remove steering switches screws.
4. Remove steering switches (1) from steering wheel (2).
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
1. Steering switches 2. Steering wheel 3. Steering wheel rear finisher
ALOIA0025ZZ
ALOIA0026ZZ
ALOIA0027ZZ
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
DISPLAY UNIT
AV-191
< REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
DISPLAY UNIT
Exploded View INFOID:0000000009174502
Removal and Installation INFOID:0000000009174503
REMOVAL
1. Remove cluster lid D. Refer to IP-24, "Removal and Installation".
2. Remove the display unit screws, then pull out the display unit and bracket.
3. Disconnect the harness connector from the display unit and remove.
4. Remove the display unit bracket screws and the display unit from the display unit bracket (if necessary).
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
1. Display unit 2. Display unit bracket A. Display unit bracket screws
ALNIA1430ZZ
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-192
< REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
FRONT DOOR SPEAKER
FRONT DOOR SPEAKER
Exploded View INFOID:0000000009763103
Removal and Installation INFOID:0000000009763102
REMOVAL
1. Remove the front door finisher. Refer to INT-15, "Removal and Installation".
2. Remove the front door speaker bolts.
3. Pull out the front door speaker from the speaker bracket.
4. Disconnect the harness connector from front door speaker and remove.
5. Remove the speaker bracket bolts and the speaker bracket from front door (if necessary).
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
ALNIA1329ZZ
1. Speaker bracket bolt 2. Front door speaker 3. Speaker bolt
4. Speaker bracket
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
INSTRUMENT PANEL SPEAKER/TWEETER
AV-193
< REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
INSTRUMENT PANEL SPEAKER/TWEETER
Removal and Installation INFOID:0000000009763104
REMOVAL
1. Remove instrument panel tweeter grille. Refer to IP-14, "Exploded View".
2. Remove the bolts (A), then pull out the instrument panel tweeter
(1).
3. Disconnect the harness connector from the instrument panel
tweeter (1) and remove.
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
ALNIA1423ZZ
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-194
< REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
REAR DOOR SPEAKER
REAR DOOR SPEAKER
Exploded View INFOID:0000000009763106
Removal and Installation INFOID:0000000009763105
REMOVAL
1. Remove the rear door finisher. Refer to INT-17, "Removal and Installation".
2. Remove the rear door speaker bolts.
3. Disconnect the harness connector from the rear door speaker and remove.
4. Remove the speaker bracket bolts and the speaker bracket from the rear door (if necessary).
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
1. Speaker bracket bolt 2. Rear door speaker 3. Speaker bolt
4. Speaker bracket
ALNIA1330ZZ
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
USB INTERFACE
AV-195
< REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
USB INTERFACE
Removal and Installation INFOID:0000000009174509
REMOVAL
1. Remove shift selector finisher. Refer to IP-18, "Exploded View".
2. Disconnect the harness connector from the USB interface.
3. Release the pawl from the back of USB interface, then remove USB interface.
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-196
< REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
FRONT AUXILIARY INPUT JACKS
FRONT AUXILIARY INPUT JACKS
Removal and Installation INFOID:0000000009174510
REMOVAL
1. Remove shift selector finisher. Refer to IP-18, "Exploded View".
2. Disconnect the harness connector from the front auxiliary input jack.
3. Remove front auxiliary input jack screws and the front auxiliary input jack.
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
BLUETOOTH CONTROL UNIT
AV-197
< REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
BLUETOOTH CONTROL UNIT
Exploded View INFOID:0000000009174511
Removal and Installation INFOID:0000000009174512
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect the negative battery terminal. Refer to PG-90, "Removal and Installation".
2. Remove satellite radio tuner. Refer to AV-199, "Removal and Installation"
3. Disconnect the harness connectors from bluetooth control unit.
4. Remove bluetooth control unit screws and the bluetooth control unit.
5. Remove the bluetooth antenna screws and the bluetooth antenna.
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
1. Bluetooth control unit 2. Satellite radio tuner (if equipped) 3. Bluetooth antenna
Front
ALNIA1464ZZ
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-198
< REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
MICROPHONE
MICROPHONE
Removal and Installation INFOID:0000000009174513
REMOVAL
1. Remove the front room/map lamp assembly. Refer to INL-58, "Removal and Installation".
2. Remove the microphone (1) from the front room/map lamp
assembly.
CAUTION:
Carefully handle the pawls that retain the microphone to
avoid damaging.
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
NOTE:
Make sure the microphone is firmly secure after installation.
AWNIA2584ZZ
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
SATELLITE RADIO TUNER
AV-199
< REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
SATELLITE RADIO TUNER
Exploded View INFOID:0000000009174514
Removal and Installation INFOID:0000000009174515
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect the negative battery terminal. Refer to PG-90, "Removal and Installation".
2. Remove the luggage side lower finisher (LH). Refer to INT-31, "LUGGAGE SIDE LOWER FINISHER :
Removal and Installation".
3. Disconnect the harness connectors from satellite radio antenna.
4. Remove the screws and the satellite radio tuner.
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
1. Bluetooth control unit (if
equipped)
2. Satellite radio tuner 3. Bluetooth antenna
Front
ALNIA1464ZZ
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-200
< REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
REAR VIEW CAMERA
REAR VIEW CAMERA
Removal and Installation INFOID:0000000009174516
REMOVAL
1. Remove the back door outer finisher. Refer to EXT-43, "Removal and Installation".
2. Remove rear view camera screws (A), then remove rear view
camera (1) from the back door outer finisher (2).
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
ALNIA1427ZZ
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
AUDIO ANTENNA
AV-201
< REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
AUDIO ANTENNA
Location of Antennas INFOID:0000000009174517
Window Antenna Repair INFOID:0000000009174518
ELEMENT CHECK
1. Attach probe circuit tester (ohm setting) to antenna terminal on
each side.
1. Antenna base (satellite antenna and antenna
amp)
2. M502 3. M501
4. M503, M504 5. M505 6. Antenna Feeder
7. M95, M500 8. AV control unit M155
AWNIA2589ZZ
SEL250I
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-202
< REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
AUDIO ANTENNA
When measuring continuity, wrap tin foil around the top of
probe. Then, press the foil against the wire with your finger.
2. If an element is broken, no continuity will exist.
3. To locate a break, move probe along element. Tester indication
will change abruptly when probe passes the broken point.
SEL122R
SEL252I
SEL253I
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
BLUETOOTH ANTENNA
AV-203
< REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
BLUETOOTH ANTENNA
Removal and Installation INFOID:0000000009763973
REMOVAL
1. Remove luggage side lower finisher (LH). Refer to INT-31, "LUGGAGE SIDE LOWER FINISHER :
Removal and Installation".
2. Disconnect the bluetooth antenna harness connector from bluetooth control unit.
3. Remove bolts and the bluetooth antenna from bracket.
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-204
< REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
[MID AUDIO WITHOUT BOSE]
SATELLITE RADIO ANTENNA
SATELLITE RADIO ANTENNA
Removal and Installation INFOID:0000000009174519
REMOVAL
1. Lower headlining (rear). Refer to INT-27, "Removal and Installation".
2. Disconnect harness connector from antenna feeder.
3. Remove nut from satellite antenna (1) and remove.
: Front
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
CAUTION:
If the satellite antenna nut is not tightened to the specified torque, lower sensitivity of the antenna may
be experienced. If the nut is tightened tighter than the specified torque, this will deform the roof panel.
Disassembly and Assembly INFOID:0000000009174520
DISASSEMBLY
Insert a suitable tool into gaps between satellite antenna (2) and the
cover (1), then remove the cover (1) from satellite antenna (2).
ASSEMBLY
Assembly is in the reverse order of disassembly.
AWNIA2587ZZ
ALNIA1335ZZ
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
PRECAUTIONS
AV-205
< PRECAUTION >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
PRECAUTION
PRECAUTIONS
Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) "AIR BAG" and "SEAT BELT
PRE-TENSIONER" INFOID:0000000009174521
The Supplemental Restraint System such as AIR BAG and SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER, used along
with a front seat belt, helps to reduce the risk or severity of injury to the driver and front passenger for certain
types of collision. Information necessary to service the system safely is included in the SR and SB section of
this Service Manual.
WARNING:
To avoid rendering the SRS inoperative, which could increase the risk of personal injury or death in
the event of a collision which would result in air bag inflation, all maintenance must be performed by
an authorized NISSAN/INFINITI dealer.
Improper maintenance, including incorrect removal and installation of the SRS, can lead to personal
injury caused by unintentional activation of the system. For removal of Spiral Cable and Air Bag
Module, see the SR section.
Do not use electrical test equipment on any circuit related to the SRS unless instructed to in this
Service Manual. SRS wiring harnesses can be identified by yellow and/or orange harnesses or har-
ness connectors.
PRECAUTIONS WHEN USING POWER TOOLS (AIR OR ELECTRIC) AND HAMMERS
WARNING:
When working near the Airbag Diagnosis Sensor Unit or other Airbag System sensors with the Igni-
tion ON or engine running, DO NOT use air or electric power tools or strike near the sensor(s) with a
hammer. Heavy vibration could activate the sensor(s) and deploy the air bag(s), possibly causing
serious injury.
When using air or electric power tools or hammers, always switch the Ignition OFF, disconnect the
battery and wait at least three minutes before performing any service.
Cautions in Removing Battery Terminal and AV Control Unit (Models with AV Control
Unit) INFOID:0000000009174522
CAUTION:
Remove battery terminal and AV control unit 30 seconds or more after turning the ignition switch OFF.
NOTE:
After the ignition switch is turned OFF, the AV control unit continues operating for approximately 30 seconds.
Therefore, data corruption may occur if battery voltage is cut off within 30 seconds.
Precaution for Trouble Diagnosis INFOID:0000000009174523
AV COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
Do not apply voltage of 7.0 V or higher to the measurement terminals.
Use the tester with its open terminal voltage being 7.0 V or less.
Be sure to turn ignition switch OFF and disconnect the battery cable from the negative terminal before
checking the circuit.
Precaution for Harness Repair INFOID:0000000009174524
AV COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-206
< PRECAUTION >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
PRECAUTIONS
Solder the repaired parts, and wrap with tape. [Frays of twisted line
must be within 110 mm (4.33 in).]
Do not perform bypass wire connections for the repair parts. (The
spliced wire will become separated and the characteristics of
twisted line will be lost.)
Precaution for Work INFOID:0000000009174525
When removing or disassembling each component, be careful not to damage or deform it. If a component
may be subject to interference, be sure to protect it with a shop cloth.
When removing (disengaging) components with a screwdriver or similar tool, be sure to wrap the component
with a shop cloth or vinyl tape to protect it.
Protect the removed parts with a shop cloth and prevent them from being dropped.
Replace a deformed or damaged clip.
If a part is specified as a non-reusable part, always replace it with a new one.
Be sure to tighten bolts and nuts securely to the specified torque.
After installation is complete, be sure to check that each part works properly.
Follow the steps below to clean components:
- Water soluble dirt:
Dip a soft cloth into lukewarm water, wring the water out of the cloth and wipe the dirty area.
Then rub with a soft, dry cloth.
- Oily dirt:
Dip a soft cloth into lukewarm water with mild detergent (concentration: within 2 to 3%) and wipe the dirty
area.
Then dip a cloth into fresh water, wring the water out of the cloth and wipe the detergent off.
Then rub with a soft, dry cloth.
- Do not use organic solvent such as thinner, benzene, alcohol or gasoline.
- For genuine leather seats, use a genuine leather seat cleaner.
PKIA0306E
PKIA0307E
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
PREPARATION
AV-207
< PREPARATION >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
PREPARATION
PREPARATION
Special Service Tool INFOID:0000000009174526
The actual shapes of Kent-Moore tools may differ from those of special service tools illustrated here.
Commercial Service Tools INFOID:0000000009174527
Tool number
(Kent-Moore No.)
Tool name
Description
(J-46534)
Trim tool set
Removing trim components
AWJIA0483ZZ
(Kent-Moore No.)
Tool name
Description
( )
Power tools
Loosening nuts, screws and bolts
PIIB1407E
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-208
< SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
COMPONENT PARTS
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
COMPONENT PARTS
Component Parts Location INFOID:0000000009174528
AWNIA2805ZZ
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
COMPONENT PARTS
AV-209
< SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
Component Description INFOID:0000000009174529
1. Front tweeter LH 2. Instrument panel tweeter LH 3. Steering switches
4. A/C and AV switch assembly 5. Front tweeter RH 6. Instrument panel tweeter RH
7. Display unit 8. Center speaker 9. AV control unit (view with center stack
removed)
10. Microphone 11. USB interface 12. Front auxiliary input jacks
13. Front door speaker LH 14. Front door speaker RH 15. Rear door speaker LH
16.
Rear door speaker RH
17.
Rear view camera
18.
Bluetooth
control unit
19. Satellite radio tuner 20.
Bluetooth
antenna
21. Subwoofer
22. Bose speaker amp. 23. Rear side speaker LH 24. Rear side speaker RH
ALNIA1446ZZ
Part name Description
AV control unit
Master unit of MULTI AV system.
AV control unit includes audio, USB connection and vehicle status functions.
Connected to MULTI AV system control units via AV communication.
Connected to other vehicle control units via CAN communication to obtain neces-
sary information for vehicle information function.
Inputs signals for driving status recognition (vehicle speed, reverse and parking
brake).
TEL voice signal and voice guidance signal are input from Bluetooth
control unit.
Camera image signal is received and transmitted to display unit.
Display unit
Display image is controlled by AV control unit via serial communication.
Receives power (signal VCC and inverter VCC) from AV control unit.
RGB image signals (RGB image, RGB area and RGB synchronizing) are input
from AV control unit.
Composite image signals are input from AV control unit.
Synchronizing signals (HP, VP) are output to AV control unit.
Front door speaker Outputs low and mid range sounds.
Instrument panel tweeter Outputs high range sounds.
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-210
< SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
COMPONENT PARTS
Rear door speaker Outputs low, mid and high range sounds.
A/C and AV switch assembly
Operation panels are equipped with switches for audio and air conditioner opera-
tions.
Operation signal is transmitted via AV communication to AV control unit.
Disk eject operation signal is performed via hardwire.
Rear view camera
Camera power supply is input from AV control unit.
Vehicle rear view image is transmitted to display unit via AV control unit.
Steering switches
Operations for audio, hands-free phone and voice recognition are possible.
Steering switch signal (operation signal) is output to AV control unit.
Microphone
Used for hands-free phone and voice recognition operation.
Microphone signal is transmitted to Bluetooth
control unit.
Power (Microphone VCC) is supplied from Bluetooth
control unit.
Antenna amp.
Radio signal received by window antenna is amplified and transmitted to AV con-
trol unit.
Power (antenna amp. ON signal) is supplied from AV control unit.
Satellite radio tuner
Inputs satellite radio signal from satellite radio antenna and outputs sound signal
to AV control unit.
Controlled via serial communication (communication signal and request signal) by
AV control unit.
Satellite radio antenna Satellite radio signal is received and transmitted to satellite radio tuner.
Bluetooth
control unit
Inputs TEL voice signal from Bluetooth
control unit.
USB connector USB sound and data input signals are transmitted to AV control unit.
Part name Description
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
SYSTEM
AV-211
< SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
SYSTEM
MULTI AV SYSTEM
MULTI AV SYSTEM : System Diagram INFOID:0000000009174530
MULTI AV SYSTEM : System Description INFOID:0000000009174531
AUDIO SYSTEM
AWNIA2806GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-212
< SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
SYSTEM
The audio system consists of the following components
AV control unit
A/C and AV switch assembly
Display unit
Steering switches
Bose speaker amp.
Instrument panel tweeters
Center speaker
Front tweeters
Front door speakers
Rear door speakers
Rear side speakers
Subwoofer
Antenna
When the audio system is on, radio signals are received by the window antenna. The AV control unit then
sends audio signals to the Bose speaker amp. The Bose speaker amp. amplifies the audio signals before
sending them to the speakers, tweeters and subwoofer.
Refer to Owner's Manual for audio system operating instructions.
SATELLITE RADIO SYSTEM
The satellite radio system consists of the following components
Satellite antenna
Satellite radio tuner
When the satellite radio system is on, radio signals are supplied to the satellite radio tuner from the satellite
antenna. The satellite radio tuner then sends audio signals to the AV control unit.
Refer to Owner's Manual for satellite radio system operating instructions.
HANDS-FREE PHONE SYSTEM
System Operation
NOTE:
Cellular telephones must have their wireless connection set up (paired) before using the Bluetooth
telephone
system.
The Bluetooth
control unit. Different cellular telephones may have different pairing procedures, refer to
the cellular telephone operating manual.
Refer to the Owner's Manual for Bluetooth
Control Unit
When the ignition switch is turned to ACC or ON, the Bluetooth
control unit is initialized and performs various self-checks. Initialization may take up to 20 sec-
onds. If a phone is present in the vehicle and paired with the Bluetooth
telephone functions can be turned off using the Nissan Voice Recognition
system.
Steering Switches
When buttons on the steering switches are pushed, the resistance in steering switch circuits change, depend-
ing on which button is pushed. The Bluetooth
telephone system
Start a voice recognition session
Answer and end telephone calls
Adjust the volume of calls
Microphone
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
SYSTEM
AV-213
< SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
The microphone is located in the roof console assembly. The microphone sends a signal to the Bluetooth
control unit.
Bluetooth
control unit.
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (AV CONTROL UNIT)
AV-217
< SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
2. Select each switch on the Confirmation/Adjustment screen to
display the relevant trouble diagnosis screen. Press the BACK
switch to return to the initial Confirmation/Adjustment screen.
Display Diagnosis
Vehicle Signals
A comparison check can be made of each actual vehicle signal and
the signals recognized by the system.
Speaker Test
AWNIA2562GB
JSNIA2233GB
JSNIA0149GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-218
< SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (AV CONTROL UNIT)
Select Speaker Test to display the Speaker Diagnosis screen. Press
Start to generate a test tone in a speaker. Press Start again to gener-
ate a test tone in the next speaker. Press End to stop the test tones.
Error History
The self diagnosis results are judged depending on whether any error occurs from when Self diagnosis is
selected until the self diagnosis results are displayed.
However, the diagnosis results are judged normal if an error has occurred before the ignition switch is turned
ON and then no error has occurred until the self
diagnosis start. Check the Error Record to detect any error that may have occurred before the self diagnosis
start because of this situation.
The frequency of occurrence is displayed in a count up manner. The actual count up method differs depending
on the error item.
Count up method A
The counter resets to 0 if an error occurs when ignition switch is turned ON. The counter increases by 1 if
the condition is normal at a next ignition ON cycle.
The counter upper limit is 39. Any counts exceeding 39 are ignored. The counter can be reset (no error
record display) with the Delete log switch or CONSULT.
Count up method B
The counter increases by 1 if an error occurs when ignition switch is ON. The counter will not decrease even
if the condition is normal at the next ignition ON cycle.
The counter upper limit is 50. Any counts exceeding 50 are ignored. The counter can be reset (no error
record display) with the Delete log switch or CONSULT.
Error item
Some error items may be displayed simultaneously according to the cause. If some error items are displayed
simultaneously, the detection of the cause can be performed by the combination of display items
JSNIA0150GB
Display type of occur-
rence frequency
Error history display item
Count up method A CAN communication line, control unit (CAN), AV communication line, control unit (AV)
Count up method B Other than the above
JSNIA0151GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (AV CONTROL UNIT)
AV-219
< SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
Camera Cont.
The two functions of Correct Draw Line of Rear view Cam, Con-
firm Configuration are available.
Adjust Offset of Rear view Camera
Error item Description Possible cause
CAN COMM CIRCUIT
CAN communication malfunction is detect-
ed.
Perform diagnosis with CONSULT, then re-
pair the malfunctioning components ac-
cording to diagnosis results. Refer to AV-
221, "CONSULT Function".
CONTROL UNIT (CAN)
CAN initial diagnosis malfunction is detect-
ed.
Replace the AV control unit if the malfunc-
tion occurs constantly. Refer to AV-365,
"Removal and Installation".
CONTROL UNIT (AV)
AV communication circuit initial diagnosis
malfunction is detected.
FLASH-ROM Error Of Control Unit
AV control unit malfunction is detected.
CAN Controller Memory Error
Display Connection Error
When any of the following is detected:
display unit power supply or ground cir-
cuits malfunction.
communication circuit malfunction be-
tween AV control unit and display unit.
Display unit power supply or ground cir-
cuits. Refer to AV-305, "DISPLAY UNIT :
Diagnosis Procedure".
Communication circuits between AV con-
trol unit and display unit. Refer to AV-296,
"Diagnosis Procedure".
XM Connection Error
When any of the following is detected:
satellite radio tuner power supply or
ground circuit malfunction.
communication circuit malfunction be-
tween AV control unit and satellite radio
tuner.
request signal circuit malfunction be-
tween AV control unit and satellite radio
tuner.
Satellite radio tuner power supply or
ground circuits. Refer to AV-308, "SAT-
ELLITE RADIO TUNER : Diagnosis Pro-
cedure".
Communication circuit between AV con-
trol unit and satellite radio tuner. Refer to
AV-298, "Diagnosis Procedure".
Request signal circuit between AV con-
trol unit and satellite radio tuner. Refer to
AV-298, "Diagnosis Procedure".
AV COMM CIRCUIT
Switches Connection Error
When any of the following is detected:
A/C and AV switch assembly power sup-
ply or ground circuit malfunction.
AV communication circuit malfunction
between AV control unit and A/C and AV
switch assembly.
A/C and AV switch assembly power sup-
ply or ground circuits. Refer to AV-310,
"A/C AND AV SWITCH ASSEMBLY : Di-
agnosis Procedure".
AV communication circuits between AV
control unit and A/C and AV switch as-
sembly.
AV COMM CIRCUIT
BTHF Unit Connection Error
When any of the following is detected:
Bluetooth
control unit.
Bluetooth
control unit.
AV COMM CIRCUIT
Switches Connection Error
BTHF Unit Connection Error
AV communication circuit malfunction be-
tween AV control unit and A/C and AV
switch assembly.
AV communication circuits between AV
control unit and A/C and AV switch assem-
bly.
JSNIA2230ZZ
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-220
< SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (AV CONTROL UNIT)
Use this mode to adjust the guide line display position of the rear
view monitor if necessary after removing the rear view monitor
camera.
CAUTION:
After the adjustment, never perform other operations for one
minute.
Factory Configuration Confirmation
Configuration stored in the AV control unit can be checked.
Vehicle CAN Diagnosis
CAN communication status and error counter is displayed.
The error counter displays OK if any malfunction was not
detected in the past and displays 0 if a malfunction is detected. It
increases by 1 if the condition is normal at the next ignition switch
ON cycle. The upper limit of the counter is 39.
The error counter is erased if Reset is pressed.
NOTE:
??? indicates UNKWN.
AV COMM Diagnosis
JSNIA2231ZZ
JSNIA2234ZZ
Items Display (Current)
Malfunction counter
(Past)
Tx(HVAC) OK / ??? OK / 0 39
Rx(ECM) OK / ??? OK / 0 39
Rx(Cluster) OK / ??? OK / 0 39
Rx(BCM) OK / ??? OK / 0 39
Rx(HVAC) OK / ??? OK / 0 39
Rx(USM) OK / ??? OK / 0 39
Rx(VDC) OK / ??? OK / 0 39
Rx(STRG) OK / ??? OK / 0 39
JSNIA2235ZZ
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (AV CONTROL UNIT)
AV-221
< SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
Displays the communication status between AV control unit and
each unit.
The error counter displays OK if any malfunction was not
detected in the past and displays 0 if a malfunction is detected. It
increases by 1 if the condition is normal at the next ignition switch
ON cycle. The upper limit of the counter is 39.
The error counter is erased if Reset is pressed.
NOTE:
??? indicates UNKWN.
Delete Unit Connection Log
Deletes any unit connection records and error records from the AV
control unit memory. (Clear the records of the unit that has been
removed.)
Initialize Settings
User Data Initialization and Accessory Number Initialization are
possible.
CAUTION:
Never perform Accessory Number Initialization except when
configuration is unsuccessful.
Accessory Number Initialization requires configuration. For
details, refer to AV-276, "CONFIGURATION (AV CONTROL
UNIT) : Description".
CONSULT Function INFOID:0000000009174534
CAUTION:
After disconnecting the CONSULT vehicle interface (VI) from the data link connector, the ignition must
be cycled OFF ON (for at least 5 seconds) OFF. If this step is not performed, the BCM may not go
to sleep mode, potentially causing a discharged battery and no-start condition.
CONSULT FUNCTIONS
CONSULT performs the following functions via communication with the AV control unit.
Items
Status
(Current)
Counter
(Past)
C Tx(ITM-SW) OK / ??? OK / 0 39
C Rx(PrimarySW-ITM) OK / ??? OK / 0 39
C Rx(BTHF-ITM) OK / ??? OK / 0 39
JSNIA2505ZZ
JSNIA0154GB
JSNIA2237ZZ
Direct Diagnostic Mode Description
Ecu Identification The AV control unit part number is displayed.
Self Diagnostic Result The AV control unit self diagnostic results are displayed.
Data Monitor The AV control unit input/output data is displayed in real time.
Work support The settings for AV control unit functions can be changed.
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-222
< SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (AV CONTROL UNIT)
ECU IDENTIFICATION
The part number of AV control unit is displayed.
SELF DIAGNOSTIC RESULT
Refer to AV-230, "DTC Index".
DATA MONITOR
CONFIGURATION
Refer to AV-276, "CONFIGURATION (AV CONTROL UNIT) : Description".
CAN DIAG SUPPORT MNTR
Refer to LAN-17, "CAN Diagnostic Support Monitor".
Configuration
The vehicle specification can be read and saved.
The vehicle specification can be written when replacing AV control unit.
CAN Diag Support Mntr
The result of transmit/receive diagnosis of AV communication is displayed.
The result of transmit/receive diagnosis of CAN communication is displayed.
Direct Diagnostic Mode Description
Monitor Item [Unit] Description
VHCL SPD SIG [On/Off]
On: vehicle speed > 0 km/h (0 MPH).
Off: vehicle speed = 0 km/h (0 MPH).
PKB SIG [On/Off]
On: parking brake applied.
Off: parking brake released.
ILLUM SIG [On/Off]
On: optical sensor signal is received.
Off: optical sensor signal is not received.
IGN SIG [On/Off]
On: ignition switch ON.
Off: ignition switch ACC.
REV SIG [On/Off]
On: selector lever in R position.
Off: selector lever in any position other than R.
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (BLUETOOTH CONTROL UNIT)
AV-223
< SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (BLUETOOTH CONTROL UNIT)
Diagnosis Description INFOID:0000000009174535
The Bluetooth
control unit has two diagnostic checks. The first diagnostic check is performed automatically
every ignition cycle during control unit initialization. The second diagnostic check is performed by the techni-
cian using the steering wheel audio control switches prior to trouble diagnosis.
Bluetooth
inquiry check
OPERATION PROCEDURE
1. Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON.
2. Wait for the Bluetooth
antenna open
1. Inspect harness connection.
2. Replace Bluetooth
antenna shorted
Phone/Send for Hands Free System is stuck
Check steering wheel audio control switches. Refer to AV-355, "Diagnosis Proce-
dure".
Phone/End for the Hands Free System is stuck
Microphone test (failed interactive test)
1. Inspect harness between Bluetooth
voice signal
Input
Ignition
switch
ON
During voice guide output
with switch pressed.
6 Shield
10
(V)
Ground Switch ground Ignition switch ON 0 V
SKIB3609E
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
AV CONTROL UNIT
AV-225
< ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
11
(L)
CANH
Input/
Output
12
(P)
CANL
Input/
Output
13
(SB)
AV communication signal
(H)
Input/
Output
14
(LG)
AV communication signal
(L)
Input/
Output
15
(SB)
AV communication signal
(H)
Input/
Output
16
(LG)
AV communication signal
(L)
Input/
Output
20
(W)
22
(B)
AUX sound signal RH Input
Ignition
switch
ON
AUX mode selected.
21
(R)
22
(B)
AUX sound signal LH Input
Ignition
switch
ON
AUX mode selected.
25 Shield
28
(Y)
Ground Disk eject signal Input
Ignition
switch
ON
Pressing eject switch. 0 V
Except above. 5.0 V
29
(LG)
Ground Ignition signal Input Ignition switch ON Battery voltage
30
(R)
Ground Reverse signal Input
Ignition
switch
ON
Selector lever in R position. Battery voltage
Selector lever in any posi-
tion other than R.
0 V
31
(G)
Ground Parking brake signal Input
Ignition
switch
ON
Parking brake applied. 4.5 V
Parking brake released. 0 V
32
(GR)
Ground Vehicle speed signal Input
Ignition
switch
ON
Vehicle speed approx. 40
km/h (25 MPH)
NOTE:
The maximum voltage varies de-
pending on the specification
(destination unit).
Terminal No.
(Wire color)
Description
Condition
Value
(Approx.)
+ Signal name
Input/
Output
SKIB3609E
SKIB3609E
JSNIA0012GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-226
< ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
AV CONTROL UNIT
38
(G)
47
(B)
Steering switch signal A Input
Ignition
switch
ON
Press SOURCE switch 0V
Press switch
1.0V
Press switch
2.0V
Press switch
3.0V
Press ENTER switch 4.0V
Except above 5.0V
39
(P)
Ground ACC power supply Input Ignition switch ACC Battery voltage
41
(R)
Ground Illumination signal Input
Ignition
switch
OFF
Lighting switch OFF 0 V
Lighting switch ON Battery voltage
48
(W)
47
(B)
Steering switch signal B Input
Ignition
switch
ON
Press switch
0V
Press switch
1.0V
Press switch
2.0V
Press switch
3.0V
Press DISP switch 4.0V
Except above 5.0V
51
(Y)
Ground Battery power supply Input Ignition switch OFF Battery voltage
52
(B)
Ground Ground Ignition switch ON 0 V
53
(B)
Ground Composite image signal Output
Ignition
switch
ON
Camera image or AUX im-
age displayed
54
(W)
Ground
Composite image signal
ground
Ignition switch ON 0 V
55
(W)
Ground RGB signal (B: blue) Output
Ignition
switch
ON
Begin Confirmation/Adjust-
ment mode, then select
Color Spectrum Bar
56
(B)
Ground RGB signal (G: green) Output
Ignition
switch
ON
Begin Confirmation/Adjust-
ment mode, then select
Color Spectrum Bar
Terminal No.
(Wire color)
Description
Condition
Value
(Approx.)
+ Signal name
Input/
Output
SKIB2251J
SKIB2237J
SKIB2236J
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
AV CONTROL UNIT
AV-227
< ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
57
(R)
Ground RGB signal (R: red) Output
Ignition
switch
ON
Begin Confirmation/Adjust-
ment mode, then select
Color Spectrum Bar
58
(B)
Ground RGB synchronizing signal Output Ignition switch ON
59 Shield
60
(W)
Ground RGB area (YS) signal Output
Ignition
switch
ON
RGB image displayed 5.0 V
AUX image displayed
61
(B)
Ground
Communication signal
(DISPCONT)
Input
Ignition
switch
ON
Adjusting display bright-
ness
62
(G)
Ground
Horizontal synchronizing
(HP) signal
Input Ignition switch ON
63
(B)
Ground Signal ground Ignition switch OFF 0 V
64
(V)
Ground Signal VCC Output Ignition switch ACC 9.0 V
66 Shield
67 Shield
72 Shield
Terminal No.
(Wire color)
Description
Condition
Value
(Approx.)
+ Signal name
Input/
Output
SKIB2238J
SKIB3603E
PKIB4948J
PKIB5039J
SKIB3601E
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-228
< ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
AV CONTROL UNIT
73
(W)
Ground
Communication signal
(CONTDISP)
Output
Ignition
switch
ON
Adjusting display bright-
ness
74
(R)
Ground
Vertical synchronizing (VP)
signal
Input Ignition switch ON
75
(LG)
Ground Inverter ground Ignition switch OFF 0 V
76
(L)
Ground Inverter VCC Output Ignition switch ACC 9.0 V
82
(B)
Ground Camera image signal Input
Ignition
switch
ON
Camera image displayed
83
(W)
Ground AUX image signal Input
Ignition
switch
ON
AUX image displayed
87
(R)
Ground Camera power supply Output
Ignition
switch
ON
Selector lever in R posi-
tion
6.0 V
88
(W)
Ground Camera ground Ignition switch ON 0 V
89 Shield
90 Shield
91
(B)
Ground AUX image signal ground Ignition switch ON 0 V
94
(B)
93
(W)
Satellite radio sound signal
LH
Input
Ignition
switch
ON
Satellite radio mode select-
ed
Terminal No.
(Wire color)
Description
Condition
Value
(Approx.)
+ Signal name
Input/
Output
PKIB5039J
SKIB3598E
SKIB2251J
SKIB2251J
SKIB3609E
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
AV CONTROL UNIT
AV-229
< ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
96
(G)
95
(R)
Satellite radio sound signal
RH
Input
Ignition
switch
ON
Satellite radio mode select-
ed
97 Shield
98 Shield
100
(W)
Ground
Request signal
(SATCONT)
Input
Ignition
switch
ON
Satellite radio mode select-
ed
101
(R)
Ground
Communication signal
(SATCONT)
Input
Ignition
switch
ON
Satellite radio mode select-
ed
102
(B)
Ground
Communication signal
(CONTSAT)
Output
Ignition
switch
ON
Satellite radio mode select-
ed
108
(B)
114
(W)
Sound signal rear door
speaker RH
Output
Ignition
switch
ON
Audio output
109
(W)
115
(B)
Sound signal front door
speaker and instrument
panel tweeter RH
Output
Ignition
switch
ON
Audio output
110
(SB)
Ground Bose amp. ON signal Output
Ignition
switch
ACC
Battery voltage
Terminal No.
(Wire color)
Description
Condition
Value
(Approx.)
+ Signal name
Input/
Output
SKIB3609E
SKIA9299J
SKIA9300J
SKIA9301J
SKIB3609E
SKIB3609E
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-230
< ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
AV CONTROL UNIT
DTC Index INFOID:0000000009174538
111
(GR)
Shield
112
(B)
118
(W)
Sound signal rear door
speaker LH
Output
Ignition
switch
ON
Audio output
113
(B)
119
(W)
Sound signal front door
speaker and instrument
panel tweeter LH
Output
Ignition
switch
ON
Audio output
121
(W)
V BUS signal
122
(G)
USB ground
123
(L)
USB D+ signal
124
(R)
USB D signal
125 Shield
126
(B)
Antenna amp. ON signal Output Ignition switch ON Battery voltage
127
(B)
AM - FM main Input
128
(B)
FM sub Input
Terminal No.
(Wire color)
Description
Condition
Value
(Approx.)
+ Signal name
Input/
Output
SKIB3609E
SKIB3609E
CONSULT Display Reference Page
U1000: CAN COMM CIRCUIT AV-278, "DTC Logic"
U1010: CONTROL UNIT AV-279, "DTC Logic"
U1200: CONT UNIT AV-280, "DTC Logic"
U1216: CAN CONT AV-281, "DTC Logic"
U1218: HDD CONN AV-282, "DTC Logic"
U1219: HDD READ AV-283, "DTC Logic"
U121A: HDD WRITE AV-284, "DTC Logic"
U121B: HDD COMM AV-285, "DTC Logic"
U121C: HDD ACCESS AV-286, "DTC Logic"
U121D: DSP CONN AV-287, "DTC Logic"
U121E: DSP COMM AV-288, "DTC Logic"
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
AV CONTROL UNIT
AV-231
< ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
U1225: USB CONTROLLER AV-289, "DTC Logic"
U1227: DVD COMM AV-290, "DTC Logic"
U1228: SUB CPU CONN AV-291, "DTC Logic"
U1229: iPod CERTIFICATION AV-292, "DTC Logic"
U122A: CONFIG UNFINISH AV-293, "DTC Logic"
U122E: Built-in AUDIO CONN AV-294, "DTC Logic"
U1231: AMP TEMP AV-295, "DTC Logic"
U1240: SWITCH CONN AV-303, "Description"
U1243: FRONT DISP CONN AV-296, "DTC Logic"
U1255: SAT CONN AV-298, "DTC Logic"
U1256: HAND FREE CONN AV-303, "Description"
U1263: USB OVERCURRENT AV-530, "DTC Logic"
U1264: ANTENNA AMP TERMINAL AV-531, "DTC Logic"
U1265: AMP ON TERMINAL AV-302, "DTC Logic"
U1300: AV COMM CIRCUIT AV-303, "Description"
U1310: CONTROL UNIT AV-304, "DTC Logic"
CONSULT Display Reference Page
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-232
< ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
DISPLAY UNIT
DISPLAY UNIT
Reference Value INFOID:0000000009174539
TERMINAL LAYOUT
PHYSICAL VALUES
AWNIA1727ZZ
Terminal
(Wire color)
Description
Condition
Reference value
(Approx.)
+ Signal name
Input/
Output
1
(B)
Ground Ground
Ignition
switch
ON
0V
2
(L)
Ground Inverter VCC Input
Ignition
switch
ACC
9V
3
(V)
Ground Signal VCC Input
Ignition
switch
ACC
9V
4
(W)
Ground Composite image ground
Ignition
switch
ON
0V
5 Shield
6
(B)
Ground RGB signal (G: green) Input
Ignition
switch
ON
Start Confirmation/Adjust-
ment mode, and then dis-
play color bar by selecting
Color Spectrum Bar on
Display Diagnosis screen.
7 Shield
8
(G)
Ground
Horizontal synchronizing
(HP) signal
Output
Ignition
switch
ON
JSNIA1030ZZ
SKIB3601E
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
DISPLAY UNIT
AV-233
< ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
9
(W)
Ground RGB area (YS) signal Input
Ignition
switch
ON
At RGB image is displayed. 5V
At DVD image is displayed.
11
(W)
Ground
Communication signal
(CONTDISP)
Input
Ignition
switch
ON
When adjusting display
brightness.
13
(LG)
Ground Inverter ground
Ignition
switch
ON
0V
14
(B)
Ground Signal ground
Ignition
switch
ON
0V
15
(B)
Ground Composite image signal Input
Ignition
switch
ON
At rear view camera image
is displayed.
17
(R)
Ground RGB signal (R: red) Input
Ignition
switch
ON
Start Confirmation/Adjust-
ment mode, and then dis-
play color bar by selecting
Color Spectrum Bar on
Display Diagnosis screen.
18
(W)
Ground RGB signal (B: blue) Input
Ignition
switch
ON
Start Confirmation/Adjust-
ment mode, and then dis-
play color bar by selecting
Color Spectrum Bar on
Display Diagnosis screen.
Terminal
(Wire color)
Description
Condition
Reference value
(Approx.)
+ Signal name
Input/
Output
PKIB4948J
PKIB5039J
SKIB2251J
JSNIA1029ZZ
JSNIA1031ZZ
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-234
< ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
DISPLAY UNIT
19
(B)
Ground RGB synchronizing signal Input
Ignition
switch
ON
20
(R)
Ground
Vertical synchronizing (VP)
signal
Output
Ignition
switch
On
21 Shield
22
(B)
Ground
Communication signal
(DISPCONT)
Output
Ignition
switch
ON
When adjusting display
brightness.
23 Shield
Terminal
(Wire color)
Description
Condition
Reference value
(Approx.)
+ Signal name
Input/
Output
SKIB3603E
SKIB3598E
PKIB5039J
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
BOSE AMP.
AV-235
< ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
BOSE AMP.
Reference Value INFOID:0000000009174540
TERMINAL LAYOUT
PHYSICAL VALUES
ALNIA1354ZZ
Terminal
(Wire color)
Description
Condition
Reference value
(Approx.)
+ Signal name
Input/
Output
41
(R)
42
(G)
Sound signal tweeter LH Output
Ignition
switch
ON
Sound output
44
(G)
43
(G)
Sound signal rear speaker
RH
Output
Ignition
switch
ON
Sound output
45
(G)
46
(W)
Sound signal tweeter RH Output
Ignition
switch
ON
Sound output
47
(B)
Ground
Ignition
switch
ON
0 V
50
(LG)
Ground Battery power supply Input
Ignition
switch
OFF
Battery voltage
51
(Y)
Ground Battery power supply Input
Ignition
switch
OFF
Battery voltage
52
(B)
Ground
Ignition
switch
ON
0 V
SKIB3609E
SKIB3609E
SKIB3609E
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-236
< ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
BOSE AMP.
53
(W)
48
(G)
Sound signal rear speaker
LH
Output
Ignition
switch
ON
Sound output
54
(G)
49
(W)
Sound signal rear door
speaker RH
Output
Ignition
switch
ON
Sound output
57
(W)
56
(B)
Sound signal woofer Output
Ignition
switch
ON
Sound output
58
(G)
59
(R)
Sound signal front door
speaker LH
Output
Ignition
switch
ON
Sound output
60
(W)
Ground BOSE amp. ON signal Input
Ignition
switch
ON
Battery voltage
61 Shield
62
(W)
64
(B)
63
(W)
Sound signal rear LH Input
Ignition
switch
ON
Sound output
66
(B)
65
(W)
Sound signal rear RH Input
Ignition
switch
ON
Sound output
Terminal
(Wire color)
Description
Condition
Reference value
(Approx.)
+ Signal name
Input/
Output
SKIB3609E
SKIB3609E
SKIB3609E
SKIB3609E
SKIB3609E
SKIB3609E
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
BOSE AMP.
AV-237
< ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
68
(P)
55
(R)
Sound signal rear door
speaker LH
Output
Ignition
switch
ON
Sound output
69
(P)
70
(R)
Sound signal center speak-
er
Output
Ignition
switch
ON
Sound output
71
(W)
72
(P)
Sound signal front door
speaker RH
Output
Ignition
switch
ON
Sound output
73
(B)
74
(W)
Sound signal front RH Input
Ignition
switch
ON
Sound output
75
(B)
76
(W)
Sound signal front LH Input
Ignition
switch
ON
Sound output
Terminal
(Wire color)
Description
Condition
Reference value
(Approx.)
+ Signal name
Input/
Output
SKIB3609E
SKIB3609E
SKIB3609E
SKIB3609E
SKIB3609E
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-238
< ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
SATELLITE RADIO TUNER
SATELLITE RADIO TUNER
Reference Value INFOID:0000000009174541
PHYSICAL VALUES
AWNIA2563ZZ
Terminal Description
Condition
Reference value
(Approx.)
+ Signal name
Input/
Output
22
(B)
21
(W)
Satellite radio sound signal
LH
Output
Ignition
switch
ON
When satellite radio
mode is selected
24
(G)
23
(R)
Satellite radio sound signal
RH
Output
Ignition
switch
ON
When satellite radio
mode is selected
25 Shield
26 Shield
28
(W)
Ground
Request signal
(SATCONT)
Output
Ignition
switch
ON
When satellite radio
mode is selected
29
(R)
Ground
Communication signal
(SATCONT)
Output
Ignition
switch
ON
When satellite radio
mode is selected
SKIB3609E
SKIB3609E
SKIA9299J
SKIA9300J
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
SATELLITE RADIO TUNER
AV-239
< ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
30
(B)
Ground
Communication signal
(CONTSAT)
Input
Ignition
switch
ON
When satellite radio
mode is selected
32
(SB)
Ground Battery power supply Input
Ignition
switch
OFF
Battery voltage
35
(GR)
Ground Ground
Ignition
switch
ON
0V
36
(BG)
Ground ACC power supply Input
Ignition
switch
ACC
Battery voltage
37
(B)
Satellite antenna
Terminal Description
Condition
Reference value
(Approx.)
+ Signal name
Input/
Output
SKIA9301J
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-240
< ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
BLUETOOTH CONTROL UNIT
BLUETOOTH CONTROL UNIT
Reference Value INFOID:0000000009174542
TERMINAL LAYOUT
PHYSICAL VALUES
AWNIA2564ZZ
Terminal
(wire color)
Description
Condition
Reference value
(Approx.)
+ Signal name
Input/out-
put
1
(Y)
Ground Battery power Input Battery voltage
2
(R)
Ground ACC power Input
Ignition
switch
ACC/ON
Battery voltage
3
(P)
Ground IGN power Input
Ignition
switch
ON/
START
Battery voltage
4
(B)
Ground Ground
Ignition
switch ON
0V
5 Shield
7
(B)
8 MIC in signal Input
9
(W)
10
(B)
Audio out Output
Ignition
switch
ACC/ON
Bluetooth
control
unit sends audio sig-
nal
20
(B)
Ground Ground
Ignition
switch ON
0V
22
(B)
Ground Ground
Ignition
switch ON
0V
24
(B)
Ground Ground
Ignition
switch ON
0V
27
(B)
Ground Ground
Ignition
switch ON
0V
SKIB3609E
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
BLUETOOTH CONTROL UNIT
AV-241
< ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
28
(V)
Ground
Vehicle speed signal
(8-pulse)
Input
Ignition
switch ON
When vehicle speed
is approx. 40 km/h
(25 MPH)
29
(W)
Ground Microphone power Output
Ignition
switch ON
5V
35
(SB)
M-CAN1 (+)
36
(LG)
M-CAN1 (-)
43
(B)
Bluetooth
antenna
44 Shield
Terminal
(wire color)
Description
Condition
Reference value
(Approx.)
+ Signal name
Input/out-
put
PKIA1935E
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-242
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
MID AUDIO WITH BOSE
WIRING DIAGRAM
MID AUDIO WITH BOSE
Wiring Diagram INFOID:0000000009174543
ABNWA1840GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
MID AUDIO WITH BOSE
AV-243
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
ABNWA1841GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-244
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
MID AUDIO WITH BOSE
ABNWA1842GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
MID AUDIO WITH BOSE
AV-245
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
AANWA0716GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-246
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
MID AUDIO WITH BOSE
ABNWA1843GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
MID AUDIO WITH BOSE
AV-247
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
AANWA0718GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-248
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
MID AUDIO WITH BOSE
AANIA1196GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
MID AUDIO WITH BOSE
AV-249
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
ABNIA4788GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-250
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
MID AUDIO WITH BOSE
ABNIA4789GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
MID AUDIO WITH BOSE
AV-251
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
ABNIA4790GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-252
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
MID AUDIO WITH BOSE
ABNIA4791GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
MID AUDIO WITH BOSE
AV-253
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
ABNIA4792GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-254
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
MID AUDIO WITH BOSE
ABNIA4793GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
MID AUDIO WITH BOSE
AV-255
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
ABNIA4794GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-256
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
MID AUDIO WITH BOSE
ABNIA4795GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
MID AUDIO WITH BOSE
AV-257
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
ABNIA4796GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-258
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
MID AUDIO WITH BOSE
ABNIA4797GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
MID AUDIO WITH BOSE
AV-259
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
ABNIA4798GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-260
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
MID AUDIO WITH BOSE
AANIA1208GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
MID AUDIO WITH BOSE
AV-261
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
ABNIA4799GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-262
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
MID AUDIO WITH BOSE
ABNIA4800GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
MID AUDIO WITH BOSE
AV-263
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
ABNIA4801GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-264
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
MID AUDIO WITH BOSE
ABNIA4802GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
MID AUDIO WITH BOSE
AV-265
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
ABNIA4803GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-266
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
MID AUDIO WITH BOSE
ABNIA4804GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
MID AUDIO WITH BOSE
AV-267
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
ABNIA4805GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-268
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
MID AUDIO WITH BOSE
ABNIA4806GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
MID AUDIO WITH BOSE
AV-269
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
ABNIA4807GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-270
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
MID AUDIO WITH BOSE
ABNIA4808GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
MID AUDIO WITH BOSE
AV-271
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
ABNIA4809GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-272
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
MID AUDIO WITH BOSE
ABNIA4810GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORKFLOW
AV-273
< BASIC INSPECTION >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
BASIC INSPECTION
DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORKFLOW
Work Flow INFOID:0000000009174544
OVERALL SEQUENCE
Reference 1: Refer to AV-221, "CONSULT Function".
Reference 2: Refer to AV-358, "Symptom Table".
DETAILED FLOW
1.CHECK SYMPTOM
Check the malfunction symptoms by performing the following items:
Interview the customer to obtain the malfunction information (conditions and environment when the malfunc-
tion occurred).
Check the symptom.
>> GO TO 2
2.SELF-DIAGNOSIS (CONSULT)
1. Connect CONSULT and perform SELF-DIAGNOSIS for MULTI AV.
NOTE:
Skip to step 4 of the diagnosis procedure if MULTI AV is not displayed.
2. Check if any DTC No. is displayed in the self-diagnosis results.
AWNIA2486GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-274
< BASIC INSPECTION >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORKFLOW
Is any DTC No. displayed?
YES >> GO TO 3
NO >> GO TO 4
3.CHECK SELF-DIAGNOSIS RESULTS (CONSULT)
1. Check the DTC No. indicated in the self-diagnosis results.
2. Perform the relevant diagnosis referring to the DTC No. list. Refer to AV-230, "DTC Index".
NOTE:
Start with the diagnosis for the CAN communication system if CAN COMM CIRCUIT [U1000] or CONTROL
UNIT (CAN) [U1010] is displayed.
>> GO TO 5
4.PERFORM DIAGNOSIS BY SYMPTOM
Perform the relevant diagnosis referring to the diagnosis chart by symptom. Refer to AV-358, "Symptom
Table".
>> GO TO 5
5.REPAIR OR REPLACE MALFUNCTIONING PARTS
Repair or replace the identified malfunctioning parts.
NOTE:
Erase the stored self-diagnosis results after repairing or replacing the relevant components if any DTC No. has
been indicated in the self-diagnosis results.
>> GO TO 6
6.CHECK AFTER REPAIR
1. Perform self-diagnosis for MULTI AV with CONSULT after repairing or replacing the malfunctioning
parts.
2. Check if any DTC No. is displayed in the self-diagnosis results.
Is any DTC No. displayed?
YES >> GO TO 3
NO >> GO TO 7
7.FINAL CHECK
Perform the operation check to confirm that the malfunction symptom is solved or that any other symptoms
are present.
Are any symptoms present?
YES >> GO TO 4
NO >> Inspection End.
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
INSPECTION AND ADJUSTMENT
AV-275
< BASIC INSPECTION >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
INSPECTION AND ADJUSTMENT
ADDITIONAL SERVICE WHEN REPLACING AV CONTROL UNIT
ADDITIONAL SERVICE WHEN REPLACING AV CONTROL UNIT : Description
INFOID:0000000009174545
BEFORE REPLACEMENT
When replacing AV control unit, save or print current vehicle specification with CONSULT configuration before
replacement.
NOTE:
If Before Replace ECU cannot be used, use the After Replace ECU or Manual Configuration after replac-
ing AV control unit.
AFTER REPLACEMENT
CAUTION:
When replacing AV control unit, you must perform After Replace ECU with CONSULT.
Complete the procedure of After Replace ECU in order.
If you set incorrect After Replace ECU, incidents might occur.
Configuration is different for each vehicle model. Confirm configuration of each vehicle model.
ADDITIONAL SERVICE WHEN REPLACING AV CONTROL UNIT : Work Procedure
INFOID:0000000009174546
1.SAVING VEHICLE SPECIFICATION
-CONSULT
Enter Re/Programming, Configuration and perform Before Replace ECU to save or print current vehicle
specification.
NOTE:
If Before Replace ECU cannot be used, use the After Replace ECU or Manual Configuration after replac-
ing AV control unit.
>> GO TO 2.
2.REPLACE AV CONTROL UNIT
Replace AV control unit. Refer to AV-365, "Removal and Installation".
>> GO TO 3.
3.WRITING VEHICLE SPECIFICATION
CONSULT
1. Enter "Re/Programming, Configuration".
2. If Before Replace ECU operation was performed, automatically an "Operation Log Selection" screen will
be displayed. Select the applicable file from the "Saved Data List" and press Confirm to write vehicle
specification. Refer to AV-276, "CONFIGURATION (AV CONTROL UNIT) : Work Procedure".
3. If Before Replace ECU operation was not performed, select "After Replace ECU" or "Manual Configura-
tion" to write vehicle specification. Refer to AV-276, "CONFIGURATION (AV CONTROL UNIT) : Work Pro-
cedure".
>> GO TO 4.
4.OPERATION CHECK
Check that the operation of the AV control unit and camera images (fixed guide lines and predictive course
lines) are normal.
>> Work End.
CONFIGURATION (AV CONTROL UNIT)
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-276
< BASIC INSPECTION >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
INSPECTION AND ADJUSTMENT
CONFIGURATION (AV CONTROL UNIT) : Description INFOID:0000000009174547
Vehicle specification needs to be written with CONSULT because it is not written after replacing AV control
unit.
Configuration has three functions as follows:
CAUTION:
When replacing AV control unit, you must perform Select Saved Data List or "After Replace ECU"
with CONSULT.
Complete the procedure of Select Saved Data List or "After Replace ECU" in order.
If you set incorrect Select Saved Data List or "After Replace ECU", incidents might occur.
Configuration is different for each vehicle model. Confirm configuration of each vehicle model.
Never perform Select Saved Data List or "After Replace ECU" except for new AV control unit.
CONFIGURATION (AV CONTROL UNIT) : Work Procedure INFOID:0000000009174548
1.WRITING MODE SELECTION
CONSULT
Select Reprogramming, Configuration of AV control unit.
When writing saved data>>GO TO 2.
When writing manually>>GO TO 3.
2.PERFORM SAVED DATA LIST
CONSULT
Automatically Operation Log Selection window will display if Before Replace ECU was performed. Select
applicable file from the Save Data List and press Confirm.
>> Work End.
3.PERFORM AFTER REPLACE ECU OR MANUAL CONFIGURATION
CONSULT
1. Select After Replace ECU or Manual Configuration.
2. Identify the correct model and configuration list. Refer to AV-277, "CONFIGURATION (AV CONTROL
UNIT) : Configuration List".
3. Confirm and/or change setting value for each item.
CAUTION:
Thoroughly read and understand the vehicle specification. ECU control may not operate normally
if the setting is not correct.
4. Select Next.
CAUTION:
Make sure to select Next, confirm each setting value and press OK even if the indicated con-
figuration of brand new AV control unit is same as the desirable configuration. If not, configuration
which is set automatically by selecting vehicle model can not be memorized.
5. When "Completed", select "End".
>> GO TO 4.
4.OPERATION CHECK
Confirm that each function controlled by AV control unit operates normally.
Function Description
"Before Replace ECU"
Reads the vehicle configuration of current AV control unit.
Saves the read vehicle configuration.
"After Replace ECU" Writes the vehicle configuration with manual selection.
"Select Saved Data List" Writes the vehicle configuration with saved data.
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
INSPECTION AND ADJUSTMENT
AV-277
< BASIC INSPECTION >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
>> Work End.
CONFIGURATION (AV CONTROL UNIT) : Configuration List INFOID:0000000009174549
CAUTION:
Thoroughly read and understand the vehicle specification. Incorrect settings may result in abnormal
control of ECU.
: Items which confirm vehicle specifications
MANUAL SETTING ITEM
Items Setting value
CAMERA SYSTEM NONE/AVM REAR CAMERA
SOUND SYSTEM BASE BOSE
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-278
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
U1000 CAN COMM CIRCUIT
DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS
U1000 CAN COMM CIRCUIT
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174550
DTC DETECTION LOGIC
Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174551
1.PERFORM SELF DIAGNOSTIC RESULT
1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait for 2 seconds or more.
2. Perform Self Diagnostic Result for MULTI AV.
Is CAN COMM CIRCUIT displayed?
YES >> Refer to LAN-20, "Trouble Diagnosis Flow Chart".
NO >> Refer to GI-49, "Intermittent Incident".
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
CAN COMM CIRCUIT
[U1000]
AV control unit is not transmitting or receiving
CAN communication signal for 2 seconds or
more.
CAN communication system.
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
U1010 CONTROL UNIT (CAN)
AV-279
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
U1010 CONTROL UNIT (CAN)
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174552
DTC DETECTION LOGIC
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
CONTROL UNIT (CAN)
[U1010]
CAN initial diagnosis malfunction is detected.
Replace the AV control unit if the malfunction oc-
curs constantly.
Refer to AV-365, "Removal and Installation".
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-280
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
U1200 AV CONTROL UNIT
U1200 AV CONTROL UNIT
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174553
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
CONT UNIT
[U1200]
AV control unit malfunction is detected.
Replace the AV control unit if the malfunction oc-
curs constantly.
Refer to AV-365, "Removal and Installation".
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
U1216 AV CONTROL UNIT
AV-281
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
U1216 AV CONTROL UNIT
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174554
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
CAN CONT
[U1216]
AV control unit malfunction is detected.
Replace the AV control unit if the malfunction occurs
constantly.
Refer to AV-365, "Removal and Installation".
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-282
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
U1218 AV CONTROL UNIT
U1218 AV CONTROL UNIT
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174555
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
HDD CONN
[U1218]
AV control unit malfunction is detected.
If the hard disk drive (HDD) is functioning normal-
ly, there is a possibility of an intermittent malfunc-
tion.
Replace AV control unit if malfunction occurs con-
stantly.
Refer to AV-365, "Removal and Installation".
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
U1219 AV CONTROL UNIT
AV-283
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
U1219 AV CONTROL UNIT
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174556
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
HDD READ
[U1219]
AV control unit malfunction is detected.
If the hard disk drive (HDD) is functioning normal-
ly, there is a possibility of an intermittent malfunc-
tion.
Replace AV control unit if malfunction occurs con-
stantly.
Refer to AV-365, "Removal and Installation".
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-284
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
U121A AV CONTROL UNIT
U121A AV CONTROL UNIT
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174557
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
HDD WRITE
[U121A]
AV control unit malfunction is detected.
If the hard disk drive (HDD) is functioning normal-
ly, there is a possibility of an intermittent malfunc-
tion.
Replace AV control unit if malfunction occurs con-
stantly.
Refer to AV-365, "Removal and Installation".
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
U121B AV CONTROL UNIT
AV-285
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
U121B AV CONTROL UNIT
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174558
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
HDD COMM
[U121B]
AV control unit malfunction is detected.
If the hard disk drive (HDD) is functioning normal-
ly, there is a possibility of an intermittent malfunc-
tion.
Replace AV control unit if malfunction occurs con-
stantly.
Refer to AV-365, "Removal and Installation".
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-286
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
U121C AV CONTROL UNIT
U121C AV CONTROL UNIT
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174559
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
HDD ACCESS
[U121C]
AV control unit malfunction is detected.
If the hard disk drive (HDD) is functioning normal-
ly, there is a possibility of an intermittent malfunc-
tion.
Replace AV control unit if malfunction occurs con-
stantly.
Refer to AV-365, "Removal and Installation".
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
U121D AV CONTROL UNIT
AV-287
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
U121D AV CONTROL UNIT
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174560
Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174561
1.CHECK CD PLAYBACK
Check the CD playback operation of the AV control unit. Refer to Owners Manual for audio system operating
instructions.
Is the CD playback function of the AV control unit operating normally?
YES >> Refer to GI-49, "Intermittent Incident".
NO >> Replace AV control unit. Refer to AV-365, "Removal and Installation".
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
DSP CONN
[U121D]
AV control unit malfunction is detected.
An intermittent error causing disc player malfunc-
tion may be detected.
Replace AV control unit if malfunction occurs con-
stantly.
Refer to AV-365, "Removal and Installation".
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-288
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
U121E AV CONTROL UNIT
U121E AV CONTROL UNIT
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174562
Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174563
1.CHECK CD PLAYBACK
Check the CD playback operation of the AV control unit. Refer to Owners Manual for audio system operating
instructions.
Is the CD playback function of the AV control unit operating normally?
YES >> Refer to GI-49, "Intermittent Incident".
NO >> Replace AV control unit. Refer to AV-365, "Removal and Installation".
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
DSP COMM
[U121E]
AV control unit malfunction is detected.
An intermittent error causing disc player malfunc-
tion may be detected.
Replace AV control unit if malfunction occurs con-
stantly.
Refer to AV-365, "Removal and Installation".
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
U1225 AV CONTROL UNIT
AV-289
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
U1225 AV CONTROL UNIT
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174564
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
USB CONTROLLER
[U1225]
USB connection malfunction is detected.
Check that connection to USB connector is nor-
mal.
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-290
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
U1227 AV CONTROL UNIT
U1227 AV CONTROL UNIT
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174565
Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174566
1.CHECK DVD PLAYBACK
Check the DVD playback operation of the AV control unit. Refer to Owners Manual for audio system operating
instructions.
Is the DVD playback function of the AV control unit operating normally?
YES >> Refer to GI-49, "Intermittent Incident".
NO >> Replace AV control unit. Refer to AV-365, "Removal and Installation".
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
DVD COMM
[U1227]
AV control unit malfunction is detected.
An intermittent error causing disc player malfunc-
tion may be detected.
Replace AV control unit if malfunction occurs con-
stantly.
Refer to AV-365, "Removal and Installation".
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
U1228 AV CONTROL UNIT
AV-291
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
U1228 AV CONTROL UNIT
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174567
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
SUB CPU CONN
[U1228]
AV control unit malfunction is detected.
Replace AV control unit if malfunction occurs con-
stantly.
Refer to AV-365, "Removal and Installation".
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-292
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
U1229 AV CONTROL UNIT
U1229 AV CONTROL UNIT
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174568
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
iPod CERTIFICATION
[U1229]
AV control unit malfunction is detected.
Replace AV control unit if malfunction occurs con-
stantly.
Refer to AV-365, "Removal and Installation".
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
U122A AV CONTROL UNIT
AV-293
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
U122A AV CONTROL UNIT
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174569
Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174570
1.PERFORM CONFIGURATION
When U122A is detected, configuration data must be written.
>> Write configuration data with CONSULT. Refer to AV-276, "CONFIGURATION (AV CONTROL
UNIT) : Work Procedure".
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
CONFIG UNFINISH
[U122A]
Configuration data is incomplete.
Write configuration data.
Refer to AV-276, "CONFIGURATION (AV CON-
TROL UNIT) : Work Procedure".
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-294
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
U122E AV CONTROL UNIT
U122E AV CONTROL UNIT
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174571
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
Built-in AUDIO CONN
[U122E]
AV control unit malfunction is detected.
Replace AV control unit if malfunction occurs con-
stantly.
Refer to AV-365, "Removal and Installation".
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
U1231 BOSE AMP.
AV-295
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
U1231 BOSE AMP.
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174572
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
AMP TEMP
[U1231]
BOSE speaker amp. malfunction is detected.
Replace BOSE speaker amp. if malfunction oc-
curs constantly.
Refer to AV-372, "Removal and Installation".
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-296
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
U1243 DISPLAY UNIT
U1243 DISPLAY UNIT
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174573
Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174574
Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-242, "Wiring Diagram".
1.CHECK DISPLAY UNIT POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT
Check display unit power supply and ground circuits. Refer to AV-305, "DISPLAY UNIT : Diagnosis Proce-
dure".
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 2.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
2.CHECK COMMUNICATION CIRCUIT CONTINUITY
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect display unit connector and AV control unit connector M45.
3. Check continuity between display unit connector M93 terminals 11, 22 and AV control unit connector M45
terminals 73, 61.
4. Check continuity between display unit connector M93 terminals 11, 22 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 3.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
3.CHECK COMMUNICATION SIGNAL (DISPCONT)
1. Connect display unit connector and AV control unit connector M45.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check signal between display unit connector M93 terminal 11 and ground.
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
FRONT DISP CONN
[U1243]
When any of the following is detected:
display unit power supply or ground circuit mal-
function.
serial communication circuit malfunction be-
tween display unit and AV control unit.
Display unit power supply and ground circuits.
Serial communication circuits between display
unit and AV control unit.
Display unit AV control unit
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
M93
11
M45
73
Yes
22 61
Display unit
Ground Continuity
Connector Terminal
M93
11
No
12
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
U1243 DISPLAY UNIT
AV-297
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 4.
NO >> Replace AV control unit. Refer to AV-365, "Removal and Installation".
4.CHECK COMMUNICATION SIGNAL (CONTDISP)
Check signal between display unit connector M93 terminal 22 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> Inspection End.
NO >> Replace display unit. Refer to AV-369, "Removal and Installation".
Display unit Ground
Condition Reference value (+)
()
Connector Terminal
M93 11
When adjusting dis-
play brightness.
PKIB5039J
Display unit Ground
Condition Reference value (+)
()
Connector Terminal
M93 22
When adjusting dis-
play brightness.
PKIB5039J
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-298
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
U1255 SATELLITE RADIO TUNER
U1255 SATELLITE RADIO TUNER
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174575
Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174576
Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-242, "Wiring Diagram".
1.CHECK SATELLITE RADIO TUNER POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT
Check satellite radio tuner power supply and ground circuit. Refer to AV-308, "SATELLITE RADIO TUNER :
Diagnosis Procedure".
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 2.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
2.CHECK COMMUNICATION CIRCUIT AND REQUEST SIGNAL CIRCUIT CONTINUITY
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect AV control unit connector M51 and satellite radio tuner connector B2.
3. Check continuity between AV control unit connector M51 terminals 100, 101, 102 and satellite radio tuner
connector B2 terminals 28, 29, 30.
4. Check continuity between AV control unit connector M51 terminals 100, 101, 102 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 3.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
3.CHECK AV CONTROL UNIT VOLTAGE
1. Connect AV control unit connector M51.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check voltage between AV control unit connector M51 terminals 100, 101 and ground.
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
SAT CONN
[U1255]
When any of the following is detected:
satellite radio tuner power supply or ground circuit
malfunction.
communication circuit malfunction between AV
control unit and satellite radio tuner.
request signal circuit malfunction between AV
control unit and satellite radio tuner.
Satellite radio tuner power supply and ground cir-
cuits.
Communication circuits between AV control unit
and satellite radio tuner.
Request signal circuits between AV control unit
and satellite radio tuner.
AV control unit Satellite radio tuner
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
M51
100
B2
28
Yes 101 29
102 30
AV control unit
Ground
Continuity
Connector Terminal
M51
100
No 101
102
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
U1255 SATELLITE RADIO TUNER
AV-299
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 4.
NO >> Replace AV control unit. Refer to AV-365, "Removal and Installation".
4.CHECK SATELLITE RADIO TUNER VOLTAGE
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect AV control unit connector M51.
3. Connect satellite radio tuner connector B2.
4. Turn ignition switch ON.
5. Check voltage between satellite radio tuner connector B2 terminal 30 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> Inspection End.
NO >> Replace satellite radio tuner. Refer to AV-384, "Removal and Installation".
AV control unit Ground
Voltage
(Approx.)
(+)
()
Connector Terminal
M51
100
7.0 V
101
Satellite radio tuner Ground
Voltage
(Approx.)
(+)
()
Connector Terminals
B2 30 7.0 V
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-300
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
U1263 USB
U1263 USB
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174577
Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174578
1.CHECK USB INTERFACE HARNESS
Visually inspect USB interface harness.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 2.
NO >> Replace USB interface harness. Refer to AV-380, "Removal and Installation".
2.CHECK USB INTERFACE HARNESS CONTINUITY
Check USB interface harness continuity. Refer to AV-300, "Diagnosis Procedure".
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> Replace AV control unit. Refer to AV-365, "Removal and Installation".
NO >> Replace USB interface harness. Refer to AV-380, "Removal and Installation".
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
USB OVERCURRENT
[U126]
Overcurrent in USB connector is detected.
Check USB harness between the AV control unit
and USB connector.
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
U1264 ANTENNA AMP.
AV-301
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
U1264 ANTENNA AMP.
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174579
Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174580
Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-242, "Wiring Diagram".
1.CHECK CONTINUITY BETWEEN AV CONTROL UNIT AND ANTENNA BASE
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect AV control unit connector M155 and antenna base connector M502.
3. Check continuity between AV control unit connector M155 and antenna base connector M502.
4. Check continuity between AV control unit connector M155 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 2.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
2.CHECK AV CONTROL UNIT VOLTAGE
1. Connect AV control unit connector M155.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check voltage between AV control unit connector M155 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> Replace antenna base. Refer to AV-389, "Removal and Installation".
NO >> Replace AV control unit. Refer to AV-365, "Removal and Installation".
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
ANTENNA AMP TERMINAL
[U1264]
Antenna amp. ON signal circuit open or short cir-
cuited.
Antenna amp. ON signal circuit between AV con-
trol unit and antenna amp.
AV control unit Antenna base
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
M155 126 M502 1 Yes
AV control unit
Ground Continuity
Connector Terminal
M155 126 No
AV control unit Ground
Voltage
(Approx.)
(+)
()
Connector Terminal
M155 126 Battery voltage
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-302
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
U1265 BOSE AMP.
U1265 BOSE AMP.
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174581
Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174582
Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-242, "Wiring Diagram".
1.CHECK CONTINUITY BETWEEN AV CONTROL UNIT AND BOSE SPEAKER AMP.
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect AV control unit connector M143 and Bose speaker amp. connector B130.
3. Check continuity between AV control unit connector M143 and Bose speaker amp. connector M130.
4. Check continuity between AV control unit connector M122 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 2.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
2.CHECK AV CONTROL UNIT VOLTAGE
1. Connect AV control unit connector M143.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check voltage between AV control unit connector M143 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> Replace Bose speaker amp. Refer to AV-372, "Removal and Installation".
NO >> Replace AV control unit. Refer to AV-365, "Removal and Installation".
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
AMP ON TERMINAL
[U1265]
BOSE amp. ON signal circuit open or short cir-
cuited.
BOSE amp. ON signal circuit between AV control
unit and BOSE speaker amp.
AV control unit Bose speaker amp.
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
M143 110 B130 60 Yes
AV control unit
Ground Continuity
Connector Terminal
M143 110 No
AV control unit Ground
Voltage
(Approx.)
(+)
()
Connector Terminal
M143 110 Battery voltage
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
U1300 AV COMM CIRCUIT
AV-303
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
U1300 AV COMM CIRCUIT
Description INFOID:0000000009174583
U1300 is indicated when a malfunction occurs in the communication signal of the multi AV system. Indicated
simultaneously, without fail, the malfunction of control units connected to the AV control unit through communi-
cation circuits. Determine the possible malfunction cause from the table below.
SELF-DIAGNOSIS RESULTS DISPLAY ITEM
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
AV COMM CIRCUIT
[U1300]
SWITCH CONN
[U1240]
When any of the following is detected:
A/C and AV switch assembly power supply or
ground circuit malfunction.
AV communication circuit malfunction between
AV control unit and A/C and AV switch assem-
bly.
A/C and AV switch assembly power supply and
ground circuits.
AV communication circuits between AV control
unit and A/C and AV switch assembly.
AV COMM CIRCUIT
[U1300]
HAND FREE CONN
[U1256]
When any of the following is detected:
Bluetooth
control unit.
Bluetooth
control unit.
AV COMM CIRCUIT
[U1300]
SWITCH CONN
[U1240]
HAND FREE CONN
[U1256]
AV communication circuit malfunction between AV
control unit and A/C and AV switch assembly.
AV communication circuits between AV control unit
and A/C and AV switch assembly.
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-304
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
U1310 AV CONTROL UNIT
U1310 AV CONTROL UNIT
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174584
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
CONTROL UNIT (AV)
[U1310]
An initial diagnosis error is detected in AV com-
munication circuit.
Replace the AV control unit if the malfunction occurs
constantly.
Refer to AV-365, "Removal and Installation".
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT
AV-305
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT
AV CONTROL UNIT
AV CONTROL UNIT : Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174585
Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-242, "Wiring Diagram".
1.CHECK FUSE
Check that the following fuses are not blown.
Are the fuses blown?
YES >> Replace the blown fuse after repairing the affected circuit.
NO >> GO TO 2.
2.CHECK POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect AV control unit connectors M42 and M44.
3. Check voltage between AV control unit connectors and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 3.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
3.CHECK GROUND CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Check continuity between AV control unit connector M44 terminal 52 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> Inspection End.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
DISPLAY UNIT
DISPLAY UNIT : Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174586
Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-242, "Wiring Diagram".
1.CHECK INVERTER VCC AND SIGNAL VCC (POWER SUPPLY) CIRCUIT 1
Terminal No. Signal name Fuse No.
29 Ignition signal 29 (5A)
39 ACC power supply 65 (10A)
51 Battery power supply 15 (15A)
AV control unit
Ground Condition
Voltage
(Approx.)
Connector Terminal
M42 29
Ignition switch: ON
Battery voltage
M44
39 Ignition switch: ACC
51 Ignition switch: OFF
AV control unit
Ground Continuity
Connector Terminal
M44 52 Yes
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-306
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT
Check voltage between display unit harness connector M93 terminals 2, 3 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 4.
NO >> GO TO 2.
2.CHECK INVERTER VCC AND SIGNAL VCC (POWER SUPPLY) CIRCUIT CONTINUITY
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect AV control unit connector M45 and display unit connector.
3. Check continuity between AV control unit connector M45 terminals 64, 76 and display unit connector M93
terminals 3, 2.
4. Check continuity between AV control unit connector M45 terminals 64, 76 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 3.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
3.CHECK INVERTER VCC AND SIGNAL VCC (POWER SUPPLY) CIRCUIT 2
1. Connect the AV control unit connector M45.
2. Check voltage between AV control unit connector M45 terminals 64, 76 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> Inspection End.
NO >> Replace AV control unit. Refer to AV-365, "Removal and Installation".
4.CHECK INVERTER GROUND AND SIGNAL GROUND CIRCUIT CONTINUITY
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect AV control unit connector M45 and display unit connector.
3. Check continuity between AV control unit connector M45 terminals 63, 75 and display unit connector M93
terminals 14, 13.
Display unit
Ground Condition
Voltage
(Approx.)
Connector Terminal
M93
2
Ignition switch: ACC 9.0 V
3
AV control unit Display unit
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
M45
64
M93
3
Yes
76 2
AV control unit
Ground Continuity
Connector Terminal
M45
64
No
76
AV control unit Ground
Condition
Voltage
(Approx.)
(+)
()
Connector Terminal
M45
64
Ignition switch: ACC 9.0 V
76
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT
AV-307
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 5.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
5.CHECK DISPLAY UNIT GROUND CIRCUIT
Check continuity between display unit connector M93 terminal 1 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> Inspection End.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
BOSE AMP.
BOSE AMP. : Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174587
Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-242, "Wiring Diagram".
1.CHECK FUSE
Check that the following fuses are not blown.
Are the fuses blown?
YES >> Replace the blown fuse after repairing the affected circuit.
NO >> GO TO 2.
2.CHECK POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Disconnect BOSE speaker amp. connector B129.
2. Check voltage between BOSE speaker amp. connector B129 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 3.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
3.CHECK GROUND CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Check continuity between BOSE speaker amp. connector B129 and ground.
AV control unit Display unit
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
M45
63
M93
14
Yes
75 13
Display unit
Ground Continuity
Connector Terminal
M93 1 Yes
Terminal No. Signal name Fuse No.
50
Battery power supply
11 (15A)
51 12 (15A)
BOSE speaker amp.
Ground
Voltage
(Approx.)
Connector Terminal
B129
50
Battery voltage
51
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-308
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> Inspection End.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
SUBWOOFER
SUBWOOFER : Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174588
Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-242, "Wiring Diagram".
1.CHECK FUSE
Check that the following fuses are not blown.
Are the fuses blown?
YES >> Replace the blown fuse after repairing the affected circuit.
NO >> GO TO 2.
2.CHECK POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Disconnect subwoofer connector.
2. Check voltage between subwoofer connector B73 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 3.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
3.CHECK GROUND CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Check continuity between subwoofer connector B73 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> Inspection End.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
SATELLITE RADIO TUNER
SATELLITE RADIO TUNER : Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174589
Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-242, "Wiring Diagram".
BOSE speaker amp.
Ground Continuity
Connector Terminal
B129
47
Yes
52
Terminal No. Signal name Fuse No.
6 Battery power supply 58 (10A)
Subwoofer
Ground
Voltage
(Approx.)
Connector Terminal
B73 6 Battery voltage
Subwoofer
Ground Continuity
Connector Terminal
B73 5 Yes
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT
AV-309
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
1.CHECK FUSE
Check that the following fuses are not blown.
Are the fuses blown?
YES >> Replace the blown fuse after repairing the affected circuit.
NO >> GO TO 2.
2.CHECK POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect satellite radio tuner connector B2.
3. Check voltage between satellite radio tuner connector B2 terminal 32, 36 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 3.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
3.CHECK GROUND CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Check continuity between satellite radio tuner connector B2 terminal 35 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> Inspection End.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
BLUETOOTH CONTROL UNIT
BLUETOOTH CONTROL UNIT : Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174590
Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-242, "Wiring Diagram".
1.CHECK FUSE
Check that the following fuses are not blown.
Are the fuses blown?
YES >> Replace the blown fuse after repairing the affected circuit.
NO >> GO TO 2.
Terminal No. Signal name Fuse No.
32 Battery power supply 15 (15A)
36 ACC power supply 65 (10A)
Satellite radio tuner
Ground Condition
Voltage
(Approx.)
Connector Terminal
B2
32
control unit
Ground Condition
Voltage
(Approx.)
Connector Terminal
B3
1
control unit
Ground Continuity
Connector Terminal
B3
4
Yes
20
22
24
27
Terminal No. Signal name Fuse No.
3 ACC power supply 65 (10A)
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT
AV-311
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 3.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
3.CHECK CONTROL UNIT GROUND CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect AV control unit connector M42.
3. Check continuity between A/C and AV switch assembly connector M98 terminal 9 and AV control unit con-
nector M42 terminal 10.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 4.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
4.CHECK SWITCH GROUND CIRCUIT
Check continuity between A/C and AV switch assembly connector M98 terminal 1 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> Inspection End.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
A/C and AV switch assembly
Ground Condition
Voltage
(Approx.)
Connector Terminal
M98 3 Ignition switch: ACC Battery voltage
A/C and AV switch assembly AV control unit
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
M98 9 M42 10 Yes
A/C and AV switch assembly
Ground Continuity
Connector Terminal
M98 1 Yes
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-312
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
CENTER SPEAKER
CENTER SPEAKER
Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174592
Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-242, "Wiring Diagram".
1.CONNECTOR CHECK
Check the BOSE speaker amp. and speaker connectors for the following:
Proper connection
Damage
Disconnected or loose terminals
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 2.
NO >> Repair the terminals or connectors.
2.CHECK CENTER SPEAKER SIGNAL CIRCUIT CONTINUITY
1. Disconnect BOSE speaker amp. connector B130 and center speaker connector.
2. Check continuity between BOSE speaker amp. connector B130 and center speaker connector.
3. Check continuity between BOSE speaker amp. connector B130 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 3.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
3.CHECK CENTER SPEAKER SIGNAL
1. Connect BOSE speaker amp. connector B130 and center speaker connector.
2. Turn ignition switch to ACC.
3. Push AV control unit POWER switch.
4. Check signal between BOSE speaker amp. connector B130 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
BOSE speaker amp. Center speaker
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
B130
69
M110
1
Yes
70 2
BOSE speaker amp.
Ground Continuity
Connector Terminal
B130
69
No
70
BOSE speaker amp. connector B130
Condition Reference value (+) ()
Terminal Terminal
69 70 Audio signal output
SKIB3609E
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
CENTER SPEAKER
AV-313
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
YES >> Replace center speaker. Refer to AV-376, "Removal and Installation".
NO >> GO TO 4.
4.CHECK PRE-AMP SIGNAL CIRCUIT CONTINUITY
1. Disconnect AV control unit connector M143 and BOSE speaker amp. connector B130.
2. Check continuity between AV control unit connector M143 and BOSE speaker amp. connector B130.
3. Check continuity between AV control unit connector M143 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 5.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
5.CHECK PRE-AMP SIGNAL
1. Connect AV control unit connector M143 and BOSE speaker amp. connector B130.
2. Turn ignition switch to ACC.
3. Push AV control unit POWER switch.
4. Check signal between the terminals of AV control unit connector M143.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> Replace BOSE speaker amp. Refer to AV-372, "Removal and Installation".
NO >> Replace AV control unit. Refer to AV-365, "Removal and Installation".
AV control unit BOSE speaker amp.
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
M143
113
B130
75
Yes
119 76
109 73
115 74
AV control unit
Ground Continuity
Connector Terminal
M143
113
No
119
109
115
AV control unit connector M143
Condition Reference value (+) ()
Terminal Terminal
113 119
Audio signal output
109 115
SKIB3609E
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-314
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
INSTRUMENT PANEL SPEAKER/TWEETER
INSTRUMENT PANEL SPEAKER/TWEETER
Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174593
Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-242, "Wiring Diagram".
1.CONNECTOR CHECK
Check the BOSE speaker amp. and speaker connectors for the following:
Proper connection
Damage
Disconnected or loose terminals
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 2.
NO >> Repair the terminals or connectors.
2.CHECK INSTRUMENT PANEL TWEETER SIGNAL CIRCUIT CONTINUITY
1. Disconnect BOSE speaker amp. connector B129 and suspect instrument panel tweeter connector.
2. Check continuity between BOSE speaker amp. connector B129 and suspect instrument panel tweeter
connector.
3. Check continuity between BOSE speaker amp. connector B122 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 3.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
3.CHECK INSTRUMENT PANEL TWEETER SIGNAL
1. Connect BOSE speaker amp. connector B129 and suspect instrument panel tweeter connector.
2. Turn ignition switch to ACC.
3. Push AV control unit POWER switch.
4. Check signal between BOSE speaker amp. connector B129 and ground.
BOSE speaker amp. Instrument panel tweeter
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
B129
41
M62 (LH)
1
Yes
42 2
45
M73 (RH)
1
46 2
BOSE speaker amp.
Ground Continuity
Connector Terminal
B129
41
No
42
45
46
BOSE speaker amp.
Condition Reference value (+) ()
Terminal Terminal
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
INSTRUMENT PANEL SPEAKER/TWEETER
AV-315
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> Replace instrument panel tweeter. Refer to AV-375, "Removal and Installation".
NO >> GO TO 4.
4.CHECK PRE-AMP SIGNAL CIRCUIT CONTINUITY
1. Disconnect AV control unit connector M143 and BOSE speaker amp. connector B130.
2. Check continuity between AV control unit connector M143 and BOSE speaker amp. connector B130.
3. Check continuity between AV control unit connector M143 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 5.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
5.CHECK PRE-AMP SIGNAL
1. Connect AV control unit connector M143 and BOSE speaker amp. connector B130.
2. Turn ignition switch to ACC.
3. Push AV control unit POWER switch.
4. Check signal between the terminals of AV control unit connector M143.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> Replace BOSE speaker amp. Refer to AV-372, "Removal and Installation".
41 42
Audio signal output
45 46
SKIB3609E
AV control unit BOSE speaker amp.
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
M143
113
B130
75
Yes
119 76
109 73
115 74
AV control unit
Ground Continuity
Connector Terminal
M143
113
No
119
109
115
AV control unit connector M143
Condition Reference value (+) ()
Terminal Terminal
113 119
Audio signal output
109 115
SKIB3609E
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-316
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
INSTRUMENT PANEL SPEAKER/TWEETER
NO >> Replace AV control unit. Refer to AV-365, "Removal and Installation".
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
FRONT TWEETER
AV-317
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
FRONT TWEETER
Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174594
Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-242, "Wiring Diagram".
1.CONNECTOR CHECK
Check the BOSE speaker amp. and speaker connectors for the following:
Proper connection
Damage
Disconnected or loose terminals
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 2.
NO >> Repair the terminals or connectors.
2.CHECK FRONT TWEETER SIGNAL CIRCUIT CONTINUITY
1. Disconnect BOSE speaker amp. connector B130 and suspect front tweeter connector.
2. Check continuity between BOSE speaker amp. connector B130 and suspect front door speaker connec-
tor.
3. Check continuity between BOSE speaker amp. connector B130 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 3.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
3.CHECK FRONT TWEETER SIGNAL
1. Connect BOSE speaker amp. connector B130 and suspect front tweeter connector.
2. Turn ignition switch to ACC.
3. Push AV control unit POWER switch.
4. Check the signal between the terminals of BOSE speaker amp. connector B130.
BOSE speaker amp. Front tweeter
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
B130
58
M109 (LH)
1
Yes
59 2
71
M111 (RH)
1
72 2
BOSE speaker amp.
Ground Continuity
Connector Terminal
B130
58
No
59
71
72
BOSE speaker amp. connector B130
Condition Reference value (+) ()
Terminal Terminal
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-318
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
FRONT TWEETER
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> Replace front tweeter. Refer to AV-374, "Removal and Installation".
NO >> GO TO 4.
4.CHECK PRE-AMP SIGNAL CIRCUIT CONTINUITY
1. Disconnect AV control unit connector M143 and BOSE speaker amp. connector B130.
2. Check continuity between AV control unit connector M143 and BOSE speaker amp. connector B130.
3. Check continuity between AV control unit connector M143 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 5.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
5.CHECK PRE-AMP SIGNAL
1. Connect AV control unit connector M143 and BOSE speaker amp. connector B130.
2. Turn ignition switch to ACC.
3. Push AV control unit POWER switch.
4. Check signal between the terminals of AV control unit connector M143.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> Replace BOSE speaker amp. Refer to AV-372, "Removal and Installation".
58 59
Audio signal output
71 72
SKIB3609E
AV control unit BOSE speaker amp.
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
M143
113
B130
75
Yes
119 76
109 73
115 74
AV control unit
Ground Continuity
Connector Terminal
M143
113
No
119
109
115
AV control unit connector M143
Condition Reference value (+) ()
Terminal Terminal
113 119
Audio signal output
109 115
SKIB3609E
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
FRONT TWEETER
AV-319
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
NO >> Replace AV control unit. Refer to AV-365, "Removal and Installation".
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-320
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
FRONT DOOR SPEAKER
FRONT DOOR SPEAKER
Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174595
Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-242, "Wiring Diagram".
1.CONNECTOR CHECK
Check the BOSE speaker amp. and speaker connectors for the following:
Proper connection
Damage
Disconnected or loose terminals
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 2.
NO >> Repair the terminals or connectors.
2.CHECK FRONT DOOR SPEAKER SIGNAL CIRCUIT CONTINUITY
1. Disconnect BOSE speaker amp. connector B130 and suspect front door speaker connector.
2. Check continuity between BOSE speaker amp. connector B130 and suspect front door speaker connec-
tor.
3. Check continuity between BOSE speaker amp. connector B130 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 3.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
3.CHECK FRONT DOOR SPEAKER SIGNAL
1. Connect BOSE speaker amp. connector B130 and suspect front door speaker connector.
2. Turn ignition switch to ACC.
3. Push AV control unit POWER switch.
4. Check the signal between the terminals of BOSE speaker amp. connector B130.
BOSE speaker amp. Front door speaker
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
B130
58
D12 (LH)
1
Yes
59 2
71
D112 (RH)
1
72 2
BOSE speaker amp.
Ground Continuity
Connector Terminal
B130
58
No
59
71
72
BOSE speaker amp. connector B130
Condition Reference value (+) ()
Terminal Terminal
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
FRONT DOOR SPEAKER
AV-321
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> Replace front door speaker. Refer to AV-373, "Removal and Installation".
NO >> GO TO 4.
4.CHECK PRE-AMP SIGNAL CIRCUIT CONTINUITY
1. Disconnect AV control unit connector M143 and BOSE speaker amp. connector B130.
2. Check continuity between AV control unit connector M143 and BOSE speaker amp. connector B130.
3. Check continuity between AV control unit connector M143 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 5.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
5.CHECK PRE-AMP SIGNAL
1. Connect AV control unit connector M143 and BOSE speaker amp. connector B130.
2. Turn ignition switch to ACC.
3. Push AV control unit POWER switch.
4. Check signal between the terminals of AV control unit connector M143.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> Replace BOSE speaker amp. Refer to AV-372, "Removal and Installation".
58 59
Audio signal output
71 72
SKIB3609E
AV control unit BOSE speaker amp.
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
M143
113
B130
75
Yes
119 76
109 73
115 74
AV control unit
Ground Continuity
Connector Terminal
M143
113
No
119
109
115
AV control unit connector M143
Condition Reference value (+) ()
Terminal Terminal
113 119
Audio signal output
109 115
SKIB3609E
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-322
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
FRONT DOOR SPEAKER
NO >> Replace AV control unit. Refer to AV-365, "Removal and Installation".
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
REAR DOOR SPEAKER
AV-323
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
REAR DOOR SPEAKER
Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174596
Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-242, "Wiring Diagram".
1.CONNECTOR CHECK
Check the BOSE speaker amp. and speaker connectors for the following:
Proper connection
Damage
Disconnected or loose terminals
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 2.
NO >> Repair the terminals or connectors.
2.CHECK REAR DOOR SPEAKER SIGNAL CIRCUIT CONTINUITY
1. Disconnect BOSE speaker amp. connectors and suspect rear door speaker connector.
2. Check continuity between BOSE speaker amp. connectors and suspect rear door speaker connector.
3. Check continuity between BOSE speaker amp. connectors and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 3.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
3.CHECK REAR DOOR SPEAKER SIGNAL
1. Connect BOSE speaker amp. connectors and suspect rear door speaker connector.
2. Turn ignition switch to ACC.
3. Push AV control unit POWER switch.
4. Check the signal between the terminals of BOSE speaker amp. connectors.
BOSE speaker amp. Rear door speaker
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
B130
68
D207 (LH)
1
Yes
55 2
B129
54
D307 (RH)
1
49 2
BOSE speaker amp.
Ground Continuity
Connector Terminal
B130
68
No
55
B129
54
49
BOSE speaker amp. Condition Reference value
Connector
(+) ()
Terminal Terminal
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-324
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
REAR DOOR SPEAKER
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> Replace rear door speaker. Refer to AV-377, "Removal and Installation".
NO >> GO TO 4.
4.CHECK PRE-AMP SIGNAL CIRCUIT CONTINUITY
1. Disconnect AV control unit connector M143 and BOSE speaker amp. connector B130.
2. Check continuity between AV control unit connector M143 and BOSE speaker amp. connector B130.
3. Check continuity between AV control unit connector M143 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 5.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
5.CHECK PRE-AMP SIGNAL
1. Connect AV control unit connector M143 and BOSE speaker amp. connector B130.
2. Turn ignition switch to ACC.
3. Push AV control unit POWER switch.
4. Check signal between the terminals of AV control unit connector M143.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> Replace BOSE speaker amp. Refer to AV-372, "Removal and Installation".
B130 68 55
Audio signal output
B129 54 49
SKIB3609E
AV control unit BOSE speaker amp.
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
M143
112
B130
64
Yes
118 63
108 66
114 65
AV control unit
Ground Continuity
Connector Terminal
M143
112
No
118
108
114
AV control unit connector M143
Condition Reference value (+) ()
Terminal Terminal
112 118
Audio signal output
108 114
SKIB3609E
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
REAR DOOR SPEAKER
AV-325
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
NO >> Replace AV control unit. Refer to AV-365, "Removal and Installation".
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-326
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
REAR SPEAKER
REAR SPEAKER
Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174597
Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-242, "Wiring Diagram".
1.CONNECTOR CHECK
Check the BOSE speaker amp. and speaker connectors for the following:
Proper connection
Damage
Disconnected or loose terminals
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 2.
NO >> Repair the terminals or connectors.
2.CHECK REAR SIDE SPEAKER SIGNAL CIRCUIT CONTINUITY
1. Disconnect BOSE speaker amp. connector B129 and suspect rear side speaker connector.
2. Check continuity between BOSE speaker amp. connector B129 and suspect rear side speaker connector.
3. Check continuity between BOSE speaker amp. connector B129 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 3.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
3.CHECK REAR SIDE SPEAKER SIGNAL
1. Connect BOSE speaker amp. connector B129 and suspect rear side speaker connector.
2. Turn ignition switch to ACC.
3. Push AV control unit POWER switch.
4. Check the signal between the terminals of BOSE speaker amp. connector B129.
BOSE speaker amp. Rear side speaker
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
B129
53
B1 (LH)
1
Yes
48 2
44
B153 (RH)
1
43 2
BOSE speaker amp.
Ground Continuity
Connector Terminal
B129
43
No
44
48
53
BOSE speaker amp. connector B129 Condition Reference value
(+) ()
Terminal Terminal
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
REAR SPEAKER
AV-327
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> Replace rear side speaker. Refer to AV-378, "Removal and Installation".
NO >> GO TO 4.
4.CHECK PRE-AMP SIGNAL CIRCUIT CONTINUITY
1. Disconnect AV control unit connector M143 and BOSE speaker amp. connector B130.
2. Check continuity between AV control unit connector M143 and BOSE speaker amp. connector B130.
3. Check continuity between AV control unit connector M143 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 5.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
5.CHECK PRE-AMP SIGNAL
1. Connect AV control unit connector M143 and BOSE speaker amp. connector B130.
2. Turn ignition switch to ACC.
3. Push AV control unit POWER switch.
4. Check signal between the terminals of AV control unit connector M143.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> Replace BOSE speaker amp. Refer to AV-372, "Removal and Installation".
48 53
Audio signal output
43 44
SKIB3609E
AV control unit BOSE speaker amp.
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
M143
112
B130
64
Yes
118 63
108 66
114 65
AV control unit
Ground Continuity
Connector Terminal
M143
112
No
118
108
114
AV control unit connector M143
Condition Reference value (+) ()
Terminal Terminal
112 118
Audio signal output
108 114
SKIB3609E
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-328
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
REAR SPEAKER
NO >> Replace AV control unit. Refer to AV-365, "Removal and Installation".
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
SUBWOOFER
AV-329
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
SUBWOOFER
Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174598
Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-242, "Wiring Diagram".
1.CONNECTOR CHECK
Check the AV control unit, BOSE speaker amp. and subwoofer connectors for the following:
Proper connection
Damage
Disconnected or looses terminals
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 2.
NO >> Repair the terminal and connector.
2.VERIFY SUBWOOFER POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND
Check subwoofer power supply and ground. Refer to AV-308, "SUBWOOFER : Diagnosis Procedure".
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 3.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
3.CHECK SUBWOOFER AMP ON CIRCUIT CONTINUITY
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect Bose speaker amp. connector B130 and subwoofer connector.
3. Check continuity between Bose speaker amp. connector B130 and subwoofer connector B73.
4. Check continuity between Bose speaker amp. connector B130 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 4.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
4.CHECK SUBWOOFER AMP ON CIRCUIT VOLTAGE
1. Connect Bose speaker amp. connector B130.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check voltage between Bose speaker amp. connector B130 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 5.
NO >> Replace Bose speaker amp. Refer to AV-372, "Removal and Installation".
Bose speaker amp. Subwoofer
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
B130 62 B73 4 Yes
Bose speaker amp.
Ground Continuity
Connector Terminal
B130 62 No
Bose speaker amp. Ground
Voltage
(Approx.)
(+)
()
Connector Terminal
B130 62 Battery voltage
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-330
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
SUBWOOFER
5.CHECK SUBWOOFER SIGNAL CIRCUIT CONTINUITY
1. Disconnect BOSE speaker amp. connector B130 and subwoofer connector.
2. Check continuity between BOSE speaker amp. connector B130 and subwoofer connector.
3. Check continuity between BOSE speaker amp. connector B130 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 6.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
6.CHECK SUBWOOFER SIGNAL
1. Connect BOSE speaker amp. connector B130 and subwoofer connector.
2. Turn ignition switch to ACC.
3. Push AV control unit POWER switch.
4. Check the signal between the terminals of BOSE speaker amp. connector B130.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> Replace subwoofer. Refer to AV-379, "Removal and Installation".
NO >> GO TO 7.
7.CHECK PRE-AMP SIGNAL CIRCUIT CONTINUITY
1. Disconnect AV control unit connector M143 and BOSE speaker amp. connector B130.
2. Check continuity between AV control unit connector M143 and BOSE speaker amp. connector B130.
3. Check continuity between AV control unit connector M143 and ground.
BOSE speaker amp. Subwoofer
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
B130
56
B73
2
Yes
57 1
BOSE speaker amp.
Ground Continuity
Connector Terminal
B130
56
No
57
BOSE speaker amp. connector B130
Condition Reference value (+) ()
Terminal Terminal
56 57 Audio signal output
SKIB3609E
AV control unit BOSE speaker amp.
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
M143
112
B130
64
Yes
118 63
108 66
114 65
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
SUBWOOFER
AV-331
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 8.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
8.CHECK PRE-AMP SIGNAL
1. Connect AV control unit connector M143 and BOSE speaker amp. connector B130.
2. Turn ignition switch to ACC.
3. Push AV control unit POWER switch.
4. Check signal between the terminals of AV control unit connector M143.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> Replace BOSE speaker amp. Refer to AV-372, "Removal and Installation".
NO >> Replace AV control unit. Refer to AV-365, "Removal and Installation".
AV control unit
Ground Continuity
Connector Terminal
M143
112
No
118
108
114
AV control unit connector M143
Condition Reference value (+) ()
Terminal Terminal
112 118
Audio signal output
108 114
SKIB3609E
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-332
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
FRONT AUXILIARY INPUT JACK AUDIO SIGNAL CIRCUIT
FRONT AUXILIARY INPUT JACK AUDIO SIGNAL CIRCUIT
Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174599
Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-242, "Wiring Diagram".
1.CHECK AUX SOUND SIGNAL CIRCUIT CONTINUITY
1. Turn ignition OFF.
2. Disconnect AV control unit connector M42 and front auxiliary input jacks connector.
3. Check continuity between AV control unit connector M42 and front auxiliary input jacks connector.
4. Check continuity between AV control unit connector M42 and ground.
Is inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 2.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
2.CHECK AUX SOUND SIGNAL GROUND CIRCUIT CONTINUITY
Check continuity between AV control unit connector M42 and front auxiliary input jacks connector.
Is inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 3.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
3.CHECK AUX SOUND SIGNAL
1. Connect AV control unit connector M42 and front auxiliary input jacks connector.
2. Turn ignition switch to ACC.
3. Select AUX mode.
4. Check signals between AV control unit connector M42 and ground.
AV control unit Front auxiliary input jacks
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
M42
20
M205
1
Yes
21 3
AV control unit
Ground Continuity
Connector Terminal
M42
20
No
21
AV control unit Front auxiliary input jacks
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
M42 22 M205 2 Yes
AV control unit connector M42 Condition Reference value
(+) ()
Terminal Terminal
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
FRONT AUXILIARY INPUT JACK AUDIO SIGNAL CIRCUIT
AV-333
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> Replace front auxiliary input jacks. Refer to AV-381, "Removal and Installation".
NO >> Replace AV control unit. Refer to AV-365, "Removal and Installation".
20 22
AUX mode selected
21 22
SKIB3609E
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-334
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
SATELLITE AUDIO SIGNAL CIRCUIT
SATELLITE AUDIO SIGNAL CIRCUIT
Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174600
Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-242, "Wiring Diagram".
1.CHECK SATELLITE SOUND SIGNAL CIRCUIT CONTINUITY
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect AV control unit connector M51 and satellite radio tuner connector B2.
3. Check continuity between AV control unit connector M51 and satellite radio tuner connector B2.
4. Check continuity between AV control unit connector M51 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 2.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
2.CHECK SATELLITE SOUND SIGNAL GROUND CIRCUIT CONTINUITY
Check continuity between AV control unit connector M51 and satellite radio tuner connector B2.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 3.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
3.CHECK SATELLITE SOUND SIGNAL
1. Connect AV control unit connector M51 and satellite radio tuner connector B2.
2. Turn ignition switch to ACC.
3. Select satellite radio mode.
4. Check the signal between the terminals of AV control unit connector M51.
AV control unit Satellite radio tuner
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
M51
94
B2
22
Yes
96 24
AV control unit
Ground
Continuity
Connector Terminal
M51
94
No
96
AV control unit Satellite radio tuner
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
M51
93
B2
21
Yes
95 23
AV control unit connector M51
Condition Reference value (+) ()
Terminal Terminal
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
SATELLITE AUDIO SIGNAL CIRCUIT
AV-335
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> Replace satellite radio tuner. Refer to AV-384, "Removal and Installation".
NO >> Replace AV control unit. Refer to AV-365, "Removal and Installation".
94 93
Satellite radio mode selected
96 95
SKIB3609E
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-336
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
BLUETOOTH VOICE SIGNAL CIRCUIT
BLUETOOTH VOICE SIGNAL CIRCUIT
Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174601
Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-242, "Wiring Diagram".
1.CHECK BLUETOOTH
VOICE SIGNAL
1. Connect AV control unit connector M42 and Bluetooth
control unit
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
M42 5 B3 9 Yes
AV control unit
Ground Continuity
Connector Terminal
M42 5 No
AV control unit
Bluetooth
control unit
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
M42 4 B3 10 Yes
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
BLUETOOTH VOICE SIGNAL CIRCUIT
AV-337
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> Replace Bluetooth
control unit
Microphone
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
B3
7
R109
6
Yes 8 5
29 3
Bluetooth
control unit
Ground Continuity
Connector Terminal
B3
7
No 8
29
Bluetooth
control unit
Ground Continuity
Connector Terminal
B3
20
Yes
24
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
STEERING SWITCH
AV-355
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
STEERING SWITCH
Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174615
Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-242, "Wiring Diagram".
1.CHECK STEERING WHEEL AUDIO CONTROL SWITCH RESISTANCE
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect combination switch connector M149.
3. Check the resistance between the terminals of combination switch connector M149.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 2.
NO >> Replace steering wheel audio control switch. Refer to AV-368, "Removal and Installation".
2.CHECK HARNESS BETWEEN COMBINATION SWITCH AND COMBINATION METER
1. Disconnect combination meter connector M24 and combination switch connector M30.
2. Check continuity between combination meter connector M24 and combination switch connector M30.
3. Check continuity between combination meter connector M24 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
Combination switch connector M149
Condition
Resistance
(Approx.)
Terminal Terminal
14
17
Depress SOURCE switch. 1
Depress switch.
121
Depress switch.
321
Depress switch.
723
Depress ENTER switch. 2023
15
Depress switch.
1
Depress switch.
121
Depress switch.
321
Depress switch.
723
Depress DISP switch. 2023
Combination meter Combination switch
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
M24
3
M30
24
Yes 24 33
4 31
Combination meter
Ground Continuity
Connector Terminal
M24
3
No 24
4
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-356
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
STEERING SWITCH
YES >> GO TO 3.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
3.CHECK COMBINATION SWITCH
Check continuity between combination switch connectors M30 and M149.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 4.
NO >> Replace spiral cable. Refer to SR-15, "Removal and Installation".
4.CHECK HARNESS BETWEEN COMBINATION METER AND AV CONTROL UNIT
1. Disconnect AV control unit connector M44.
2. Check continuity between combination meter connector M24 and AV control unit connector M44.
3. Check continuity between combination meter connector M24 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 5.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
5.CHECK AV CONTROL UNIT VOLTAGE
1. Connect combination meter connector M24 and AV control unit connector M44.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check the voltage between the terminals of AV control unit connector M44.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> Replace combination meter. Refer to MWI-82, "Removal and Installation".
NO >> Replace AV control unit. Refer to AV-365, "Removal and Installation".
Combination switch
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
M30
24
M149
14
Yes 31 15
33 17
Combination meter AV control unit
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
M24
14
M44
38
Yes 15 48
16 47
Combination meter
Ground Continuity
Connector Terminal
M24
14
No 15
16
AV control unit M44
Voltage
(Approx.)
(+) ()
Terminal Terminal
38
47 5.0 V
48
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
USB CONNECTOR
AV-357
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
USB CONNECTOR
Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174616
Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-242, "Wiring Diagram".
1.CHECK USB INTERFACE HARNESS CONTINUITY
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect AV control unit connector M145 and USB interface connector M209.
3. Check continuity between AV control unit connector M145 and USB interface connector M209.
4. Check continuity between AV control unit connector M55 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> Replace the USB interface. Refer to AV-380, "Removal and Installation".
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
AV control unit USB interface
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
M145
121
M209
2
Yes
122 1
123 4
124 3
125 5
AV control unit
Continuity
Connector Terminal
M145
121
Ground No
123
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-358
< SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
MULTI AV SYSTEM
SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS
MULTI AV SYSTEM
Symptom Table INFOID:0000000009174617
RELATED TO AUDIO
Symptoms Check items Probable malfunction location
The disk cannot be removed. AV control unit
Malfunction in AV control unit.
Refer to AV-214, "On Board Diagnosis
Function".
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
MULTI AV SYSTEM
AV-359
< SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
No sound comes out or the level of the
sound is low.
No sound from all speakers.
Speaker circuit shorted to ground.
Refer to AV-242, "Wiring Diagram".
Bose amp. ON signal circuit malfunction.
Refer to AV-302, "Diagnosis Procedure".
Bose speaker amp. power supply and
ground circuits malfunction.
Refer to AV-307, "BOSE AMP. : Diagno-
sis Procedure".
Only a certain speaker (front door speaker
LH, front door speaker RH, front tweeter
LH, front tweeter RH, instrument panel
tweeter LH, instrument panel tweeter RH,
center speaker, rear door speaker LH, rear
door speaker RH, rear side speaker LH,
rear side speaker RH) does not output
sound.
Poor connector connection of speaker.
Sound signal circuit malfunction between
AV control unit and Bose speaker amp.
Refer to:
- AV-320, "Diagnosis Procedure" (front
door speaker).
- AV-317, "Diagnosis Procedure" (front
tweeter).
- AV-314, "Diagnosis Procedure" (instru-
ment panel tweeter).
- AV-312, "Diagnosis Procedure" (center
speaker).
- AV-323, "Diagnosis Procedure" (rear
door speaker).
- AV-326, "Diagnosis Procedure" (rear
side speaker).
Sound signal circuit malfunction between
Bose speaker amp. and speaker.
Refer to:
- AV-320, "Diagnosis Procedure" (front
door speaker).
- AV-317, "Diagnosis Procedure" (front
tweeter).
- AV-314, "Diagnosis Procedure" (instru-
ment panel tweeter).
- AV-312, "Diagnosis Procedure" (center
speaker).
- AV-323, "Diagnosis Procedure" (rear
door speaker).
- AV-326, "Diagnosis Procedure" (rear
side speaker).
Malfunction in speaker.
Refer to:
- AV-373, "Removal and Installation" (front
door speaker).
- AV-374, "Removal and Installation" (front
tweeter).
- AV-375, "Removal and Installation" (in-
strument panel tweeter).
- AV-376, "Removal and Installation" (cen-
ter speaker).
- AV-377, "Removal and Installation" (rear
door speaker).
- AV-378, "Removal and Installation" (rear
side speaker).
Malfunction in AV control unit.
Refer to AV-214, "On Board Diagnosis
Function".
Malfunction in Bose speaker amp.
Replace Bose speaker amp. Refer to AV-
372, "Removal and Installation".
Symptoms Check items Probable malfunction location
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-360
< SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
MULTI AV SYSTEM
Noise is mixed with audio.
Noise comes out from all speakers.
Malfunction in AV control unit.
Refer to AV-214, "On Board Diagnosis
Function".
Malfunction in Bose speaker amp.
Replace Bose speaker amp. Refer to AV-
372, "Removal and Installation".
Noise comes out only from a certain speak-
er (front door speaker LH, front door speak-
er RH, front tweeter LH, front tweeter RH,
instrument panel tweeter LH, instrument
panel tweeter RH, center speaker, rear
door speaker LH, rear door speaker RH,
rear side speaker LH, rear side speaker
RH).
Poor connector connection of speaker.
Sound signal circuit malfunction between
AV control unit and Bose speaker amp.
Refer to:
- AV-320, "Diagnosis Procedure" (front
door speaker).
- AV-317, "Diagnosis Procedure" (front
tweeter).
- AV-314, "Diagnosis Procedure" (instru-
ment panel tweeter).
- AV-312, "Diagnosis Procedure" (center
speaker).
- AV-323, "Diagnosis Procedure" (rear
door speaker).
- AV-326, "Diagnosis Procedure" (rear
side speaker).
Sound signal circuit malfunction between
Bose speaker amp. and speaker.
Refer to:
- AV-320, "Diagnosis Procedure" (front
door speaker).
- AV-317, "Diagnosis Procedure" (front
tweeter).
- AV-314, "Diagnosis Procedure" (instru-
ment panel tweeter).
- AV-312, "Diagnosis Procedure" (center
speaker).
- AV-323, "Diagnosis Procedure" (rear
door speaker).
- AV-326, "Diagnosis Procedure" (rear
side speaker).
Malfunction in speaker.
Poor Installation of speaker (e.g. back-
lash and looseness).
Refer to:
- AV-373, "Removal and Installation" (front
door speaker).
- AV-374, "Removal and Installation" (front
tweeter).
- AV-375, "Removal and Installation" (in-
strument panel tweeter).
- AV-376, "Removal and Installation" (cen-
ter speaker).
- AV-377, "Removal and Installation" (rear
door speaker).
- AV-378, "Removal and Installation" (rear
side speaker).
Malfunction in AV control unit.
Refer to AV-214, "On Board Diagnosis
Function".
Malfunction in Bose speaker amp.
Replace Bose speaker amp. Refer to AV-
372, "Removal and Installation".
Noise is mixed with radio only (when the ve-
hicle hits a bump or while driving over bad
roads)
Poor connector connection of antenna or
antenna feeder.
Refer to AV-386, "Location of Antennas".
Symptoms Check items Probable malfunction location
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
MULTI AV SYSTEM
AV-361
< SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
RELATED TO HANDS-FREE PHONE
Before performing diagnosis, confirm that the cellular phone being used by the customer is compatible with
the vehicle.
It is possible that a malfunction is occurring due to a version change of the phone even though the phone is
a compatible type. This can be confirmed by changing the cellular phone to another compatible type, and
check that it operates normally. It is important to determine whether the cause of the malfunction is the vehi-
cle or the cellular phone.
Check Compatibility
1. Make sure the customers Bluetooth
wire-
less connection, the battery power of the cellular phone may dis-
charge quicker than usual. The Bluetooth
Hands-Free Phone
System cannot charge cellular phones.
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-364
< SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
NORMAL OPERATING CONDITION
The other partys voice cannot be heard by hands-free phone.
When the radio wave condition is not ideal or ambient sound is too
loud, it may be difficult to hear the other persons voice during a
call.
Poor sound quality.
Do not place the cellular phone in an area surrounded by metal or
far away from the in-vehicle phone module to prevent tone quality
degradation and wireless connection disruption.
Symptom Cause and Counter measure
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
AV CONTROL UNIT
AV-365
< REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
AV CONTROL UNIT
Exploded View INFOID:0000000009763202
Removal and Installation INFOID:0000000009763201
REMOVAL
CAUTION:
Remove battery terminal and AV control unit after a lapse of 30 seconds or more after turning the
ignition switch OFF.
Before replacing AV control unit, perform "READ CONFIGURATION" to save current vehicle specifi-
cation. Refer to AV-277, "CONFIGURATION (AV CONTROL UNIT) : Configuration List".
NOTE:
After the ignition switch is turned OFF, the AV control unit continues operating for approximately 30 seconds.
Therefore, data corruption may occur if battery voltage is cut off within 30 seconds.
1. Disconnect the negative battery terminal. Refer to PG-90, "Removal and Installation".
2. Remove cluster lid C. Refer to IP-22, "CLUSTER LID C : Removal and Installation".
3. Remove the screws, then pull out the AV control unit.
4. Disconnect the harness connectors from the AV control unit and remove.
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
CAUTION:
1. AV control unit bracket (LH) 2. A/C auto amp. 3. AV control unit
4. AV control unit bracket (RH)
ALNIA1436ZZ
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-366
< REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
AV CONTROL UNIT
When replacing AV control unit, perform "WRITE CONFIGURATION". Refer to AV-277, "CONFIGURA-
TION (AV CONTROL UNIT) : Configuration List".
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
A/C AND AV SWITCH ASSEMBLY
AV-367
< REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
A/C AND AV SWITCH ASSEMBLY
Removal and Installation INFOID:0000000009763203
REMOVAL
1. Remove cluster lid C lower. Refer to IP-22, "CLUSTER LID C LOWER : Removal and Installation".
2. Remove the A/C and AV switch assembly lower screws.
3. Release upper pawls and remove A/C and AV switch assembly.
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-368
< REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
STEERING SWITCH
STEERING SWITCH
Exploded View INFOID:0000000009174622
Removal and Installation INFOID:0000000009174623
REMOVAL
NOTE:
The steering switches are serviced as an assembly.
1. Remove steering wheel. Refer to ST-44, "Removal and Installation".
2. Release pawls and remove steering wheel rear finisher (1) from
steering wheel (2).
3. Remove steering switches screws.
4. Remove steering switches (1) from steering wheel (2).
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
1. Steering switches 2. Steering wheel 3. Steering wheel rear finisher
ALOIA0025ZZ
ALOIA0026ZZ
ALOIA0027ZZ
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
DISPLAY UNIT
AV-369
< REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
DISPLAY UNIT
Exploded View INFOID:0000000009763205
Removal and Installation INFOID:0000000009763204
REMOVAL
1. Remove cluster lid D. Refer to IP-24, "Removal and Installation".
2. Remove the display unit screws, then pull out the display unit and bracket.
3. Disconnect the harness connector from the display unit and remove.
4. Remove the display unit bracket screws and the display unit from the display unit bracket (if necessary).
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
1. Display unit 2. Display unit bracket A. Display unit bracket screws
ALNIA1430ZZ
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-370
< REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
HEADREST DISPLAY UNIT
HEADREST DISPLAY UNIT
Removal and Installation INFOID:0000000009174626
REMOVAL
CAUTION:
Do not press on the panel surface of display (glass area).
Do not press or pull out the movable part of display.
1. Remove the headrest trim retainer (A).
2. Remove the headrest display harness and upper tube screws
(A), then remove headrest display unit bolts (B).
3. Remove the headrest display escutcheon and headrest display.
a. Insert a suitable tool (A) between lower side of headrest display
escutcheon (1) and headrest trim (2) and pull out lower side of
escutcheon.
b. Pull out headrest display escutcheon (1) to the position that pawl
is visible and disengage pawl.
: Pawl
c. Pull out lower side of headrest display escutcheon from headrest.
JMJIA4069ZZ
JMJIA4070ZZ
JMJIA4071ZZ
AWNIA2554ZZ
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
HEADREST DISPLAY UNIT
AV-371
< REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
CAUTION:
Be careful not to damage pawls on upper side headrest display escutcheon.
d. Pull downward and remove headrest display escutcheon (1) and
headrest display unit (2) by pulling them out and removing pins
on upper side of display.
e. Disconnect inner harness connector.
f. Press headrest display escutcheon to the headrest display unit side. Disconnect pawls on upper side and
remove headrest display escutcheon.
4. Remove the headrest display harness upper tube from headrest trim.
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
JMJIA4233ZZ
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-372
< REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
BOSE SPEAKER AMP
BOSE SPEAKER AMP
Removal and Installation INFOID:0000000009174627
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect the negative battery terminal. Refer to PG-90, "Removal and Installation"
2. Remove third row seat. Refer to SE-107, "Removal and Installation".
3. Remove Bose speaker amp screws (A).
4. Disconnect the harness connectors (B) from the Bose speaker
amp. and remove.
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
ALNIA0918ZZ
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
FRONT DOOR SPEAKER
AV-373
< REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
FRONT DOOR SPEAKER
Exploded View INFOID:0000000009763207
Removal and Installation INFOID:0000000009763206
REMOVAL
1. Remove the front door finisher. Refer to INT-15, "Removal and Installation".
2. Remove the front door speaker bolts.
3. Pull out the front door speaker from the speaker bracket.
4. Disconnect the harness connector from front door speaker and remove.
5. Remove the speaker bracket bolts and the speaker bracket from front door (if necessary).
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
ALNIA1329ZZ
1. Speaker bracket bolt 2. Front door speaker 3. Speaker bolt
4. Speaker bracket
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-374
< REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
FRONT TWEETER
FRONT TWEETER
Removal and Installation INFOID:0000000009174630
REMOVAL
1. Remove the front pillar finisher (1). Refer to INT-19, "FRONT
PILLAR FINISHER : Removal and Installation"
2. Remove the two screws and the front tweeter (2).
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
JSNIA3786ZZ
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
INSTRUMENT PANEL SPEAKER/TWEETER
AV-375
< REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
INSTRUMENT PANEL SPEAKER/TWEETER
Removal and Installation INFOID:0000000009763208
REMOVAL
1. Remove instrument panel tweeter grille. Refer to IP-14, "Exploded View".
2. Remove the bolts (A), then pull out the instrument panel tweeter
(1).
3. Disconnect the harness connector from the instrument panel
tweeter (1) and remove.
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
ALNIA1423ZZ
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-376
< REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
CENTER SPEAKER
CENTER SPEAKER
Removal and Installation INFOID:0000000009174632
REMOVAL
1. Remove center speaker grille. Refer to IP-14, "Exploded View".
2. Remove the center speaker bolts (A).
3. Pull out the center speaker (1).
4. Disconnect the harness connector from the center speaker and
remove.
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
ALNIA1196ZZ
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
REAR DOOR SPEAKER
AV-377
< REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
REAR DOOR SPEAKER
Exploded View INFOID:0000000009763210
Removal and Installation INFOID:0000000009763209
REMOVAL
1. Remove the rear door finisher. Refer to INT-17, "Removal and Installation".
2. Remove the rear door speaker bolts.
3. Disconnect the harness connector from the rear door speaker and remove.
4. Remove the speaker bracket bolts and the speaker bracket from the rear door (if necessary).
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
1. Speaker bracket bolt 2. Rear door speaker 3. Speaker bolt
4. Speaker bracket
ALNIA1330ZZ
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-378
< REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
REAR SPEAKERS
REAR SPEAKERS
Removal and Installation INFOID:0000000009174635
REMOVAL
1. Remove the luggage side lower finisher. Refer to INT-31, "LUGGAGE SIDE LOWER FINISHER :
Removal and Installation".
2. Remove rear side speaker screws (A), then remove the rear
side and grille assembly (1) from the luggage side lower finisher.
3. Remove the screws (B) from the rear side speaker grille, then
remove the rear side speaker (2).
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
ALNIA1428ZZ
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
SUBWOOFER
AV-379
< REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
SUBWOOFER
Exploded View INFOID:0000000009174636
Removal and Installation INFOID:0000000009174637
REMOVAL
1. Open the storage box lid.
2. Remove the spare tire clamp.
3. Lift subwoofer to disconnect the harness connector and remove.
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
ALNIA1328ZZ
1. Spare tire clamp 2. Subwoofer 3. Harness
4. Bracket 5. Rear storage box
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-380
< REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
USB INTERFACE
USB INTERFACE
Removal and Installation INFOID:0000000009763211
REMOVAL
1. Remove shift selector finisher. Refer to IP-18, "Exploded View".
2. Disconnect the harness connector from the USB interface.
3. Release the pawl from the back of USB interface, then remove USB interface.
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
FRONT AUXILIARY INPUT JACKS
AV-381
< REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
FRONT AUXILIARY INPUT JACKS
Removal and Installation INFOID:0000000009763212
REMOVAL
1. Remove shift selector finisher. Refer to IP-18, "Exploded View".
2. Disconnect the harness connector from the front auxiliary input jack.
3. Remove front auxiliary input jack screws and the front auxiliary input jack.
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-382
< REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
BLUETOOTH CONTROL UNIT
BLUETOOTH CONTROL UNIT
Exploded View INFOID:0000000009174640
Removal and Installation INFOID:0000000009174641
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect the negative battery terminal. Refer to PG-90, "Removal and Installation".
2. Remove satellite radio tuner. Refer to AV-384, "Removal and Installation"
3. Disconnect the harness connectors from bluetooth control unit.
4. Remove bluetooth control unit screws and the bluetooth control unit.
5. Remove the bluetooth antenna screws and the bluetooth antenna.
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
1. Bluetooth control unit 2. Satellite radio tuner (if equipped) 3. Bluetooth antenna
Front
ALNIA1464ZZ
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
MICROPHONE
AV-383
< REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
MICROPHONE
Removal and Installation INFOID:0000000009763213
REMOVAL
1. Remove the front room/map lamp assembly. Refer to INL-58, "Removal and Installation".
2. Remove the microphone (1) from the front room/map lamp
assembly.
CAUTION:
Carefully handle the pawls that retain the microphone to
avoid damaging.
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
NOTE:
Make sure the microphone is firmly secure after installation.
AWNIA2584ZZ
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-384
< REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
SATELLITE RADIO TUNER
SATELLITE RADIO TUNER
Exploded View INFOID:0000000009763215
Removal and Installation INFOID:0000000009763214
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect the negative battery terminal. Refer to PG-90, "Removal and Installation".
2. Remove the luggage side lower finisher (LH). Refer to INT-31, "LUGGAGE SIDE LOWER FINISHER :
Removal and Installation".
3. Disconnect the harness connectors from satellite radio antenna.
4. Remove the screws and the satellite radio tuner.
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
1. Bluetooth control unit (if
equipped)
2. Satellite radio tuner 3. Bluetooth antenna
Front
ALNIA1464ZZ
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
REAR VIEW CAMERA
AV-385
< REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
REAR VIEW CAMERA
Removal and Installation INFOID:0000000009763216
REMOVAL
1. Remove the back door outer finisher. Refer to EXT-43, "Removal and Installation".
2. Remove rear view camera screws (A), then remove rear view
camera (1) from the back door outer finisher (2).
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
ALNIA1427ZZ
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-386
< REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
AUDIO ANTENNA
AUDIO ANTENNA
Location of Antennas INFOID:0000000009174646
Window Antenna Repair INFOID:0000000009174647
ELEMENT CHECK
1. Attach probe circuit tester (ohm setting) to antenna terminal on
each side.
1. Antenna base (satellite antenna and antenna
amp)
2. M502 3. M501
4. M503, M504 5. M505 6. Antenna Feeder
7. M95, M500 8. AV control unit M155
AWNIA2589ZZ
SEL250I
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
AUDIO ANTENNA
AV-387
< REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
When measuring continuity, wrap tin foil around the top of
probe. Then, press the foil against the wire with your finger.
2. If an element is broken, no continuity will exist.
3. To locate a break, move probe along element. Tester indication
will change abruptly when probe passes the broken point.
SEL122R
SEL252I
SEL253I
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-388
< REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
BLUETOOTH ANTENNA
BLUETOOTH ANTENNA
Removal and Installation INFOID:0000000009763982
REMOVAL
1. Remove luggage side lower finisher (LH). Refer to INT-31, "LUGGAGE SIDE LOWER FINISHER :
Removal and Installation".
2. Disconnect the bluetooth antenna harness connector from bluetooth control unit.
3. Remove bolts and the bluetooth antenna from bracket.
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
SATELLITE RADIO ANTENNA
AV-389
< REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
[MID AUDIO WITH BOSE]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
SATELLITE RADIO ANTENNA
Removal and Installation INFOID:0000000009174648
REMOVAL
1. Lower headlining (rear). Refer to INT-27, "Removal and Installation".
2. Disconnect harness connector from antenna feeder.
3. Remove nut from satellite antenna (1) and remove.
: Front
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
CAUTION:
If the satellite antenna nut is not tightened to the specified torque, lower sensitivity of the antenna may
be experienced. If the nut is tightened tighter than the specified torque, this will deform the roof panel.
Disassembly and Assembly INFOID:0000000009174649
DISASSEMBLY
Insert a suitable tool into gaps between satellite antenna (2) and the
cover (1), then remove the cover (1) from satellite antenna (2).
ASSEMBLY
Assembly is in the reverse order of disassembly.
AWNIA2587ZZ
ALNIA1335ZZ
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-390
< PRECAUTION >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
PRECAUTIONS
PRECAUTION
PRECAUTIONS
Precaution for Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) "AIR BAG" and "SEAT BELT
PRE-TENSIONER" INFOID:0000000009174650
The Supplemental Restraint System such as AIR BAG and SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER, used along
with a front seat belt, helps to reduce the risk or severity of injury to the driver and front passenger for certain
types of collision. Information necessary to service the system safely is included in the SR and SB section of
this Service Manual.
WARNING:
To avoid rendering the SRS inoperative, which could increase the risk of personal injury or death in
the event of a collision which would result in air bag inflation, all maintenance must be performed by
an authorized NISSAN/INFINITI dealer.
Improper maintenance, including incorrect removal and installation of the SRS, can lead to personal
injury caused by unintentional activation of the system. For removal of Spiral Cable and Air Bag
Module, see the SR section.
Do not use electrical test equipment on any circuit related to the SRS unless instructed to in this
Service Manual. SRS wiring harnesses can be identified by yellow and/or orange harnesses or har-
ness connectors.
PRECAUTIONS WHEN USING POWER TOOLS (AIR OR ELECTRIC) AND HAMMERS
WARNING:
When working near the Airbag Diagnosis Sensor Unit or other Airbag System sensors with the Igni-
tion ON or engine running, DO NOT use air or electric power tools or strike near the sensor(s) with a
hammer. Heavy vibration could activate the sensor(s) and deploy the air bag(s), possibly causing
serious injury.
When using air or electric power tools or hammers, always switch the Ignition OFF, disconnect the
battery and wait at least three minutes before performing any service.
Cautions in Removing Battery Terminal and AV Control Unit (Models with AV Control
Unit) INFOID:0000000009174651
CAUTION:
Remove battery terminal and AV control unit 30 seconds or more after turning the ignition switch OFF.
NOTE:
After the ignition switch is turned OFF, the AV control unit continues operating for approximately 30 seconds.
Therefore, data corruption may occur if battery voltage is cut off within 30 seconds.
Precaution for Trouble Diagnosis INFOID:0000000009174652
AV COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
Do not apply voltage of 7.0 V or higher to the measurement terminals.
Use the tester with its open terminal voltage being 7.0 V or less.
Be sure to turn ignition switch OFF and disconnect the battery cable from the negative terminal before
checking the circuit.
Precaution for Harness Repair INFOID:0000000009174653
AV COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
PRECAUTIONS
AV-391
< PRECAUTION >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
Solder the repaired parts, and wrap with tape. [Frays of twisted line
must be within 110 mm (4.33 in).]
Do not perform bypass wire connections for the repair parts. (The
spliced wire will become separated and the characteristics of
twisted line will be lost.)
Precaution for Work INFOID:0000000009174654
When removing or disassembling each component, be careful not to damage or deform it. If a component
may be subject to interference, be sure to protect it with a shop cloth.
When removing (disengaging) components with a screwdriver or similar tool, be sure to wrap the component
with a shop cloth or vinyl tape to protect it.
Protect the removed parts with a shop cloth and prevent them from being dropped.
Replace a deformed or damaged clip.
If a part is specified as a non-reusable part, always replace it with a new one.
Be sure to tighten bolts and nuts securely to the specified torque.
After installation is complete, be sure to check that each part works properly.
Follow the steps below to clean components:
- Water soluble dirt:
Dip a soft cloth into lukewarm water, wring the water out of the cloth and wipe the dirty area.
Then rub with a soft, dry cloth.
- Oily dirt:
Dip a soft cloth into lukewarm water with mild detergent (concentration: within 2 to 3%) and wipe the dirty
area.
Then dip a cloth into fresh water, wring the water out of the cloth and wipe the detergent off.
Then rub with a soft, dry cloth.
- Do not use organic solvent such as thinner, benzene, alcohol or gasoline.
- For genuine leather seats, use a genuine leather seat cleaner.
PKIA0306E
PKIA0307E
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-392
< PREPARATION >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
PREPARATION
PREPARATION
PREPARATION
Special Service Tool INFOID:0000000009174655
The actual shapes of Kent-Moore tools may differ from those of special service tools illustrated here.
Commercial Service Tools INFOID:0000000009174656
Tool number
(Kent-Moore No.)
Tool name
Description
(J-46534)
Trim tool set
Removing trim components
AWJIA0483ZZ
(Kent-Moore No.)
Tool name
Description
( )
Power tools
Loosening nuts, screws and bolts
PIIB1407E
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
COMPONENT PARTS
AV-393
< SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
COMPONENT PARTS
Component Parts Location INFOID:0000000009174657
AWNIA2808ZZ
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-394
< SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
COMPONENT PARTS
ALNIA1447ZZ
1. Front tweeter LH 2. Instrument panel tweeter LH 3. Steering switches
4. A/C and AV switch assembly 5. Front tweeter RH 6. Instrument panel tweeter RH
7. Display unit 8. Center speaker 9. AV control unit (view with center stack
removed)
10. Microphone 11. USB interface 12. Front auxiliary input jacks
13. Front door speaker LH 14. Front door speaker RH 15. Rear door speaker LH
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
COMPONENT PARTS
AV-395
< SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
Component Description INFOID:0000000009174658
16. Rear door tweeter LH 17. Rear side speaker LH 18. Rear side speaker RH
19. Headrest display unit (driver seat) 20. Rear auxiliary input jacks 21. Headrest display unit (passenger seat)
22. Subwoofer 23. Bose speaker amp. 24. Around view monitor control unit
25. Front camera 26. Rear camera 27. Door mirror LH (side camera)
28. Door mirror RH (side camera) 29. Video distributor
Part name Description
AV control unit
Master unit of MULTI AV system.
AV control unit includes audio, hands-free phone, navigation, USB connection,
DVD play and vehicle status functions.
Integrates hard disk drive (HDD) allowing map data and music data to be stored.
Connected to MULTI AV system control units via AV communication.
Connected to other vehicle control units via CAN communication to obtain neces-
sary information for vehicle function.
Receives steering angle signal via CAN communication from steering angle sen-
sor and controls an expected course line during around view monitor operation.
Inputs signals for driving status recognition (vehicle speed, reverse and parking
brake).
Composite image signal are output to front display unit.
Transmits image and sound output to video distributor and inputs image switch sig-
nal from headrest display units via AV communication.
Receives an Intelligent Key identification signal necessary for Intelligent Key inter-
locking function via hard wire from BCM.
Transmits Amp. ON signal and mode change signal to BOSE speaker amp.
Update of map data is performed using DVD-ROM.
Display unit
Display image is controlled by AV control unit via serial communication.
Receives power from AV control unit.
Composite image signals are input from AV control unit.
Synchronizing signals are output to AV control unit.
Camera image signals are input from around view monitor control unit via video
output signal.
Touch panel functions can be operated by touching display directly.
BOSE speaker amp.
Receives sound signals from AV control unit and outputs sound signals to each
speaker.
Instrument panel tweeter Outputs high range sound signals from BOSE speaker amp.
Center speaker Outputs mid and high range sound signals from BOSE speaker amp.
Front tweeter Outputs high range sound signals from BOSE speaker amp.
Front door speaker Outputs low, mid and high range sound signals from BOSE speaker amp.
Rear door tweeter Outputs high range sound signals from BOSE speaker amp.
Rear door speaker Outputs low, mid and high range sound signals from BOSE speaker amp.
Rear side speaker Outputs low, mid and high range sound signals from BOSE speaker amp.
Subwoofer Outputs low range sound signals from BOSE speaker amp.
A/C and AV switch assembly
Operation panels are equipped with switches for audio and air conditioner opera-
tions.
Operation signal is transmitted via AV communication to AV control unit and
around view monitor.
Disk eject operation signal is performed via hardwire.
Steering switches
Operations for audio, hands-free phone and voice recognition are possible.
Steering switch signal (operation signal) is output to AV control unit.
Steering angle sensor
Connected to AV control unit via CAN communication and transmits steering angle
sensor signal.
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-396
< SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
COMPONENT PARTS
Video distributor
Receives image and sound signals from AV control unit and transmits them to
headrest display units.
Receives image and sound signals from rear auxiliary input jacks and transmits
them to headrest display units.
Transmits image and sound signals to headrest display unit and receives image
switch signal from headrest display units.
Headrest display units
Composite image signals are input from video distributor.
Receives DVD/AUX/USB sound signals from video distributor and transmits them
to headphones.
Transmits image switch signal to video distributor according to remote control op-
eration.
Transmits image switch signal to AV control unit via AV communication according
to remote control operation.
Front auxiliary input jacks Transmits image and sound signals to AV control unit.
Rear auxiliary input jacks Transmits image and sound signals to video distributor and headrest display units.
Around view monitor control unit
Supplies power to front, rear and side cameras.
Superimposes images from each camera and outputs them to display unit.
Superimposes guiding line, predicted course line and sonar indicator to camera
image that outputs to display unit.
Performs reception/transmission of communication signals with cameras.
Transmits sonar operation signal from sonar control unit via CAN communication.
Receives sonar information from sonar control unit via CAN communication.
Transmits data received/transmitted from sonar control unit to AV control unit via
CAN communication.
Front camera
Inputs power supply from around view monitor control unit.
Outputs image of vehicle front to around view monitor control unit.
Performs reception/transmission of communication signal with around view moni-
tor control unit.
Rear view camera
Inputs power supply from around view monitor control unit.
Outputs image of vehicle rear to around view monitor control unit.
Performs reception/transmission of communication signal with around view moni-
tor control unit.
Side camera LH
Inputs power supply from around view monitor control unit.
Outputs image of vehicle LH side to around view monitor control unit.
Performs reception/transmission of communication signal with around view moni-
tor control unit.
Side camera RH
Inputs power supply from around view monitor control unit.
Outputs image of vehicle RH side to around view monitor control unit.
Performs reception/transmission of communication signal with around view moni-
tor control unit.
Microphone
Used for hands-free phone operations.
Microphone signal is transmitted to AV control unit.
Power (Microphone VCC) is supplied from AV control unit.
GPS antenna GPS signal is received and transmitted to AV control unit.
Antenna amp.
Radio signal received by window antenna is amplified and transmitted to AV con-
trol unit.
Power (antenna amp. ON signal) is supplied from AV control unit.
USB connector USB sound and data input signals are transmitted to AV control unit.
Part name Description
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
SYSTEM
AV-397
< SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
SYSTEM
MULTI AV SYSTEM
MULTI AV SYSTEM : System Diagram INFOID:0000000009174659
MULTI AV SYSTEM : System Description INFOID:0000000009174660
AUDIO SYSTEM
The audio system consists of the following components
AV control unit
A/C and AV switch assembly
Display unit
AWNIA2810GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-398
< SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
SYSTEM
Steering switches
BOSE speaker amp.
Center speaker
Instrument panel tweeters
Front tweeters
Front door speakers
Rear door tweeters
Rear door speakers
Rear side speakers
Subwoofer
Antenna
When the audio system is on, radio signals are received by the window antenna. The AV control unit then
sends audio signals to the BOSE speaker amp. The BOSE speaker amp. amplifies the audio signals before
sending them to the speakers, tweeters and subwoofer.
Refer to Owner's Manual for audio system operating instructions.
HANDS-FREE PHONE SYSTEM
System Operation
NOTE:
Cellular telephones must have their wireless connection set up (paired) before using the Bluetooth
telephone
system.
The Bluetooth
telephone system
Answer and end telephone calls
Adjust the volume of calls
Record memos
Microphone
The microphone is located in the roof console assembly. The microphone sends a signal to the AV control unit.
The microphone can be actively tested during self-diagnosis.
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
System Operation
NOTE:
Refer to NAVI System Owner's Manual for system operation.
The navigation system periodically calculates the vehicle's current position according to the following three
signals: Travel distance of the vehicle as determined by the vehicle speed sensor, turning angle of the vehicle
as determined by the gyroscope (angular velocity sensor), and the direction of vehicle travel as determined by
the GPS antenna (GPS information).
The current position of the vehicle is then identified by comparing the calculated vehicle position with map data
read from the map data, which is stored in the hard disk drive (HDD) (map-matching), and indicated on the
screen with a current-location mark.
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
SYSTEM
AV-399
< SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
By comparing the vehicle position detection results found by the
GPS and by map-matching, more accurate vehicle position data can
be used.
The current vehicle position will be calculated by detecting the dis-
tance the vehicle moved from the previous calculation point and its
direction.
Travel Distance
Travel distance calculations are based on the vehicle speed input signal. Therefore, the calculation may
become incorrect as the tires wear down. To prevent this, an automatic distance fine adjustment function has
been adopted.
Travel Direction
Change in the travel direction of the vehicle is calculated by a gyroscope (angular velocity sensor) and a GPS
antenna (GPS information). As the gyroscope and GPS antenna have both merit and demerit, input signals
from them are prioritized in each situation. However, this order of priority may change in accordance with more
detailed travel conditions so that the travel direction is detected more accurately.
MapMatching
Mapmatching is a function that repositions the vehicle on the road
map when a new location is judged to be the most accurate. This is
done by comparing the current vehicle position, calculated by the
method described in the position detection principle, with the road
map data around the vehicle, read from the map data stored on the
HDD.
Therefore, the vehicle position may not be corrected after the vehicle
is driven over a certain distance or time in which GPS information is
hard to receive. In this case, the current-location mark on the display
must be corrected manually.
CAUTION:
The road map data is based on data stored on the HDD.
In map-matching, alternative routes to reach the destination will be
shown and prioritized, after the road on which the vehicle is cur-
rently driven has been judged and the current-location mark has
been repositioned.
If there is an error in distance and/or direction, the alternative
routes will be shown in different order of priority, and the wrong
road can be avoided.
If two roads are running in parallel, they are of the same priority.
Therefore, the current-location mark may appear on either of them
alternately, depending on maneuvering of the steering wheel and
configuration of the road.
SEL684V
Type Advantage Disadvantage
Gyroscope (angular velocity sensor)
Can detect the vehicle's turning angle quite
accurately.
Direction errors may accumulate when the ve-
hicle is driven for long distances without stop-
ping.
GPS antenna (GPS information)
Can detect the vehicle's travel direction
(North/South/East/West).
Correct direction cannot be detected when the
vehicle speed is low.
SEL685V
SEL686V
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-400
< SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
SYSTEM
Map-matching does not function correctly when the road on which
the vehicle is driving is new and not recorded on the HDD, or when
the road pattern stored in the map data and the actual road pattern
are different due to repair.
When driving on a road not present in the map, the map-matching
function may find another road and position the current-location
mark on it. Then, when the correct road is detected, the current-
location mark may leap to it.
Effective range for comparing the vehicle position and travel direc-
tion calculated by the distance and direction with the road data
read from the HDD is limited. Therefore, when there is an exces-
sive gap between the current vehicle position and the position on
the map, correction by map-matching is not possible.
GPS (Global Positioning System)
GPS (Global Positioning System) has been developed and con-
trolled by the US Department of Defense. The system utilizes GPS
satellite (NAVSTAR), sending out radio waves while flying on an orbit
around the earth at the height of approx. 21,000 km (13,000 mi).
The GPS receiver calculates the vehicle's position in three dimen-
sions (latitude/longitude/altitude) according to the time lag of the
radio waves received from four or more GPS satellites (three-dimen-
sional positioning). If radio waves were received only from three
GPS satellites, the GPS receiver calculates the vehicle's position in
two dimensions (latitude/longitude), utilizing the altitude data calcu-
lated previously by using radio waves from four or more GPS satel-
lites (two-dimensional positioning).
Accuracy of the GPS will deteriorate under the following conditions.
In two-dimensional positioning, the GPS accuracy will deteriorate when the altitude of the vehicle position
changes.
There may be an error of approximately 10 m (30 ft.) in position detected by three-dimensional positioning,
which is more accurate than two-dimensional positioning. The accuracy can be even lower depending on the
arrangement of the GPS satellites utilized for the positioning.
Position detection is not possible when the vehicle is in an area where radio waves from the GPS satellite do
not reach, such as in a tunnel, parking lot in a building, and under an elevated highway. Radio waves from
the GPS satellites may not be received when some object is located over the GPS antenna.
Position correction by GPS is not available while the vehicle is stopped.
SPEED SENSITIVE VOLUME SYSTEM
Volume level of this system goes up and down automatically in proportion to the vehicle speed. The control
level can be selected by the customer. Refer to Owner's Manual for operating instructions.
FRONT AUXILIARY INPUT JACKS
Image and sound can be output from an external device connected to the front auxiliary input jacks.
AUX image signals are transmitted to each unit as follows:
- To the display unit via AV control unit.
- To the headrest display units via AV control unit and video distributor.
AUX sound signals are transmitted to each unit as follows:
- To each speaker via AV control unit and BOSE speaker amp.
- To video distributor via AV control unit.
Headphone sound signals are transmitted via infrared communication between headrest display units and
headphones.
REAR ENTERTAINMENT SYSTEM
Image and sound (DVD, USB memory-stored video data and front auxiliary input) played by AV control unit
can be enjoyed in rear seat using headrest display units and headphones.
Image and sound of an external device connected to rear auxiliary input jacks for rear seat can be enjoyed in
rear seat using headrest display units and headphones. Also, image and sound from rear auxiliary input
jacks can be selected and played individually on each side as well as on both sides.
NOTE:
Image signal and sound signal from rear auxiliary input jacks are not transmitted to front display unit and each
speaker.
ALNIA0671GB
SEL526V
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
SYSTEM
AV-401
< SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
Operation Signal
The rear entertainment system can be controlled by the rear seat remote control.
The rear seat remote control transmits the operation signal to the remote control receiver built into headrest
display units, which then transmits it to the AV control unit and video distributor.
Headphone Sound
Sound signals output from AV control unit or rear auxiliary input jacks are transmitted to headrest display
units via video distributor.
Headphone sound signals are transmitted via infrared communication between headrest display units and
headphones.
Headrest Display Units
Composite image signals from AV control unit are transmitted to headrest display unit via video distributor.
Image switch signals from headrest display units are transmitted to AV control unit and video distributor,
according to rear seat remote control operation.
When image switch signal is transmitted from headrest display unit to AV control unit via AV communication,
image played by AV control unit (DVD, USB memory-stored video data, and front auxiliary input) switches.
When image switch signal is transmitted from headrest display unit to video distributor, image output from
AV control unit and image output from rear auxiliary input jacks switch.
AROUND VIEW MONITOR SYSTEM
This system is equipped with wide-angle high-resolution cameras on the front and rear of the vehicle and on
both right and left door mirrors. The images from front view, rear view, front-side view (RH side), and birds-
eye view that shows the view from the top of the vehicle are displayed to monitor the vehicle surroundings.
Around view monitor control unit cuts out and expands the image received from each camera to create each
view.
The sonar indicator is viewed on display (superimposed on the camera image) in combination with the cam-
era assistance sonar system to warn of the approach of an obstacle.
In front view and rear view, the vehicle width, distance lines and predictive course lines are superimposed
and displayed. In front-side view, the vehicle distance guiding line and vehicle width guiding line are dis-
played.
The Birds-Eye view converts the images from 4 cameras into the overhead view and displays the status of
the vehicle. The vehicle icon and sonar indicator on the Birds-Eye view display are rendered by around view
monitor control unit.
Around View Monitor Screen
Around view monitor combines and displays the travel direction view and Birds-Eye view, Front-Side view
and then displays the sonar indicator on the Birds-Eye view, Front-Side view, Rear wide view.
AV control unit renders the Change View switch, view icon, warning message on display.
Operation Description
NOTE:
The first, second, and third camera image displayed when switched to the camera image display depends on
the settings of Camera View Priority.
Around view monitor operates by pressing the CAMERA switch on the A/C and AV switch assembly and
shifting the selector lever to the R position.
When the selector lever is in any position other than R, the screen is switched to the around view monitor by
pressing the CAMERA switch.
The screen is switched to the around view monitor by shifting the selector lever to the R position.
The around view monitors, Birds-Eye view, Front-side view or rear wide view (rear only) can be switched by
pressing the CAMERA switch.
The around view monitor is cancelled 3 minutes after pressing the CAMERA switch, and the display returns
to the previous screen.
ON/OFF setting of sonar indicator display on the Front-Side view screen can be performed.
In Birds-Eye view, the invisible area is displayed on the image to specify the boundary of the 4 cameras. The
invisible area is displayed in yellow in the Birds-Eye view after turning the ignition switch ON.
The sonar operates only when the camera screen is displayed.
VEHICLE INFORMATION FUNCTION
Status of audio, climate control system, fuel economy, maintenance and navigation are displayed.
AV control unit displays the fuel consumption status while receiving data signal through CAN communication
from ECM and combination meter.
AV control unit is connected to BCM via CAN communication transmitting/receiving for the vehicle settings
function.
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-402
< SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
SYSTEM
INTELLIGENT KEY INTERLOCKING FUNCTION
The AV control unit recognizes a door-unlocked state of Intelligent Key according to an Intelligent Key recogni-
tion signal transmitted from BCM and saves two different types of audio settings and navigation settings.
Settings saved in the AV control unit
Map display
Route guidance
Locator
Route search
Sound quality
Radio preset
Language
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (AV CONTROL UNIT)
AV-403
< SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (AV CONTROL UNIT)
Description INFOID:0000000009174661
The AV control unit on board diagnosis includes the following functions:
A/C and AV switch assembly self diagnosis that checks the ON/OFF operation (continuity) of each switch in
the A/C and AV switch assembly.
NOTE:
The hazard switch and disk eject switch are not included in this operation check.
AV control unit on board diagnosis performs the following functions listed in the table below:
Perform CONSULT diagnosis if the AV control unit on board diagnosis does not start, the screen does not dis-
play anything, or the A/C and AV switch assembly self diagnosis does not function.
On Board Diagnosis Function INFOID:0000000009174662
METHOD OF STARTING
A/C and AV Switch Assembly Self Diagnosis
Mode Description
Self Diagnosis
AV control unit diagnosis.
Diagnoses the connections across system components.
Confirmation/
Adjustment
Display Diagnosis
The following check functions are available: color tone check by color
bar display and white display, light and shade check by gray scale dis-
play and touch panel calibration response check.
Vehicle Signals
Diagnosis of signals can be performed for vehicle speed, parking brake,
lights, ignition, reverse, side view switch and room lamp.
Speaker Test The connection of a speaker can be confirmed by test tone.
Navigation
Steering Angle Ad-
justment
When there is a difference between the actual turning angle and the ve-
hicle mark turning angle, it can be adjusted.
Speed Calibration
When there is a difference between the current location mark and the ac-
tual location, it can be adjusted.
Error History
The system malfunction and the frequency when occurring in the past
are displayed. When the malfunctioning item is selected, the time and
place that the selected malfunction last occurred are displayed.
Synchronize FES Clock
Vehicle CAN Diagnosis The transmitting/receiving of CAN communication can be monitored.
AV COMM Diagnosis
The communication condition of each unit of Multi AV system can be
monitored.
Hands-free Phone
The received volume adjustment of hands-free phone, microphone
speaker check, and erase memory can be performed.
Camera cont.
Camera guidlines can be adjusted and the factory configuration can be
displayed.
Delete Unit Connection Log Erase the connection history of unit and error history.
Initialize Settings Initializes the AV control unit memory.
Version Information Version information of the AV control unit is displayed.
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-404
< SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (AV CONTROL UNIT)
Press the BACK and UP switches within 10 seconds after turning
the ignition switch from OFF to ACC and hold them for 3 seconds
or more.
The buzzer sounds, all indicators of the switches illuminate, and
the self-diagnosis mode begins.
The ON position continuity of each switch can be checked by
pressing the switch. The buzzer sounds if continuity is present.
The self diagnosis mode is canceled when the ignition switch is
turned OFF.
AV Control Unit Self Diagnosis
1. Turn the ignition ON.
2. Turn the audio system OFF.
3. While pressing the SETTING button, turn the volume control dial
clockwise or counterclockwise for 40 clicks or more. When self-
diagnosis mode begins, a short beep will be heard. Shifting from
current screen to previous screen is performed by pressing
BACK button.
4. The trouble diagnosis initial screen is displayed, and Self Diag-
nosis or Confirmation/Adjustment can be selected.
SELF DIAGNOSIS MODE
AV Control Unit Self Diagnosis
1. Select Self Diagnosis.
2. Self diagnosis screen is displayed. The bar graph visible in center of screen indicates progress of self
diagnosis.
ALNIA1451ZZ
ALNIA1452ZZ
AWNIA2600GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (AV CONTROL UNIT)
AV-405
< SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
3. Diagnosis results are displayed after the self-diagnosis is com-
pleted. The unit names and the connection lines are color-coded
according to the diagnostic results.
1: Control Unit (AV control unit) is displayed in red.
Replace AV control unit if Self Diagnosis did not run because control unit malfunction is indicated. The symptom is AV control
unit internal error. Refer to AV-611, "Removal and Installation".
If multiple errors occur at the same time for a single unit, the screen switch colors are determined according to the following order
of priority: red > gray.
4. Comments of self diagnosis results can be viewed in the diagno-
sis result screen.
AV Control Unit Self Diagnosis Results
AWNIA2813GB
Diagnosis results Unit Connection line
Normal Green Green
Connection malfunction Gray Yellow
Unit malfunction
1
Red Green
JPNIA1787ZZ
Only Unit Part Is Displayed In Red
Screen switch Description Possible cause
Control Unit
Malfunction is detected in AV control unit
power supply and ground circuits.
AV control unit power supply or ground
circuit.
Refer to AV-549, "AV CONTROL UNIT :
Diagnosis Procedure".
If no malfunction is detected in AV control
unit power supply and ground circuits, re-
place AV control unit.
Refer to AV-611, "Removal and Installa-
tion".
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-406
< SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (AV CONTROL UNIT)
AV Control Unit Confirmation/Adjustment
1. Select Confirmation/Adjustment.
2. Select each switch on the Confirmation/Adjustment screen to
display the relevant trouble diagnosis screen. Press the BACK
switch to return to the initial Confirmation/Adjustment screen.
A Connecting Cable Between Units Is Displayed In Yellow
Area with yellow connection lines Description Possible cause
Control unit Front Display
Malfunction is detected in serial communi-
cation circuits between AV control unit and
front display.
Serial communication circuits between AV
control unit and front display.
Control unit Switch
When one of the following is detected:
malfunction is detected in A/C and AV
switch assembly power supply and
ground circuits.
malfunction is detected in AV communi-
cation circuits between AV control unit
and A/C and AV switch assembly.
A/C and AV switch assembly power sup-
ply or ground circuit.
Refer to AV-552, "A/C AND AV SWITCH
ASSEMBLY : Diagnosis Procedure".
AV communication circuits between AV
control unit and A/C and AV switch as-
sembly.
Control unit GPS Antenna
GPS antenna connection malfunctions de-
tected.
Check the connection of the GPS antenna
connector.
Control unit Video Dist.(Rear)
Video Dist.(Rear) Rear display 2
When one of the following is detected:
malfunction is detected in video distribu-
tor power supply and ground circuits.
malfunction is detected in headrest dis-
play unit LH power supply and ground
circuits.
malfunction is detected in AV communi-
cation circuits between AV control unit
and headrest display unit (driver seat).
Video distributor power supply or ground
circuit.
Refer to AV-553, "VIDEO DISTRIBUTOR
: Diagnosis Procedure".
Headrest display unit LH power supply or
ground circuit.
Refer to AV-554, "HEADREST DISPLAY
UNIT : Diagnosis Procedure".
AV communication circuits between AV
control unit and headrest display unit
(driver seat).
Video Dist.(Rear) Rear display 2
When one of the following is detected:
malfunction is detected in headrest dis-
play unit RH power supply and ground
circuits.
malfunction is detected in AV communi-
cation circuits between headrest display
unit (driver seat) and headrest display
unit (passenger seat).
Headrest display unit RH power supply
or ground circuit.
Refer to AV-554, "HEADREST DISPLAY
UNIT : Diagnosis Procedure".
AV communication circuits between
headrest display unit (driver seat) and
headrest display unit (passenger seat).
JSNIA2990ZZ
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (AV CONTROL UNIT)
AV-407
< SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
Display Diagnosis
Vehicle Signals
A comparison check can be made of each actual vehicle signal and
the signals recognized by the system.
Speaker Test
AWNIA2603GB
JSNIA2991ZZ
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-408
< SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (AV CONTROL UNIT)
Select Speaker Test to display the Speaker Diagnosis screen. Press
Start to generate a test tone in a speaker. Press Start again to gener-
ate a test tone in the next speaker. Press End to stop the test tones.
Navigation
STEERING ANGLE ADJUSTMENT
The steering angle output value detected with the gyroscope is
adjusted.
SPEED CALIBRATION
During normal driving, distance error caused by tire wear and tire
pressure change is automatically adjusted for by the automatic dis-
tance correction function. This function, on the other hand, is for
immediate adjustment, in cases such as driving with tire chain fitted
on tires.
Error History
The self-diagnosis results are judged depending on whether any error occurs from when Self-diagnosis is
selected until the self-diagnosis results are displayed.
However, the diagnosis results are judged normal if an error has occurred before the ignition switch is turned
ON and then no error has occurred until the self-diagnosis start. Check the Error Record to detect any error
that may have occurred before the self-diagnosis start because of this situation.
The error record displays the time and place of the most recent occurrence of that error. However, take note of
the following points.
If there is a malfunction with the GPS antenna circuit board in the AV control unit, the correct date and time
of occurrence may not be able to be displayed.
Place of the error occurrence is represented by the position of the current location mark at the time an error
occurred. If current location mark has deviated from the correct position, then the place of the error occur-
rence cannot be located correctly.
The frequency of occurrence is displayed in a count up manner. The actual count up method differs depend-
ing on the error item.
Count up method A
The counter resets to 0 if an error occurs when ignition switch is turned ON. The counter increases by 1 if
the condition is normal at a next ignition ON cycle.
The counter upper limit is 39. Any counts exceeding 39 are ignored. The counter can be reset (no error
record display) with the Delete log switch or CONSULT.
Count up method B
JPNIA1828ZZ
JSNIA2179ZZ
JSNIA2180ZZ
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (AV CONTROL UNIT)
AV-409
< SYSTEM DESCRIPTION >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
The counter increases by 1 if an error occurs when ignition switch is ON. The counter will not decrease even
if the condition is normal at the next ignition ON cycle.
The counter upper limit is 50. Any counts exceeding 50 are ignored. The counter can be reset (no error
record display) with the Delete log switch or CONSULT.
Error item
Some error items may be displayed simultaneously according to the cause. If some error items are displayed
simultaneously, the detection of the cause can be performed by the combination of display items
Display type of occur-
rence frequency
Error history display item
Count up method A CAN communication line, control unit (CAN), AV communication line, control unit (AV)
Count up method B Other than the above
Error item Description Possible malfunction factor/Action to take
CAN COMM CIRCUIT
CAN communication malfunction is detect-
ed.
Perform diagnosis with CONSULT, and
then repair the malfunctioning parts accord-
ing to the diagnosis results.
Refer to AV-413, "CONSULT Function".
CONTROL UNIT (CAN)
CAN initial diagnosis malfunction is detect-
ed.
Replace the AV control unit if the malfunc-
tion occurs constantly.
Refer to AV-611, "Removal and Installa-
tion".
CONTROL UNIT (AV)
AV communication circuit initial diagnosis
malfunction is detected.
FLASH-ROM Error Of Control Unit
AV control unit malfunction is detected.
Connection Of Gyro
Connection of G Sensor
CAN Controller Memory Error
Bluetooth
Ignition
switch
ON
0 V
56
(B)
Ground Composite image signal Output
Ignition
switch
ON
At DVD image is displayed.
57
(BG)
I-Key memory
60
(W)
Ground Microphone VCC Output
Ignition
switch
ON
5.0 V
61
(W)
Ground
Communication signal
(CONTDISP)
Output
Ignition
switch
ON
When adjusting display
brightness.
62
(P)
CANL
Input/
Output
63
(LG)
AV communication signal
(L)
Input/
Output
64
(LG)
M CANL TRM
67
(P)
MR output
68
(LG)
Ground Ignition signal Input
Ignition
switch
ON
Battery voltage
69
(R)
Ground Reverse signal Input
Ignition
switch
ON
Selector lever is in R posi-
tion.
Battery voltage
Selector lever is in other
than R position.
0 V
70
(GR)
Ground
Vehicle speed signal (8-
pulse)
Input
Ignition
switch
ON
When vehicle speed is ap-
prox. 40 km/h (25 MPH)
NOTE:
The maximum voltage varies de-
pending on the specification
(destination unit).
Terminal
(Wire color)
Description
Condition
Reference value
(Approx.)
+ Signal name
Input/
Output
SKIB2251J
PKIB5039J
JSNIA0012GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
AV CONTROL UNIT
AV-421
< ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
71 Shield
72
(R)
Ground
Composite image synchro-
nizing signal
Output
Ignition
switch
ON
At DVD image is displayed.
75
(B)
59 Microphone signal Input
Ignition
switch
ON
Give a voice.
76 Shield
77
(B)
Ground
Communication signal
(DISPCONT)
Input
Ignition
switch
ON
When adjusting display
brightness.
78
(L)
CANH
Input/
Output
79
(SB)
AV communication signal
(H)
Input/
Output
80
(SB)
M CANH TRM
83
(R)
Ground Camera power supply Output
Ignition
switch
ON
Selector lever in R posi-
tion
6.0 V
84
(W)
Ground Camera ground Ignition switch ON 0 V
91
(W)
Ground AUX image signal Input
Ignition
switch
ON
At front AUX image is dis-
played.
92
(B)
Ground AUX image signal ground
Ignition
switch
ON
0 V
94 Shield
97
(Y)
Ground Disk eject signal Input
Ignition
switch
ON
Pressing the eject switch. 0 V
Except for above. 5.0 V
Terminal
(Wire color)
Description
Condition
Reference value
(Approx.)
+ Signal name
Input/
Output
SKIB2251J
PKIB5037J
PKIB5039J
SKIB2251J
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-422
< ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
AV CONTROL UNIT
Fail-Safe INFOID:0000000009174668
When the ambient temperature becomes extremely low or extremely high, AV control unit displays a message
and limits the function of the AV control unit.
FAIL-SAFE CONDITIONS
When the ambient temperature is 20C (4F) or lower, or when it is 70C (158F) or higher.
Display
The following messages are displayed during fail-safe:
98
(V)
Ground Switch ground
Ignition
switch
ON
0 V
105
(W)
Ground
Composite image signal
ground
Ignition
switch
ON
0 V
106 Shield
107
(B)
Ground Composite image signal Output
Ignition
switch
ON
When DVD, USB or front
AUX image is displayed on
headrest display unit LH or
RH.
121
(W)
V BUS signal
122
(G)
USB D+ signal
123
(L)
USB ground
124
(R)
USB D signal
125 Shield
126
(B)
Ground Antenna amp. ON signal Input
Ignition
switch
ON
Battery voltage
127
(B)
AM-FM main Input
128
(B)
FM sub Input
129
(B)
Ground
Satellite radio antenna sig-
nal
Input
Ignition
switch
ON
Satellite antenna discon-
nected.
5.0 V
130
(B)
131 GPS antenna signal Input
Ignition
switch
ON
GPS antenna disconnect-
ed.
5.0 V
Terminal
(Wire color)
Description
Condition
Reference value
(Approx.)
+ Signal name
Input/
Output
SKIB2251J
Fail-safe mode Display
When HDD temperature is low
HDD system is experiencing problems due to extreme low temperature.
Normal operation will resume when temperature rises.
When HDD temperature is high
HDD system is experiencing problems due to extreme high temperature.
Normal operation will resume when temperature drops.
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
AV CONTROL UNIT
AV-423
< ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
DESCRIPTION OF CONTROLS
Ability Operation Mode
If HDD data can be read, Fail-safe mode is displayed and functions listed above can be operated.
DTC Index INFOID:0000000009174669
SELF-DIAGNOSIS RESULTS DISPLAY ITEM
Function Fail-safe mode activated
Air conditioner
Operation A/C and AV switch assembly can be operated.
Display
LEDs of A/C and AV switch assembly illuminate.
Temperature, mode and blower speed are displayed in a simplified mode.
Audio
Operation Only ON/OFF and volume control operations of A/C and AV switch assembly are available.
Display Fail-safe mode is displayed.
Camera
Operation Image tone cannot be controlled.
Display Cannot be superimposed. (warning display, tone control display)
Hands-free phone Operation Inoperative.
Navigation Operation Inoperative.
Self diagnosis Displays in a simplified mode.
CONSULT diagnosis Inoperative.
CONSULT Display Reference Page
U1000: CAN COMM CIRCUIT AV-499, "DTC Logic"
U1010: CONTROL UNIT (CAN) AV-500, "DTC Logic"
U1200: CONT UNIT AV-501, "DTC Logic"
U1201: GYRO NO CONN AV-502, "DTC Logic"
U1202: G-SENSOR NO CONN AV-503, "DTC Logic"
U1204: GPS COMM AV-504, "DTC Logic"
U1205: GPS ROM AV-505, "DTC Logic"
U1206: GPS RAM AV-506, "DTC Logic"
U1207: GPS RTC AV-507, "DTC Logic"
U1216: CAN CONT AV-508, "DTC Logic"
U1217: BLUETOOTH MODULE AV-509, "DTC Logic"
U1218: HDD CONN AV-510, "DTC Logic"
U1219: HDD READ AV-511, "DTC Logic"
U121A: HDD WRITE AV-512, "DTC Logic"
U121B: HDD COMM AV-513, "DTC Logic"
U121C: HDD ACCESS AV-514, "DTC Logic"
U121D: DSP CONN AV-515, "DTC Logic"
U121E: DSP COMM AV-516, "DTC Logic"
U1225: USB CONTROLLER AV-517, "DTC Logic"
U1227: DVD COMM AV-518, "DTC Logic"
U1228: SUB CPU CONN AV-519, "DTC Logic"
U1229: iPod CERTIFICATION AV-520, "DTC Logic"
U122A: CONFIG UNFINISH AV-521, "DTC Logic"
U122E: Built-in AUDIO CONN AV-522, "DTC Logic"
U1231: AMP TEMP AV-523, "DTC Logic"
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-424
< ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
AV CONTROL UNIT
U1232: ST ANGLE SEN CALIB AV-524, "DTC Logic"
U1243: FRONT DISP CONN AV-525, "DTC Logic"
U1244: GPS ANTENNA CONN AV-527, "DTC Logic"
U1258: XM ANTENNA CONN AV-528, "DTC Logic"
U125A: 3RD DISP CONN AV-529, "DTC Logic"
U1263: USB OVERCURRENT AV-530, "DTC Logic"
U1264: ANTENNA AMP TERMINAL (OPEN or SHORT) AV-531, "DTC Logic"
U1265: AMP ON TERMINAL (GND-SHORT or VB-SHORT) AV-532, "DTC Logic"
U1300: AV COMM CIRCUIT
U1240: SWITCH CONN
AV-533, "Description"
U1300: AV COMM CIRCUIT
U124E: AMP CONN
U1300: AV COMM CIRCUIT
U1246: VIDEO DIST CONN
U1300: AV COMM CIRCUIT
U125B: AROUND CAMERA CONN
U1300: AV COMM CIRCUIT
U125C: SONAR CONN
U1300: AV COMM CIRCUIT
U1240: SWITCH CONN
U125C: SONAR CONN
U125B: AROUND CAMERA CONN
U1246: VIDEO DIST CONN
U1300: AV COMM CIRCUIT
U1240: SWITCH CONN
U124E: AMP CONN
U125C: SONAR CONN
U125B: AROUND CAMERA CONN
U1246: VIDEO DIST CONN
U1310: CONTROL UNIT (AV) AV-542, "DTC Logic"
U1601: FL-DOOR WOOFER/TWEETER
(OPEN, SHORT, GND-SHORT)
AV-543, "DTC Logic"
U1603: FL-DOOR WOOFER/TWEETER
(VB-SHOR)
U1609: FR-DOOR WOOFER/TWEETER
(OPEN, SHORT, GND-SHORT)
U160B: FR-DOOR WOOFER/TWEETER
(VB-SHOR)
U1627: F-INST L-TWEETER
(OPEN, SHORT, GND-SHORT or VB-SHOR)
AV-544, "DTC Logic"
U162F: F-INST R-TWEETER
(OPEN, SHORT, GND-SHORT or VB-SHOR)
U162A: F-INST C-SQAWK
(OPEN, SHORT, GND-SHORT or VB-SHOR)
AV-545, "DTC Logic"
U1684: 2L-DOOR SPEAKER/TWEETER
(OPEN, SHORT, GND-SHORT)
AV-546, "DTC Logic"
U168C: 2R-DOOR SPEAKER/TWEETER
(OPEN, SHORT, GND-SHORT)
U175D: R-LUGGAGE L-WOOFER
(OPEN, SHORT, GND-SHORT or VB-SHOR)
AV-547, "DTC Logic"
CONSULT Display Reference Page
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
AV CONTROL UNIT
AV-425
< ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
U176A: R-ROOF L-WK
(OPEN, SHORT, GND-SHORT or VB-SHOR)
AV-548, "DTC Logic"
U1772: R-ROOF R-WK
(OPEN, SHORT, GND-SHORT or VB-SHOR)
CONSULT Display Reference Page
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-426
< ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
DISPLAY UNIT
DISPLAY UNIT
Reference Value INFOID:0000000009174670
TERMINAL LAYOUT
PHYSICAL VALUES
AWNIA2572ZZ
Terminal
(Wire color)
Description
Condition
Reference value
(Approx.)
+ Signal name
Input/
Output
6 Shield
7 Shield
8
(B)
Ground Camera image signal Input
Ignition
switch
ON
At camera image is dis-
played.
9
(B)
Ground
Communication signal
(DISPCONT)
Output
Ignition
switch
ON
When adjusting display
brightness.
10
(W)
Ground
Communication signal
(CONTDISP)
Input
Ignition
switch
ON
When adjusting display
brightness.
11
(Y)
Ground Battery power supply Input
Ignition
switch
OFF
Battery voltage
12
(B)
Ground Ground
Ignition
switch
ON
0 V
SKIB2251J
PKIB5039J
PKIB5039J
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
DISPLAY UNIT
AV-427
< ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
18
(B)
Ground Composite image signal Input
Ignition
switch
ON
At DVD image is displayed.
19
(W)
Ground
Composite image signal
ground
Ignition
switch
ON
0 V
20
(R)
Ground
Composite image synchro-
nizing signal
Input
Ignition
switch
ON
22 Shield
23
(P)
Ground ACC power supply Input
Ignition
switch
ACC
Battery voltage
Terminal
(Wire color)
Description
Condition
Reference value
(Approx.)
+ Signal name
Input/
Output
SKIB2251J
SKIB0825E
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-428
< ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
BOSE AMP.
BOSE AMP.
Reference Value INFOID:0000000009174671
TERMINAL LAYOUT
PHYSICAL VALUES
ALNIA1354ZZ
Terminal
(Wire color)
Description
Condition
Reference value
(Approx.)
+ Signal name
Input/
Output
41
(R)
42
(G)
Sound signal tweeter LH Output
Ignition
switch
ON
Sound output
44
(W)
43
(G)
Sound signal rear speaker
RH
Output
Ignition
switch
ON
Sound output
45
(G)
46
(W)
Sound signal tweeter RH Output
Ignition
switch
ON
Sound output
47
(B)
Ground
Ignition
switch
ON
0 V
50
(LG)
Ground Battery power supply Input
Ignition
switch
OFF
Battery voltage
51
(Y)
Ground Battery power supply Input
Ignition
switch
OFF
Battery voltage
52
(B)
Ground
Ignition
switch
ON
0 V
SKIB3609E
SKIB3609E
SKIB3609E
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
BOSE AMP.
AV-429
< ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
53
(W)
48
(G)
Sound signal rear speaker
LH
Output
Ignition
switch
ON
Sound output
54
(G)
49
(W)
Sound signal rear door
speaker RH
Output
Ignition
switch
ON
Sound output
57
(W)
56
(B)
Sound signal woofer Output
Ignition
switch
ON
Sound output
58
(G)
59
(R)
Sound signal front door
speaker LH
Output
Ignition
switch
ON
Sound output
60
(W)
Ground BOSE amp. ON signal Input
Ignition
switch
ON
Battery voltage
61 Shield
62
(W)
64
(B)
63
(W)
Sound signal rear LH Input
Ignition
switch
ON
Sound output
66
(B)
65
(W)
Sound signal rear RH Input
Ignition
switch
ON
Sound output
Terminal
(Wire color)
Description
Condition
Reference value
(Approx.)
+ Signal name
Input/
Output
SKIB3609E
SKIB3609E
SKIB3609E
SKIB3609E
SKIB3609E
SKIB3609E
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-430
< ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
BOSE AMP.
68
(P)
55
(R)
Sound signal rear door
speaker LH
Output
Ignition
switch
ON
Sound output
69
(P)
70
(R)
Sound signal center speak-
er
Output
Ignition
switch
ON
Sound output
71
(W)
72
(P)
Sound signal front door
speaker RH
Output
Ignition
switch
ON
Sound output
73
(B)
74
(W)
Sound signal front RH Input
Ignition
switch
ON
Sound output
75
(B)
76
(W)
Sound signal front LH Input
Ignition
switch
ON
Sound output
Terminal
(Wire color)
Description
Condition
Reference value
(Approx.)
+ Signal name
Input/
Output
SKIB3609E
SKIB3609E
SKIB3609E
SKIB3609E
SKIB3609E
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
VIDEO DISTRIBUTOR
AV-431
< ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
VIDEO DISTRIBUTOR
Reference Value INFOID:0000000009174672
TERMINAL LAYOUT
PHYSICAL VALUES
JSNIA3024ZZ
Terminal
(Wire color)
Description
Condition
Reference value
(Approx.)
+ Signal name
Input/
Output
1
(B)
Ground
Ignition
switch
ON
0 V
2
(V)
Ground Battery power supply Input
Ignition
switch
OFF
Battery voltage
3
(B)
Ground
Ignition
switch
ON
0 V
4
(W)
Ground ACC power supply Input
Ignition
switch
ACC
Battery voltage
5
(BR)
Ground
Cont. ground for headrest
display unit RH
Ignition
switch
ON
0 V
6
(L)
Ground
ACC signal for headrest
display unit RH
Output
Ignition
switch
OFF
3.3 V
Ignition
switch
ACC
0 V
7
(SB)
Ground
Cont. ground for headrest
display unit LH
Ignition
switch
ON
0 V
8
(BR)
Ground
ACC signal for headrest
display unit LH
Output
Ignition
switch
OFF
3.3 V
Ignition
switch
ACC
0 V
9
(SB)
Ground
Image switch signal for
headrest display unit RH
Input
Ignition
switch
ON
When DVD, USB or front
AUX image is displayed on
headrest display unit RH.
0.5 V
When rear AUX image is
displayed on headrest dis-
play unit RH.
4.5 V
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-432
< ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
VIDEO DISTRIBUTOR
10
(L)
Ground
Image switch signal for
headrest display unit LH
Input
Ignition
switch
ON
When DVD, USB or front
AUX image is displayed on
headrest display unit LH.
0.5 V
When rear AUX image is
displayed on headrest dis-
play unit LH.
4.5 V
14
(R)
15
(G)
Headphone sound signal
RH for headrest display unit
RH
Output
Ignition
switch
ON
Output headphone sound
from headrest display unit
RH to headphone.
16
(B)
17
(W)
Headphone sound signal
LH for headrest display unit
RH
Output
Ignition
switch
ON
Output headphone sound
from headrest display unit
RH to headphone.
18
(V)
Ground
AV ground for headrest dis-
play unit RH
Ignition
switch
ON
0 V
19
(V)
Ground
AV ground for headrest dis-
play unit LH
Ignition
switch
ON
0 V
20
(B)
21
(G)
Headphone sound signal
RH for headrest display unit
LH
Output
Ignition
switch
ON
Output headphone sound
from headrest display unit
LH to headphone.
22
(W)
23
(R)
Headphone sound signal
LH for headrest display unit
LH
Output
Ignition
switch
ON
Output headphone sound
from headrest display unit
LH to headphone.
27
(W)
Ground
Composite image signal
ground for headrest display
unit RH
Ignition
switch
ON
0 V
28
(B)
Ground
Composite image signal for
headrest display unit RH
Output
Ignition
switch
ON
When DVD, USB, front
AUX or rear AUX image is
displayed on headrest dis-
play unit RH.
Terminal
(Wire color)
Description
Condition
Reference value
(Approx.)
+ Signal name
Input/
Output
SKIB3609E
SKIB3609E
SKIB3609E
SKIB3609E
SKIB2251J
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
VIDEO DISTRIBUTOR
AV-433
< ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
29 Shield
30 Shield
31
(P)
Ground
Composite image signal
ground for headrest display
unit LH
Ignition
switch
ON
0 V
32
(L)
Ground
Composite image signal for
headrest display unit LH
Output
Ignition
switch
ON
When DVD, USB, front
AUX or rear AUX image is
displayed on headrest dis-
play unit LH.
33
(W)
Ground
Composite image signal
ground
Ignition
switch
ON
0 V
34
(B)
Ground Composite image signal Input
Ignition
switch
ON
When DVD, USB or front
AUX image is displayed on
headrest display unit LH or
RH.
35 Shield
40
(B)
39
(W)
AUX image signal Input
Ignition
switch
ON
When rear AUX image is
displayed on headrest dis-
play unit LH or RH.
41 Shield
45
(W)
46
(R)
Sound signal LH Input
Ignition
switch
ON
When DVD, USB or front
AUX mode is selected on
headrest display unit LH or
RH.
47
(B)
48
(G)
Sound signal RH Input
Ignition
switch
ON
When DVD, USB or front
AUX mode is selected on
headrest display unit LH or
RH.
49 Shield
53 Shield
Terminal
(Wire color)
Description
Condition
Reference value
(Approx.)
+ Signal name
Input/
Output
SKIB2251J
SKIB2251J
SKIB2251J
SKIB3609E
SKIB3609E
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-434
< ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
VIDEO DISTRIBUTOR
54
(B)
56
(W)
AUX sound signal LH Input
Ignition
switch
ON
When rear AUX mode is
selected on headrest dis-
play unit LH or RH.
55
(R)
56
(W)
AUX sound signal RH Input
Ignition
switch
ON
When rear AUX mode is
selected on headrest dis-
play unit LH or RH.
Terminal
(Wire color)
Description
Condition
Reference value
(Approx.)
+ Signal name
Input/
Output
SKIB3609E
SKIB3609E
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
HEADREST DISPLAY UNIT
AV-435
< ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
HEADREST DISPLAY UNIT
Reference Value INFOID:0000000009174673
TERMINAL LAYOUT
PHYSICAL VALUES
Driver Seat
ALNIA1528ZZ
Terminal
(Wire color)
Description
Condi-
tion
Reference value
(Approx.)
+ Signal name
Input/
Output
Ignition
switch
Operation
1
(W)
17
(B)
Headphone sound signal
LH
Input ON Headphone sound output
2
(G)
18
(R)
Headphone sound signal
RH
Input ON Headphone sound output
3
(LG)
AV communication signal
(L)
Input/
Output
11
(P)
AV communication signal
(H)
Input/
Output
12
(G)
Ground Ground ON 0 V
13
(BR)
Ground Illumination Input OFF Battery voltage
15
(W)
Ground Battery power supply Input OFF Battery voltage
16
(W)
Ground Battery power supply Input OFF Battery voltage
19
(V)
Ground AV ground ON 0 V
20
(P)
AV communication signal
(L)
Input/
Output
27
(LG)
AV communication signal
(H)
Input/
Output
29
(GR)
CON CK B
Input/
Output
31
(G)
Ground Ground ON 0 V
32
(G)
Ground Ground ON 0 V
Terminal
(Wire color)
Description
Condi-
tion
Reference value
(Approx.)
+ Signal name
Input/
Output
Ignition
switch
Operation
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
HEADREST DISPLAY UNIT
AV-437
< ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
Terminal
(Wire color)
Description
Condi-
tion
Reference value
(Approx.)
+ Signal name
Input/
Output
Ignition
switch
Operation
1
(W)
17
(B)
Headphone sound signal
LH
Input ON Headphone sound output
2
(G)
18
(R)
Headphone sound signal
RH
Input ON Headphone sound output
3
(LG)
AV communication signal
(L)
Input/
Output
11
(P)
AV communication signal
(H)
Input/
Output
13
(BR)
Ground Illumination Input OFF Battery voltage
15
(W)
Ground Battery power supply Input OFF Battery voltage
16
(W)
Ground Battery power supply Input OFF Battery voltage
19
(V)
Ground AV ground ON 0 V
20
(P)
AV communication signal
(L)
Input/
Output
27
(LG)
AV communication signal
(H)
Input/
Output
28
(G)
Ground Ground ON 0 V
29
(GR)
CON CK B
Input/
Output
31
(G)
Ground Ground ON 0 V
32
(G)
Ground Ground ON 0 V
Terminal
(Wire color)
Description
Condi-
tion
Reference value
(Approx.)
+ Signal name
Input/
Output
Ignition
switch
Operation
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
AROUND VIEW MONITOR CONTROL UNIT
AV-439
< ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
AROUND VIEW MONITOR CONTROL UNIT
Reference Value INFOID:0000000009174674
VALUES ON THE DIAGNOSIS TOOL
TERMINAL LAYOUT
PHYSICAL VALUES
Monitor Item Condition Value/Status
CAMERA OFF SIGNAL
CAMERA switch ON. Off
CAMERA switch OFF. On
CAMERA SWITCH SIGNAL
CAMERA switch OFF. Off
CAMERA switch ON. On
DR-SIDE CAMERA IMAGE SIG
Side camera LH inoperative. NG
Side camera LH operative. OK
F-CAMERA IMAGE SIG
Front camera inoperative. NG
Front camera operative. OK
PA-SIDE CAMERA IMAGE SIG
Side camera RH inoperative. NG
Side camera RH operative. OK
REAR CAMERA IMAGE SIGNAL
Rear camera LH inoperative. NG
Rear camera LH operative. OK
REVERSE SIGNAL
When selector lever is in any position other than R (reverse). Off
When selector lever in R (reverse). On
ST ANGLE SENSOR SIGNAL
Around view monitor control unit is not receiving steering angle
sensor signal.
Off
Around view monitor control unit is receiving steering angle sen-
sor signal.
On
ST ANGLE SENSOR TYPE Steering angle sensor type. Absolute
STEERING GEAR RATIO TYPE Steering gear ratio type. Type O
STEERING POSITION
Left hand drive vehicle. LHD
Right hand drive vehicle. RHD
VEHICLE SPEED SIGNAL While driving, equivalent to speedometer reading mph, km/h
AWNIA2812ZZ
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-440
< ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
AROUND VIEW MONITOR CONTROL UNIT
Terminal
(Wire color)
Description
Condition
Reference value
(Approx.)
+ Signal name
Input/
Output
1
(B)
Ground Ground
Ignition
switch
ON
0 V
2
(Y)
Ground Battery power supply Input
Ignition
switch
OFF
Battery voltage
3
(G)
Signal ground
4
(LG)
Ground Ignition signal Input
Ignition
switch
ON
Battery voltage
5
(P)
Camera direct OFF
7
(BG)
RX
8
(LG)
Ground Reverse signal Input
Ignition
switch
ON
R position Battery voltage
Other than R position 0 V
10
(P)
V-CAN (L)
12
(L)
V-CAN (H)
19 Shield
20
(B)
External video output
23 Shield
24
(B)
Ground Camera image signal Output
Ignition
switch
ON
At camera image display
25
(B)
Ground Rear camera ground
Ignition
switch
ON
0 V
26
(W)
Ground Rear camera power supply Output
Ignition
switch
ON
CAMERA switch is ON or
shift position is R.
6.0 V
28
(R)
27 Rear camera image signal Input
Ignition
switch
ON
CAMERA switch is ON or
shift position is R.
29
(B)
Ground
Side camera driver side
ground
Ignition
switch
ON
0 V
SKIB2251J
JSNIA0834GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
AROUND VIEW MONITOR CONTROL UNIT
AV-441
< ECU DIAGNOSIS INFORMATION >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
DTC Index INFOID:0000000009174675
30
(W)
Ground
Side camera driver side power
supply
Output
Ignition
switch
ON
CAMERA switch is ON or
shift position is R.
6.0 V
32
(R)
31
Side camera driver side image
signal
Input
Ignition
switch
ON
CAMERA switch is ON or
shift position is R.
33
(B)
Ground
Side camera passenger side
ground
Ignition
switch
ON
0 V
34
(W)
Ground
Side camera passenger side
power supply
Output
Ignition
switch
ON
CAMERA switch is ON or
shift position is R.
6.0 V
36
(R)
35
Side camera passenger side
image signal
Input
Ignition
switch
ON
CAMERA switch is ON or
shift position is R.
37
(B)
Ground Front camera ground
Ignition
switch
ON
0 V
38
(R)
Ground Front camera power supply Output
Ignition
switch
ON
CAMERA switch is ON or
shift position is R.
6.0 V
40
(W)
39 Front camera image signal Input
Ignition
switch
ON
CAMERA switch is ON or
shift position is R.
Terminal
(Wire color)
Description
Condition
Reference value
(Approx.)
+ Signal name
Input/
Output
JSNIA0834GB
JSNIA0834GB
JSNIA0834GB
CONSULT Display Reference Page
U1302: CAMERA SUPPLY POWER SUPPLY VOLTAGE ABNORMALITY AV-534, "DTC Logic"
U1303: LED SUPPLY POWER SUPPLY VOLTAGE ABNORMALITY AV-538, "DTC Logic"
U1304: NON-COMPLETION OF THE CALIBRATION AV-540, "DTC Logic"
U1305: NON-COMPLETION OF THE WRITE CONFIGURATION AV-541, "DTC Logic"
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-442
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
PREMIUM AUDIO SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
PREMIUM AUDIO SYSTEM
Wiring Diagram INFOID:0000000009174676
ABNWA1844GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
PREMIUM AUDIO SYSTEM
AV-443
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
ABNWA1845GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-444
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
PREMIUM AUDIO SYSTEM
ABNWA1846GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
PREMIUM AUDIO SYSTEM
AV-445
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
ABNWA1847GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-446
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
PREMIUM AUDIO SYSTEM
ABNWA1861GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
PREMIUM AUDIO SYSTEM
AV-447
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
ABNWA1848GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-448
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
PREMIUM AUDIO SYSTEM
ABNWA1849GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
PREMIUM AUDIO SYSTEM
AV-449
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
ABNWA1850GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-450
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
PREMIUM AUDIO SYSTEM
ABNIA4811GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
PREMIUM AUDIO SYSTEM
AV-451
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
ABNIA4812GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-452
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
PREMIUM AUDIO SYSTEM
ABNIA4813GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
PREMIUM AUDIO SYSTEM
AV-453
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
ABNIA4814GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-454
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
PREMIUM AUDIO SYSTEM
AANIA1228GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
PREMIUM AUDIO SYSTEM
AV-455
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
ABNIA4816GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-456
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
PREMIUM AUDIO SYSTEM
ABNIA4817GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
PREMIUM AUDIO SYSTEM
AV-457
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
ABNIA4818GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-458
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
PREMIUM AUDIO SYSTEM
ABNIA4819GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
PREMIUM AUDIO SYSTEM
AV-459
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
ABNIA4820GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-460
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
PREMIUM AUDIO SYSTEM
ABNIA4821GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
PREMIUM AUDIO SYSTEM
AV-461
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
ABNIA4822GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-462
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
PREMIUM AUDIO SYSTEM
ABNIA4823GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
PREMIUM AUDIO SYSTEM
AV-463
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
ABNIA4824GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-464
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
PREMIUM AUDIO SYSTEM
ABNIA4825GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
PREMIUM AUDIO SYSTEM
AV-465
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
ABNIA4826GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-466
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
PREMIUM AUDIO SYSTEM
ABNIA4827GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
PREMIUM AUDIO SYSTEM
AV-467
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
ABNIA4828GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-468
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
PREMIUM AUDIO SYSTEM
ABNIA4829GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
PREMIUM AUDIO SYSTEM
AV-469
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
ABNIA4830GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-470
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
PREMIUM AUDIO SYSTEM
ABNIA4831GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
PREMIUM AUDIO SYSTEM
AV-471
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
ABNIA4832GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-472
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
PREMIUM AUDIO SYSTEM
ABNIA4833GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
PREMIUM AUDIO SYSTEM
AV-473
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
ABNIA4834GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-474
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
PREMIUM AUDIO SYSTEM
ABNIA4835GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
PREMIUM AUDIO SYSTEM
AV-475
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
ABNIA4836GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-476
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
PREMIUM AUDIO SYSTEM
ABNIA4837GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
PREMIUM AUDIO SYSTEM
AV-477
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
ABNIA4838GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-478
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
PREMIUM AUDIO SYSTEM
ABNIA4839GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
PREMIUM AUDIO SYSTEM
AV-479
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
ABNIA4840GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-480
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
PREMIUM AUDIO SYSTEM
ABNIA4841GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
PREMIUM AUDIO SYSTEM
AV-481
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
ABNIA4842GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-482
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
PREMIUM AUDIO SYSTEM
ABNIA4843GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
PREMIUM AUDIO SYSTEM
AV-483
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
ABNIA4852GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-484
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
PREMIUM AUDIO SYSTEM
ABNIA4855GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
PREMIUM AUDIO SYSTEM
AV-485
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
ABNIA4856GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-486
< WIRING DIAGRAM >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
PREMIUM AUDIO SYSTEM
ABNIA4857GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORKFLOW
AV-487
< BASIC INSPECTION >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
BASIC INSPECTION
DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORKFLOW
Work Flow INFOID:0000000009174677
OVERALL SEQUENCE
Reference 1: Refer to AV-413, "CONSULT Function".
Reference 2: Refer to AV-595, "Symptom Table".
DETAILED FLOW
1.CHECK SYMPTOM
Check the malfunction symptoms by performing the following items.
Interview the customer to obtain the malfunction information (conditions and environment when the malfunc-
tion occurred).
Check the symptom.
>> GO TO 2
2.SELF-DIAGNOSIS (CONSULT)
1. Connect CONSULT and perform SELF-DIAGNOSIS for MULTI AV.
NOTE:
Skip to step 4 of the diagnosis procedure if MULTI AV is not displayed.
2. Check if any DTC No. is displayed in the self-diagnosis results.
AWNIA2486GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-488
< BASIC INSPECTION >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WORKFLOW
Is any DTC No. displayed?
YES >> GO TO 3
NO >> GO TO 4
3.CHECK SELF-DIAGNOSIS RESULTS (CONSULT)
1. Check the DTC No. indicated in the self-diagnosis results.
2. Perform the relevant diagnosis referring to the DTC No. list. Refer to AV-423, "DTC Index".
NOTE:
Start with the diagnosis for the CAN communication system if CAN COMM CIRCUIT [U1000] or CONTROL
UNIT (CAN) [U1010] is displayed.
>> GO TO 5
4.PERFORM DIAGNOSIS BY SYMPTOM
Perform the relevant diagnosis referring to the diagnosis chart by symptom. Refer to AV-595, "Symptom
Table".
>> GO TO 5
5.REPAIR OR REPLACE MALFUNCTIONING PARTS
Repair or replace the identified malfunctioning parts.
NOTE:
Erase the stored self-diagnosis results after repairing or replacing the relevant components if any DTC No. has
been indicated in the self-diagnosis results.
>> GO TO 6
6.CHECK AFTER REPAIR
1. Perform self-diagnosis for MULTI AV with CONSULT after repairing or replacing the malfunctioning
parts.
2. Check if any DTC No. is displayed in the self-diagnosis results.
Is any DTC No. displayed?
YES >> GO TO 3
NO >> GO TO 7
7.FINAL CHECK
Perform the operation check to confirm that the malfunction symptom is solved or that any other symptoms
are present.
Are any symptoms present?
YES >> GO TO 4
NO >> Inspection End.
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
INSPECTION AND ADJUSTMENT
AV-489
< BASIC INSPECTION >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
INSPECTION AND ADJUSTMENT
ADDITIONAL SERVICE WHEN REPLACING AV CONTROL UNIT
ADDITIONAL SERVICE WHEN REPLACING AV CONTROL UNIT : Description
INFOID:0000000009174678
BEFORE REPLACEMENT
When replacing AV control unit, save or print current vehicle specification with CONSULT configuration before
replacement.
NOTE:
If Before Replace ECU cannot be used, use the After Replace ECU or Manual Configuration after replac-
ing AV control unit.
AFTER REPLACEMENT
CAUTION:
When replacing AV control unit, you must perform After Replace ECU with CONSULT.
Complete the procedure of After Replace ECU in order.
If you set incorrect After Replace ECU, incidents might occur.
Configuration is different for each vehicle model. Confirm configuration of each vehicle model.
ADDITIONAL SERVICE WHEN REPLACING AV CONTROL UNIT : Work Procedure
INFOID:0000000009174679
1.SAVING VEHICLE SPECIFICATION
CONSULT
Enter Re/Programming, Configuration and perform Before Replace ECU to save or print current vehicle
specification.
NOTE:
If Before Replace ECU cannot be used, use the After Replace ECU or Manual Configuration after replac-
ing AV control unit.
>> GO TO 2.
2.REPLACE AV CONTROL UNIT
Replace AV control unit. Refer to AV-611, "Removal and Installation".
>> GO TO 3.
3.WRITING VEHICLE SPECIFICATION
CONSULT
1. Enter "Re/Programming, Configuration".
2. If Before Replace ECU operation was performed, automatically an "Operation Log Selection" screen will
be displayed. Select the applicable file from the "Saved Data List" and press Confirm to write vehicle
specification. Refer to AV-490, "CONFIGURATION (AV CONTROL UNIT) : Work Procedure".
3. If Before Replace ECU operation was not performed, select "After Replace ECU" or "Manual Configura-
tion" to write vehicle specification. Refer to AV-490, "CONFIGURATION (AV CONTROL UNIT) : Work Pro-
cedure".
>> GO TO 4.
4.OPERATION CHECK
Check that the operation of the AV control unit is normal.
>> Work End.
CONFIGURATION (AV CONTROL UNIT)
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-490
< BASIC INSPECTION >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
INSPECTION AND ADJUSTMENT
CONFIGURATION (AV CONTROL UNIT) : Description INFOID:0000000009174680
Vehicle specification needs to be written with CONSULT because it is not written after replacing AV control
unit.
Configuration has three functions as follows:
CAUTION:
When replacing AV control unit, you must perform Select Saved Data List or "After Replace ECU"
with CONSULT.
Complete the procedure of Select Saved Data List or "After Replace ECU" in order.
If you set incorrect Select Saved Data List or "After Replace ECU", incidents might occur.
Configuration is different for each vehicle model. Confirm configuration of each vehicle model.
Never perform Select Saved Data List or "After Replace ECU" except for new AV control unit.
CONFIGURATION (AV CONTROL UNIT) : Work Procedure INFOID:0000000009174681
1.WRITING MODE SELECTION
CONSULT
Select Reprogramming, Configuration of AV control unit.
When writing saved data>>GO TO 2.
When writing manually>>GO TO 3.
2.PERFORM SAVED DATA LIST
CONSULT
Automatically Operation Log Selection window will display if Before Replace ECU was performed. Select
applicable file from the Save Data List and press Confirm.
>> Work End.
3.PERFORM AFTER REPLACE ECU OR MANUAL CONFIGURATION
CONSULT
1. Select After Replace ECU or Manual Configuration.
2. Identify the correct model and configuration list. Refer to AV-491, "CONFIGURATION (AV CONTROL
UNIT) : Configuration List".
3. Confirm and/or change setting value for each item.
CAUTION:
Thoroughly read and understand the vehicle specification. ECU control may not operate normally
if the setting is not correct.
4. Select Next.
CAUTION:
Make sure to select Next, confirm each setting value and press OK even if the indicated con-
figuration of brand new AV control unit is same as the desirable configuration. If not, configuration
which is set automatically by selecting vehicle model can not be memorized.
5. When "Completed", select "End".
>> GO TO 4.
4.OPERATION CHECK
Confirm that each function controlled by AV control unit operates normally.
Function Description
"Before Replace ECU"
Reads the vehicle configuration of current AV control unit.
Saves the read vehicle configuration.
"After Replace ECU" Writes the vehicle configuration with manual selection.
"Select Saved Data List" Writes the vehicle configuration with saved data.
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
INSPECTION AND ADJUSTMENT
AV-491
< BASIC INSPECTION >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
>> Work End.
CONFIGURATION (AV CONTROL UNIT) : Configuration List INFOID:0000000009174682
CAUTION:
Thoroughly read and understand the vehicle specification. Incorrect settings may result in abnormal
control of ECU.
: Items which confirm vehicle specifications
ADDITIONAL SERVICE WHEN REPLACING AROUND VIEW MONITOR CON-
TROL UNIT
ADDITIONAL SERVICE WHEN REPLACING AROUND VIEW MONITOR CONTROL
UNIT : Description INFOID:0000000009174683
BEFORE REPLACEMENT
When replacing around view monitor control unit, save or print current vehicle specification with CONSULT
configuration before replacement.
NOTE:
If Before Replace ECU cannot be used, use the After Replace ECU or Manual Configuration after replac-
ing around view monitor control unit.
AFTER REPLACEMENT
CAUTION:
When replacing around view monitor control unit, you must perform After Replace ECU with CON-
SULT.
Complete the procedure of After Replace ECU in order.
If you set incorrect After Replace ECU, incidents might occur.
Configuration is different for each vehicle model. Confirm configuration of each vehicle model.
ADDITIONAL SERVICE WHEN REPLACING AROUND VIEW MONITOR CONTROL
UNIT : Work Procedure INFOID:0000000009174684
1.SAVING VEHICLE SPECIFICATION
-CONSULT
Enter Re/Programming, Configuration and perform Before Replace ECU to save or print current vehicle
specification.
NOTE:
If Before Replace ECU cannot be used, use the After Replace ECU or Manual Configuration after replac-
ing around view monitor control unit.
>> GO TO 2.
2.REPLACE AROUND VIEW MONITOR CONTROL UNIT
Replace around view monitor control unit. Refer to AV-629, "Removal and Installation".
>> GO TO 3.
3.WRITING VEHICLE SPECIFICATION
CONSULT
1. Enter "Re/Programming, Configuration".
2. If Before Replace ECU operation was performed, automatically an "Operation Log Selection" screen will
be displayed. Select the applicable file from the "Saved Data List" and press Confirm to write vehicle
MANUAL SETTING ITEM
Items Setting value
ENGINE TYPE NORMAL HYBRID
SOUND SYSTEM BOSE SURROUND BOSE BASE
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-492
< BASIC INSPECTION >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
INSPECTION AND ADJUSTMENT
specification. Refer to AV-492, "CONFIGURATION (AROUND VIEW MONITOR CONTROL UNIT) : Work
Procedure".
3. If Before Replace ECU operation was not performed, select "After Replace ECU" or "Manual Configura-
tion" to write vehicle specification. Refer to AV-492, "CONFIGURATION (AROUND VIEW MONITOR
CONTROL UNIT) : Work Procedure".
>> GO TO 4.
4.OPERATION CHECK
Check that the operation of the around view monitor control unit and camera images (fixed guide lines and
predictive course lines) are normal.
>> Work End.
CONFIGURATION (AROUND VIEW MONITOR CONTROL UNIT)
CONFIGURATION (AROUND VIEW MONITOR CONTROL UNIT) : Description
INFOID:0000000009174685
Vehicle specification needs to be written with CONSULT because it is not written after replacing around view
monitor control unit.
Configuration has three functions as follows:
CAUTION:
When replacing around view monitor control unit, you must perform Select Saved Data List or
"After Replace ECU" with CONSULT.
Complete the procedure of Select Saved Data List or "After Replace ECU" in order.
If you set incorrect Select Saved Data List or "After Replace ECU", incidents might occur.
Configuration is different for each vehicle model. Confirm configuration of each vehicle model.
Never perform Select Saved Data List or "After Replace ECU" except for new around view monitor
control unit.
CONFIGURATION (AROUND VIEW MONITOR CONTROL UNIT) : Work Procedure
INFOID:0000000009174686
1.WRITING MODE SELECTION
CONSULT
Select Reprogramming, Configuration of around view monitor control unit.
When writing saved data>>GO TO 2.
When writing manually>>GO TO 3.
2.PERFORM SAVED DATA LIST
CONSULT
Automatically Operation Log Selection window will display if Before Replace ECU was performed. Select
applicable file from the Save Data List and press Confirm.
>> Work End.
3.PERFORM AFTER REPLACE ECU OR MANUAL CONFIGURATION
CONSULT
1. Select After Replace ECU or Manual Configuration.
Function Description
"Before Replace ECU"
Reads the vehicle configuration of current around view monitor control unit.
Saves the read vehicle configuration.
"After Replace ECU" Writes the vehicle configuration with manual selection.
"Select Saved Data List" Writes the vehicle configuration with saved data.
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
INSPECTION AND ADJUSTMENT
AV-493
< BASIC INSPECTION >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
2. Identify the correct model and configuration list. Refer to AV-493, "CONFIGURATION (AROUND VIEW
MONITOR CONTROL UNIT) : Configuration List".
3. Confirm and/or change setting value for each item.
CAUTION:
Thoroughly read and understand the vehicle specification. ECU control may not operate normally
if the setting is not correct.
4. Select Next.
CAUTION:
Make sure to select Next, confirm each setting value and press OK even if the indicated con-
figuration of brand new around view monitor control unit is same as the desirable configuration. If
not, configuration which is set automatically by selecting vehicle model can not be memorized.
5. When "Completed", select "End".
>> GO TO 4.
4.OPERATION CHECK
Confirm that each function controlled by around view monitor control unit operates normally.
>> Work End.
CONFIGURATION (AROUND VIEW MONITOR CONTROL UNIT) : Configuration List
INFOID:0000000009174687
CAUTION:
Thoroughly read and understand the vehicle specification. Incorrect settings may result in abnormal
control of ECU.
: Items which confirm vehicle specifications
PREDICTED COURSE LINE CENTER POSITION ADJUSTMENT
PREDICTED COURSE LINE CENTER POSITION ADJUSTMENT : Description
INFOID:0000000009174688
Adjust the center position of the predictive course line of the rear view monitor if it is shifted.
PREDICTED COURSE LINE CENTER POSITION ADJUSTMENT : Work Procedure
INFOID:0000000009174689
1.DRIVING
Drive the vehicle straight ahead 100 m (328.1 ft) or more at a speed of 30 km/h (18.6 MPH) or more.
>> END
CALIBRATING CAMERA IMAGE (AROUND VIEW MONITOR)
CALIBRATING CAMERA IMAGE (AROUND VIEW MONITOR) : Description
INFOID:0000000009174690
Calibration must be performed after removing/replacing the cameras, removing parts (e.g. front grille, door
mirror, and others) mounted on the cameras, or replacing the Around view monitor control unit.
The use of CONSULT is required to perform calibration or writing of calibration results to the Around view
monitor control unit.
Align the white lines on the road near the vehicle at the boundary of each camera image by this camera cal-
ibration. The white lines far from the vehicle may not be aligned at the boundary of each camera image. The
farther the line, the greater the difference is.
MANUAL SETTING ITEM
Items Setting value
BCI FUNCTION WITH WITHOUT
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-494
< BASIC INSPECTION >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
INSPECTION AND ADJUSTMENT
CALIBRATING CAMERA IMAGE (AROUND VIEW MONITOR) : Work Procedure
INFOID:0000000009174691
CALIBRATION FLOWCHART
Following the flowchart shown in the figure, perform the calibration.
NOTE:
View in the incomplete calibration state is indicated by on the
around view monitor.
CALIBRATION PROCEDURE
1.AROUND VIEW MONITOR SCREEN CONFIRMATION
Check that there is no indication of Incomplete calibration.
Is the Incomplete calibration display visible?
YES >> GO TO 2.
NO >> GO TO 4.
2.CHECK THAT AROUND VIEW MONITOR CONTROL UNIT IS REPLACED
JSNIA4210GB
AWNIA2590GB
AWNIA2590GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
INSPECTION AND ADJUSTMENT
AV-495
< BASIC INSPECTION >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
Check that the around view monitor control unit is replaced.
Is the around view monitor control unit replaced?
YES >> GO TO 3.
NO >> GO TO 5.
3.CANCEL THE INDICATION OF INCOMPLETE CALIBRATION (PERFORM THIS ONLY AFTER REPLAC-
ING AROUND VIEW MONITOR CONTROL UNIT.)
CONSULT work support
1. On the CONSULT screen, touch CALIBRATING CAMERA IMAGE (FRONT CAMERA), CALIBRATING
CAMERA IMAGE (PASS-SIDE CAMERA), CALIBRATING CAMERA IMAGE (DR-SIDE CAMERA), or
CALIBRATING CAMERA IMAGE (REAR CAMERA) to accept the selection.
NOTE:
To cancel the indication of Incomplete calibration, select items based on the target camera.
2. On the adjustment screen of each camera, touch APPLY but-
ton. After this, touch OK button.
CAUTION:
Never perform operations other than those mentioned
above.
Never perform Initialize Camera Image Calibration.
3. Display the around view monitor screen to check that there is no
errors, such as deviations among the camera images.
Is there a malfunction?
YES >> Calibration end
NO >> GO TO 1.
4.PERFORM SIMPLIFIED CONFIRMATION/ADJUSTMENT BY FINE TUNING OF BIRDS-EYE VIEW
1. Put target line 1 on the ground beside each axle using packing tape, etc.
2. Put target lines 2 equal to the vehicle total length + approximately 1.0 m (39.3 in) from the vehicle side
(right and left) at approximately 30 cm (11.8 in) away from the vehicle (make the line as parallel with the
vehicle as possible)
Preparation of simplified target line
3. CONSULT work support
Touch FINE TUNING OF BIRDS-EYE VIEW on the CONSULT screen.
4. On the CONSULT screen, touch SELECT button to select right or left camera and perform camera cali-
bration as instructed below:
- If the marker on the screen deviates from Target line 1, touch AXIS X button and AXIS Y button to
adjust so that the marker is placed on the Target line 1.
- If Target line 2 is misaligned among the cameras, adjust each camera image to bring Target line 2 into a
straight line.
CAUTION:
JSNIA4212ZZ
JSNIA0927ZZ
1. Target lines 1 2. Target lines 2
A. Approx. 30 cm (11.8 in) B. Approx. 1.0 m (39.3 in)
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-496
< BASIC INSPECTION >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
INSPECTION AND ADJUSTMENT
Never adjust the front camera and rear camera. Only adjust the right and left cameras.
Simplified target line adjustment method
5. Adjust right and left cameras. Touch "APPLY" on the CONSULT screen to display adjustment results.
6. After adjusting right and left cameras, check that the marker is properly placed on the screen and there is
no deviation in Target line 1.
NOTE:
It can be initialized to the NISSAN factory default condition with Initialize Camera Image Calibration.
The adjustment value is cancelled on this mode by performing Initialize Camera Image Calibration.
Is the difference corrected?
YES >> On the CONSULT screen, touch OK button to complete writing to the around view monitor con-
trol unit.
NO >> GO TO 5.
5.PERFORM CALIBRATING CAMERA IMAGE
Preparation of target line
1. Hang a string with a weight as shown in the figure. Put the points FM0, RM0 (mark) on the ground at the
center of the vehicle front end and rear end with white packing tape or a pen.
2. Route the vinyl string under the vehicle, and then pull and fix it on the point approximately 1.0 m (39.9 in)
to the front and rear of the vehicle through the points FM0 and RM0 using packing tape.
Target line preparation procedure 1
JSNIA0929ZZ
1. Target lines 1 2. Target lines 2 3. Marker for target line 1
4. Boundary between cameras 5.
Crosshairs cursor (mark indicated
the selected camera)
A.
Adjustment method for target lines 1
(right)
B.
Adjustment method for target lines 2
(right)
AWNIA2866ZZ
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
INSPECTION AND ADJUSTMENT
AV-497
< BASIC INSPECTION >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
3. Put the points FM and RM (mark) 75 cm (29.5 in) from the points FM0 and RM0 individually.
4. Route the vinyl string through the points FM and RM using a triangle scale, and then fix it at approximately
1.5 m (59 in) on both sides with packing tape.
5. Put the points FL, FR, RL, and RR (mark) to both right and left [vehicle width / 2 + 30 cm (11.8 in)] from the
points FM and RM.
Target line preparation procedure 2
6. Draw the lines of the points FL RL and FR RR with vinyl string, and fix it with packing tape.
7. Put a mark on the center of each axle, draw vertical lines to the lines of the points FL RL and FR RR
from the marks on the center of the axle using a triangle scale, and then fix the lines using packing tape.
Target line preparation procedure 3
Perform Calibrating Camera Image
CONSULT work support
1. Thread 2. Weight 3. Point FM0 (mark)
4. Point RM0 (mark) 5. Packing tape (to fix the vinyl string) 6. Vinyl string
JSNIA0921ZZ
1. Point FM 2. Point RM 3. Triangle scale
4. Point FL (mark) 5. Point FR (mark) 6. Point RL (mark)
7. Point RR (mark)
A. 75 cm (29.5 in) B. Approx. 1.5 m (59 in) C.
30 cm (11.8 in)
[Vehicle width/ 2 + 30 cm (11.8 in)
from the points FM and RM]
JSNIA0922ZZ
1. Point FL 2. Point FR 3. Point RL
4. Point RR 5. Center position of axle 6. Triangle scale
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-498
< BASIC INSPECTION >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
INSPECTION AND ADJUSTMENT
1. On the CONSULT screen, touch CALIBRATING CAMERA IMAGE (FRONT CAMERA), CALIBRATING
CAMERA IMAGE (PASS-SIDE CAMERA), CALIBRATING CAMERA IMAGE (DR-SIDE CAMERA), or
CALIBRATING CAMERA IMAGE (REAR CAMERA) to accept the selection.
NOTE:
To cancel the indication of Incomplete calibration, select items based on the target camera.
2. On the adjustment screen of each camera, adjust the parameter
by touching the AXIS X button, AXIS Y button, and
ROTATE button to place the calibration marker shown on the
camera screen on the target line drawn on the ground.
3. Touch APPLY button on the CONSULT screen. PRCSNG is
displayed and adjustment results are shown on the camera screen.
CAUTION:
Check that PRCSNG is displayed. Do never perform other operations while PRCSNG is dis-
played.
4. Touch OK button on the CONSULT screen. PRCSNG is displayed and adjustment results are written to
the around view monitor control unit.
CAUTION:
Check that PRCSNG is displayed. Do never perform other operations while PRCSNG is dis-
played.
>> GO TO 6.
6.PERFORM FINE TUNING OF BIRDS-EYE VIEW
This mode is designed to align the boundary between each camera image that could not be aligned in the
Calibrating Camera Image mode.
CONSULT work support
1. Select FINE TUNING OF BIRDS-EYE VIEW by touching CONSULT screen.
2. On the adjustment screen of each camera, adjust the parameter
by touching the AXIS X button, AXIS Y button, and
ROTATE button to place the calibration marker shown on the
camera screen on the target line drawn on the ground.
NOTE:
Touch SELECT button on the CONSULT screen to select the
target camera.
3. Touch APPLY button on the CONSULT screen. PRCSNG is
displayed and adjustment results are shown on the camera
screen.
CAUTION:
Check that PRCSNG is displayed. Do never perform other
operations while PRCSNG is displayed.
4. Touch OK button on the CONSULT screen. PRCSNG is displayed and adjustment results are written to
the around view monitor control unit.
CAUTION:
Check that PRCSNG is displayed. Never perform other operations while PRCSNG is dis-
played.
After pressing the OK button, never press buttons other than the BACK button.
NOTE:
It can be initialized to the NISSAN factory default condition with Initialize Camera Image Calibration.
The adjustment value is cancelled in this mode by performing Initialize Camera Image Calibration.
>> Calibration end
Adjustment range
Rotation direction (Center dial) : 31 patterns (16 on the center)
Upper/lower direction (upper/lower
switch)
: 22 22
Left/right direction (left/right switch) : 22 22
JSNIA4212ZZ
JSNIA4214ZZ
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
U1000 CAN COMM CIRCUIT
AV-499
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS
U1000 CAN COMM CIRCUIT
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174692
DTC DETECTION LOGIC
Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174693
1.PERFORM SELF DIAGNOSTIC RESULT
1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait for 2 seconds or more.
2. Perform Self Diagnostic Result for MULTI AV.
Is CAN COMM CIRCUIT displayed?
YES >> Refer to LAN-20, "Trouble Diagnosis Flow Chart".
NO >> Refer to GI-49, "Intermittent Incident".
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
CAN COMM CIRCUIT
[U1000]
AV control unit is not transmitting or receiving
CAN communication signal for 2 seconds or
more.
CAN communication system.
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-500
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
U1010 CONTROL UNIT (CAN)
U1010 CONTROL UNIT (CAN)
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174694
DTC DETECTION LOGIC
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
CONTROL UNIT (CAN)
[U1010]
CAN initial diagnosis malfunction is detected.
Replace the AV control unit if the malfunction oc-
curs constantly.
Refer to AV-611, "Removal and Installation".
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
U1200 AV CONTROL UNIT
AV-501
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
U1200 AV CONTROL UNIT
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174695
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
CONT UNIT
[U1200]
AV control unit malfunction is detected.
Replace AV control unit if malfunction occurs con-
stantly.
Refer to AV-611, "Removal and Installation".
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-502
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
U1201 AV CONTROL UNIT
U1201 AV CONTROL UNIT
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174696
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
GYRO NO CONN
[U1201]
AV control unit malfunction is detected.
Replace AV control unit if malfunction occurs con-
stantly.
Refer to AV-611, "Removal and Installation".
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
U1202 AV CONTROL UNIT
AV-503
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
U1202 AV CONTROL UNIT
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174697
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
G-SENSOR NO CONN
[U1202]
AV control unit malfunction is detected.
Replace AV control unit if malfunction occurs con-
stantly.
Refer to AV-611, "Removal and Installation".
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-504
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
U1204 AV CONTROL UNIT
U1204 AV CONTROL UNIT
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174698
Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174699
1.PERFORM SELF DIAGNOSTIC RESULT
1. Perform Self Diagnostic Result for MULTI AV.
2. Erase Self Diagnostic Result. Turn ignition switch OFF.
3. Turn ignition switch ON. Perform Self Diagnostic Result again.
Is DTC U1204 detected?
YES >> Replace AV control unit. Refer to AV-611, "Removal and Installation".
NO >> Refer to GI-49, "Intermittent Incident".
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
GPS CONN
[U1204]
GPS malfunction is detected.
An intermittent error caused by strong radio inter-
ference, GPS reception error, etc. may be detect-
ed.
Replace AV control unit if malfunction occurs con-
stantly.
Refer to AV-611, "Removal and Installation".
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
U1205 AV CONTROL UNIT
AV-505
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
U1205 AV CONTROL UNIT
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174700
Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174701
1.PERFORM SELF DIAGNOSTIC RESULT
1. Perform Self Diagnostic Result for MULTI AV.
2. Erase Self Diagnostic Result. Turn ignition switch OFF.
3. Turn ignition switch ON. Perform Self Diagnostic Result again.
Is DTC U1205 detected?
YES >> Replace AV control unit. Refer to AV-611, "Removal and Installation".
NO >> Refer to GI-49, "Intermittent Incident".
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
GPS ROM
[U1205]
GPS malfunction is detected.
An intermittent error caused by strong radio inter-
ference, GPS reception error, etc. may be detect-
ed.
Replace AV control unit if malfunction occurs con-
stantly.
Refer to AV-611, "Removal and Installation".
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-506
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
U1206 AV CONTROL UNIT
U1206 AV CONTROL UNIT
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174702
Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174703
1.PERFORM SELF DIAGNOSTIC RESULT
1. Perform Self Diagnostic Result for MULTI AV.
2. Erase Self Diagnostic Result. Turn ignition switch OFF.
3. Turn ignition switch ON. Perform Self Diagnostic Result again.
Is DTC U1206 detected?
YES >> Replace AV control unit. Refer to AV-611, "Removal and Installation".
NO >> Refer to GI-49, "Intermittent Incident".
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
GPS RAM
[U1206]
GPS malfunction is detected.
An intermittent error caused by strong radio inter-
ference, GPS reception error, etc. may be detect-
ed.
Replace AV control unit if malfunction occurs con-
stantly.
Refer to AV-611, "Removal and Installation".
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
U1207 AV CONTROL UNIT
AV-507
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
U1207 AV CONTROL UNIT
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174704
Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174705
1.PERFORM SELF DIAGNOSTIC RESULT
1. Perform Self Diagnostic Result for MULTI AV.
2. Erase Self Diagnostic Result. Turn ignition switch OFF.
3. Turn ignition switch ON. Perform Self Diagnostic Result again.
Is DTC U1207 detected?
YES >> Replace AV control unit. Refer to AV-611, "Removal and Installation".
NO >> Refer to GI-49, "Intermittent Incident".
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
GPS RTC
[U1207]
GPS malfunction is detected.
An intermittent error caused by strong radio inter-
ference, GPS reception error, etc. may be detect-
ed.
Replace AV control unit if malfunction occurs con-
stantly.
Refer to AV-611, "Removal and Installation".
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-508
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
U1216 AV CONTROL UNIT
U1216 AV CONTROL UNIT
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174706
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
CAN CONT
[U1216]
AV control unit malfunction is detected.
Replace AV control unit if malfunction occurs con-
stantly.
Refer to AV-611, "Removal and Installation".
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
U1217 AV CONTROL UNIT
AV-509
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
U1217 AV CONTROL UNIT
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174707
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
BLUETOOTH MODULE
[U1217]
AV control unit malfunction is detected.
Replace AV control unit if malfunction occurs con-
stantly.
Refer to AV-611, "Removal and Installation".
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-510
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
U1218 AV CONTROL UNIT
U1218 AV CONTROL UNIT
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174708
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
HDD CONN
[U1218]
AV control unit malfunction is detected.
If the hard disk drive (HDD) is functioning normal-
ly, there is a possibility of an intermittent malfunc-
tion.
Replace AV control unit if malfunction occurs con-
stantly.
Refer to AV-611, "Removal and Installation".
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
U1219 AV CONTROL UNIT
AV-511
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
U1219 AV CONTROL UNIT
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174709
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
HDD READ
[U1219]
AV control unit malfunction is detected.
If the hard disk drive (HDD) is functioning normal-
ly, there is a possibility of an intermittent malfunc-
tion.
Replace AV control unit if malfunction occurs con-
stantly.
Refer to AV-611, "Removal and Installation".
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-512
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
U121A AV CONTROL UNIT
U121A AV CONTROL UNIT
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174710
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
HDD WRITE
[U121A]
AV control unit malfunction is detected.
If the hard disk drive (HDD) is functioning normal-
ly, there is a possibility of an intermittent malfunc-
tion.
Replace AV control unit if malfunction occurs con-
stantly.
Refer to AV-611, "Removal and Installation".
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
U121B AV CONTROL UNIT
AV-513
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
U121B AV CONTROL UNIT
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174711
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
HDD COMM
[U121B]
AV control unit malfunction is detected.
If the hard disk drive (HDD) is functioning normal-
ly, there is a possibility of an intermittent malfunc-
tion.
Replace AV control unit if malfunction occurs con-
stantly.
Refer to AV-611, "Removal and Installation".
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-514
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
U121C AV CONTROL UNIT
U121C AV CONTROL UNIT
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174712
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
HDD ACCESS
[U121C]
AV control unit malfunction is detected.
If the hard disk drive (HDD) is functioning normal-
ly, there is a possibility of an intermittent malfunc-
tion.
Replace AV control unit if malfunction occurs con-
stantly.
Refer to AV-611, "Removal and Installation".
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
U121D AV CONTROL UNIT
AV-515
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
U121D AV CONTROL UNIT
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174713
Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174714
1.CHECK CD PLAYBACK
Check the CD playback operation of the AV control unit. Refer to Owners Manual for audio system operating
instructions.
Is the CD playback function of the AV control unit operating normally?
YES >> Refer to GI-49, "Intermittent Incident".
NO >> Replace AV control unit. Refer to AV-611, "Removal and Installation".
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
DSP CONN
[U121D]
AV control unit malfunction is detected.
An intermittent error causing disc player malfunc-
tion may be detected.
Replace AV control unit if malfunction occurs con-
stantly.
Refer to AV-611, "Removal and Installation".
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-516
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
U121E AV CONTROL UNIT
U121E AV CONTROL UNIT
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174715
Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174716
1.CHECK CD PLAYBACK
Check the CD playback operation of the AV control unit. Refer to Owners Manual for audio system operating
instructions.
Is the CD playback function of the AV control unit operating normally?
YES >> Refer to GI-49, "Intermittent Incident".
NO >> Replace AV control unit. Refer to AV-611, "Removal and Installation".
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
DSP COMM
[U121E]
AV control unit malfunction is detected.
An intermittent error causing disc player malfunc-
tion may be detected.
Replace AV control unit if malfunction occurs con-
stantly.
Refer to AV-611, "Removal and Installation".
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
U1225 AV CONTROL UNIT
AV-517
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
U1225 AV CONTROL UNIT
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174717
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
USB CONTROLLER
[U1225]
USB connection malfunction is detected.
Check that connection to USB connector is nor-
mal.
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-518
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
U1227 AV CONTROL UNIT
U1227 AV CONTROL UNIT
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174718
Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174719
1.CHECK DVD PLAYBACK
Check the DVD playback operation of the AV control unit. Refer to Owners Manual for audio system operating
instructions.
Is the DVD playback function of the AV control unit operating normally?
YES >> Refer to GI-49, "Intermittent Incident".
NO >> Replace AV control unit. Refer to AV-611, "Removal and Installation".
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
DVD COMM
[U1227]
AV control unit malfunction is detected.
An intermittent error causing disc player malfunc-
tion may be detected.
Replace AV control unit if malfunction occurs con-
stantly.
Refer to AV-611, "Removal and Installation".
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
U1228 AV CONTROL UNIT
AV-519
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
U1228 AV CONTROL UNIT
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174720
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
SUB CPU CONN
[U1228]
AV control unit malfunction is detected.
Replace AV control unit if malfunction occurs con-
stantly.
Refer to AV-611, "Removal and Installation".
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-520
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
U1229 AV CONTROL UNIT
U1229 AV CONTROL UNIT
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174721
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
iPod CERTIFICATION
[U1229]
AV control unit malfunction is detected.
Replace AV control unit if malfunction occurs con-
stantly.
Refer to AV-611, "Removal and Installation".
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
U122A AV CONTROL UNIT
AV-521
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
U122A AV CONTROL UNIT
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174722
Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174723
1.PERFORM CONFIGURATION
When U122A is detected, configuration data must be written.
>> Write configuration data with CONSULT. Refer to AV-492, "CONFIGURATION (AROUND VIEW
MONITOR CONTROL UNIT) : Work Procedure".
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
CONFIG UNFINISH
[U122A]
Configuration data is incomplete.
Write configuration data.
Refer to AV-492, "CONFIGURATION (AROUND
VIEW MONITOR CONTROL UNIT) : Work Pro-
cedure".
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-522
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
U122E AV CONTROL UNIT
U122E AV CONTROL UNIT
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174724
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
Built-in AUDIO CONN
[U122E]
AV control unit malfunction is detected.
Replace AV control unit if malfunction occurs con-
stantly.
Refer to AV-611, "Removal and Installation".
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
U1231 BOSE AMP.
AV-523
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
U1231 BOSE AMP.
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174725
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
AMP TEMP
[U1231]
BOSE speaker amp. malfunction is detected.
Replace BOSE speaker amp. if malfunction oc-
curs constantly.
Refer to AV-618, "Removal and Installation".
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-524
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
U1232 STEERING ANGLE SENSOR
U1232 STEERING ANGLE SENSOR
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174726
Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174727
1.ADJUST PREDICTIVE COURSE LINE CENTER POSITION OF STEERING ANGLE SENSOR
When U1232 is detected, the predictive course line center position of the steering angle sensor needs to be
adjusted.
>> Adjust the predictive course line center position of steering angle sensor. Refer to AV-493, "PRE-
DICTED COURSE LINE CENTER POSITION ADJUSTMENT : Work Procedure".
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
ST ANGLE SEN CALIB
[U1232]
Predictive course line center position adjustment
of steering angle sensor is incomplete.
Adjust predictive course line center position of
steering angle sensor.
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
U1243 DISPLAY UNIT
AV-525
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
U1243 DISPLAY UNIT
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174728
Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174729
Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-442, "Wiring Diagram".
1.CHECK DISPLAY UNIT POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT
Check display unit power supply and ground circuits. Refer to AV-549, "DISPLAY UNIT : Diagnosis Proce-
dure".
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 2.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
2.CHECK COMMUNICATION CIRCUIT CONTINUITY
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect display unit connector M92 and AV control unit connector M163.
3. Check continuity between display unit connector M92 terminals 9, 10 and AV control unit connector M163
terminals 77, 61.
4. Check continuity between display unit connector M92 terminals 9, 10 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 3.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
3.CHECK COMMUNICATION SIGNAL (DISPCONT)
1. Connect display unit connector M92 and AV control unit connector M163.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check signal between display unit connector M92 terminal 9 and ground.
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
FRONT DISP CONN
[U1243]
When any of the following is detected.
display unit power supply or ground circuit
malfunction.
serial communication circuit malfunction be-
tween front display unit and AV control unit.
Display unit power supply and ground circuits.
Serial communication circuits between front
display unit and AV control unit.
Display unit AV control unit
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
M92
9
M163
77
Yes
10 61
Display unit
Ground Continuity
Connector Terminal
M92
9
No
10
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-526
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
U1243 DISPLAY UNIT
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 4.
NO >> Replace AV control unit. Refer to AV-611, "Removal and Installation".
4.CHECK COMMUNICATION SIGNAL (CONTDISP)
Check signal between display unit connector M92 terminal 10 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> Inspection End.
NO >> Replace display unit. Refer to AV-615, "Removal and Installation".
Display unit Ground
Condition Reference value (+)
()
Connector Terminal
M92 9
When adjusting dis-
play brightness.
PKIB5039J
Display unit Ground
Condition Reference value (+)
()
Connector Terminal
M92 10
When adjusting dis-
play brightness.
PKIB5039J
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
U1244 GPS ANTENNA
AV-527
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
U1244 GPS ANTENNA
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174730
Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174731
Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-442, "Wiring Diagram".
1.GPS ANTENNA INSPECTION
Visually inspect the GPS antenna and antenna feeder. Refer to AV-637, "Removal and Installation".
Is inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 2.
NO >> Replace malfunctioning parts.
2.CHECK AV CONTROL UNIT VOLTAGE
1. Disconnect GPS antenna connector.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check voltage between AV control unit connector M25 and ground.
Is inspection result normal?
YES >> Inspection End.
NO >> Replace AV control unit. Refer to AV-611, "Removal and Installation".
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
GPS ANTENNA CONN
[U1244]
GPS antenna connection malfunction is detect-
ed.
GPS antenna disconnection.
AV control unit Ground
Voltage (+)
()
Connector Terminal
M25 130 5.0 V
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-528
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
U1258 SATELLITE RADIO ANTENNA
U1258 SATELLITE RADIO ANTENNA
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174732
Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174733
Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-442, "Wiring Diagram".
1.SATELLITE RADIO ANTENNA INSPECTION
Visually inspect the satellite radio antenna and antenna feeder. Refer to AV-635, "Location of Antennas".
Is inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 2.
NO >> Replace malfunctioning parts.
2.CHECK AV CONTROL UNIT VOLTAGE
1. Disconnect AV control unit connector M156.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check voltage between AV control unit connector and ground.
Is inspection result normal?
YES >> Inspection End.
NO >> Replace AV control unit. Refer to AV-611, "Removal and Installation".
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
XM ANTENNA CONN
[U1258]
Satellite radio antenna connection malfunction is
detected.
Satellite radio antenna disconnection.
AV control unit Ground
Voltage (+)
()
Connector Terminal
M156 129 5.0 V
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
U125A HEADREST DISPLAY UNIT
AV-529
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
U125A HEADREST DISPLAY UNIT
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174734
Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174735
Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-442, "Wiring Diagram".
1.CHECK HEADREST DISPLAY UNIT POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT
Check headrest display unit power supply and ground circuits. Refer to AV-554, "HEADREST DISPLAY UNIT
: Diagnosis Procedure".
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 2.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
2.CHECK AV COMMUNICATION CIRCUIT CONTINUITY
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect headrest display unit connectors.
3. Check continuity between headrest display unit (driver seat) connector B223 and headrest display unit
(passenger seat) connector B317.
4. Check continuity between headrest display unit (driver seat) connector B223 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> Replace headrest display unit (passenger seat). Refer to AV-616, "Removal and Installation".
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
3RD DISP CONN
[U125A]
When any of the following is detected.
headrest display unit power supply or ground
circuit malfunction.
AV communication circuit malfunction be-
tween headrest display units.
Headrest display unit power supply and ground
circuits.
AV communication circuits between headrest
display units.
Headrest display unit (driver seat) Headrest display unit (passenger seat)
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
B223
26
B317
11
Yes
27 10
Headrest display unit (driver seat)
Ground Continuity
Connector Terminal
B223
26
No
27
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-530
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
U1263 USB
U1263 USB
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174736
Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174737
1.CHECK USB INTERFACE HARNESS
Visually inspect USB interface harness.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 2.
NO >> Replace USB interface harness. Refer to AV-626, "Removal and Installation".
2.CHECK USB INTERFACE HARNESS CONTINUITY
Check USB interface harness continuity. Refer to AV-530, "Diagnosis Procedure".
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> Replace AV control unit. Refer to AV-611, "Removal and Installation".
NO >> Replace USB interface harness. Refer to AV-626, "Removal and Installation".
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
USB OVERCURRENT
[U126]
Overcurrent in USB connector is detected.
Check USB harness between the AV control unit
and USB connector.
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
U1264 ANTENNA AMP.
AV-531
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
U1264 ANTENNA AMP.
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174738
Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174739
Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-442, "Wiring Diagram".
1.CHECK CONTINUITY BETWEEN AV CONTROL UNIT AND ANTENNA BASE
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect AV control unit connector M155 and antenna base connector M502.
3. Check continuity between AV control unit connector M155 and antenna base connector M502.
4. Check continuity between AV control unit connector M155 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 2.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
2.CHECK AV CONTROL UNIT VOLTAGE
1. Connect AV control unit connector M155.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check voltage between AV control unit connector M155 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> Replace antenna base. Refer to AV-638, "Removal and Installation".
NO >> Replace AV control unit. Refer to AV-611, "Removal and Installation".
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
ANTENNA AMP TERMINAL
[U1264]
Antenna amp. ON signal circuit open or short cir-
cuited.
Antenna amp. ON signal circuit between AV con-
trol unit and antenna amp.
AV control unit Antenna base
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
M155 126 M502 1 Yes
AV control unit
Ground Continuity
Connector Terminal
M155 126 No
AV control unit Ground
Voltage
(Approx.)
(+)
()
Connector Terminal
M155 126 Battery voltage
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-532
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
U1265 BOSE AMP.
U1265 BOSE AMP.
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174740
Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174741
Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-442, "Wiring Diagram".
1.CHECK CONTINUITY BETWEEN AV CONTROL UNIT AND BOSE SPEAKER AMP.
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect AV control unit connector M161 and Bose speaker amp. connector B130.
3. Check continuity between AV control unit connector M161 and Bose speaker amp. connector B130.
4. Check continuity between AV control unit connector M161 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 2.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
2.CHECK AV CONTROL UNIT VOLTAGE
1. Connect AV control unit connector M161.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check voltage between AV control unit connector M161 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> Replace Bose speaker amp. Refer to AV-618, "Removal and Installation".
NO >> Replace AV control unit. Refer to AV-611, "Removal and Installation".
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
AMP ON TERMINAL
[U1265]
BOSE amp. ON signal circuit open or short cir-
cuited.
BOSE amp. ON signal circuit between AV control
unit and BOSE speaker amp.
AV control unit Bose speaker amp.
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
M161 1 B130 60 Yes
AV control unit
Ground Continuity
Connector Terminal
M161 1 No
AV control unit Ground
Voltage
(Approx.)
(+)
()
Connector Terminal
M161 1 Battery voltage
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
U1300 AV COMM CIRCUIT
AV-533
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
U1300 AV COMM CIRCUIT
Description INFOID:0000000009174742
U1300 is indicated when a malfunction occurs in the communication signal of the multi AV system. Indicated
simultaneously, without fail, the malfunction of control units connected to the AV control unit through communi-
cation circuits. Determine the possible malfunction cause from the table below.
SELF DIAGNOSTIC RESULT DISPLAY ITEM
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
AV COMM CIRCUIT
[U1300]
SWITCH CONN
[U1240]
When any of the following is detected:
A/C and AV switch assembly power supply or
ground circuit malfunction.
AV communication circuit malfunction between AV
control unit and A/C and AV switch assembly.
A/C and AV switch assembly power supply and
ground circuits.
Refer to AV-552, "A/C AND AV SWITCH ASSEM-
BLY : Diagnosis Procedure".
AV communication circuits between AV control
unit and A/C and AV switch assembly.
AV COMM CIRCUIT
[U1300]
AMP CONN
[U124E]
When any of the following is detected:
BOSE speaker amp. power supply or ground circuit
malfunction.
AV communication circuits between AV control unit
and BOSE speaker amp. are malfunctioning.
BOSE speaker amp. power supply and ground cir-
cuits.
Refer to AV-550, "BOSE AMP. : Diagnosis Proce-
dure".
AV communication circuits between AV control
unit and BOSE speaker amp.
AV COMM CIRCUIT
[U1300]
VIDEO DIST CONN
[U1246]
When any of the following is detected:
video distributor power supply or ground circuit mal-
function.
headrest display unit (driver seat) power supply or
ground circuit malfunction.
AV communication circuit malfunction between AV
control unit and headrest display unit (driver seat).
Video distributor power supply and ground cir-
cuits.
Refer to AV-553, "VIDEO DISTRIBUTOR : Diag-
nosis Procedure".
Headrest display unit (driver seat) power supply
and ground circuits.
Refer to AV-554, "HEADREST DISPLAY UNIT :
Diagnosis Procedure".
AV communication circuits between AV control
unit and headrest display unit (driver seat).
AV COMM CIRCUIT
[U1300]
AROUND CAMERA
CONN
[U125B]
When any of the following is detected:
around view monitor control unit power supply or
ground circuit malfunction.
AV communication circuit malfunction between AV
control unit and around view monitor control unit.
Around view monitor control unit power supply
and ground circuits.
Refer to AV-554, "AROUND VIEW MONITOR
CONTROL UNIT : Diagnosis Procedure".
AV communication circuits between AV control
unit and around view monitor control unit.
AV COMM CIRCUIT
[U1300]
SWITCH CONN
[U1240]
AROUND CAMERA
CONN
[U125B]
VIDEO DIST CONN
[U1246]
AV communication circuit malfunction between AV
control unit and A/C and AV switch assembly.
AV communication circuits between AV control unit
and A/C and AV switch assembly.
AV COMM CIRCUIT
[U1300]
SWITCH CONN
[U1240]
AMP CONN
[U124E]
AROUND CAMERA
CONN
[U125B]
VIDEO DIST CONN
[U1246]
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-534
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
U1302 CAMERA POWER VOLT
U1302 CAMERA POWER VOLT
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174743
DTC DETECTION LOGIC
Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174744
Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-442, "Wiring Diagram".
1.CHECK CAMERA DATA MONITOR
Check CAMERA IMAGE SIG, CAMERA COMM STATUS and CAMERA COMM LINE for each camera in
DATA MONITOR of AVM.
Is OK displayed for all cameras?
YES >> Refer to GI-49, "Intermittent Incident".
NO-1 (Front camera)>>GO TO 2.
NO-2 (Rear camera)>>GO TO 4.
NO-3 (LH side camera)>>GO TO 6.
NO-4 (RH side camera)>>GO TO 8.
2.CHECK FRONT CAMERA POWER SUPPLY AND POWER SUPPLY GROUND CIRCUIT CONTINUITY
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect around view monitor control unit connector M96 and camera connectors.
3. Check continuity between around view monitor control unit connector M96 and front camera connector
E226.
4. Check continuity between around view monitor control unit connector M96 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 3.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
3.CHECK AROUND VIEW MONITOR CONTROL UNIT VOLTAGE
1. Connect around view monitor control unit connector M96 and front camera connector E226.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check the voltage between the terminals of around view monitor control unit connector M96.
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
CAMERA SUPPLY POWER
SUPPLY VOLTAGE ABNOR-
MALITY
[U1302]
Short in camera power circuit.
Harness or connectors.
Camera.
Around view monitor control unit.
Around view monitor control unit Front camera
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
M96
38
E226
1
Yes
37 2
Around view monitor control unit
Ground Continuity
Connector Terminal
M96 37 No
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
U1302 CAMERA POWER VOLT
AV-535
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> Replace front camera. Refer to AV-630, "Removal and Installation".
NO >> Replace around view monitor control unit. Refer to AV-629, "Removal and Installation".
4.CHECK REAR CAMERA POWER SUPPLY AND POWER SUPPLY GROUND CIRCUIT CONTINUITY
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect around view monitor control unit connector M96 and rear camera connector D504.
3. Check continuity between around view monitor control unit connector M96 and rear camera connector
D504.
4. Check continuity between around view monitor control unit connector M96 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 5.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
5.CHECK AROUND VIEW MONITOR CONTROL UNIT VOLTAGE
1. Connect around view monitor control unit connector M96 and rear camera connector D504.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check the voltage between the terminals of around view monitor control unit connector M96.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> Replace rear camera. Refer to AV-631, "Removal and Installation".
NO >> Replace around view monitor control unit. Refer to AV-629, "Removal and Installation".
6.CHECK LH SIDE CAMERA POWER SUPPLY AND POWER SUPPLY GROUND CIRCUIT CONTINUITY
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect around view monitor control unit connector M96 and LH side camera connector D28.
3. Check continuity between around view monitor control unit connector M96 and LH side camera connector
D28.
Around view monitor control unit M97
Condition
Voltage
(Approx.)
(+) ()
Terminal Terminal
38 37
CAMERA switch is ON or shift
position is R.
6.0 V
Around view monitor control unit Rear camera
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
M96
25
D504
2
Yes
26 1
Around view monitor control unit
Ground Continuity
Connector Terminal
M96 25 No
Around view monitor control unit M96
Condition
Voltage
(Approx.)
(+) ()
Terminal Terminal
26 25
CAMERA switch is ON or shift
position is R.
6.0 V
Around view monitor control unit LH side camera
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-536
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
U1302 CAMERA POWER VOLT
4. Check continuity between around view monitor control unit connector M96 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 7.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
7.CHECK AROUND VIEW MONITOR CONTROL UNIT VOLTAGE
1. Connect around view monitor control unit connector M96 and LH side camera connector D28.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check the voltage between the terminals of around view monitor control unit connector M96.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> Replace LH side camera. Refer to AV-632, "Removal and Installation".
NO >> Replace around view monitor control unit. Refer to AV-629, "Removal and Installation".
8.CHECK RH SIDE CAMERA POWER SUPPLY AND POWER SUPPLY GROUND CIRCUIT CONTINUITY
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect around view monitor control unit connector M96 and RH side camera connector D128.
3. Check continuity between around view monitor control unit connector M96 and RH side camera connector
D128.
4. Check continuity between around view monitor control unit connector M96 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 9.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
9.CHECK AROUND VIEW MONITOR CONTROL UNIT VOLTAGE
1. Connect around view monitor control unit connector M96 and RH side camera connector D128.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check the voltage between the terminals of around view monitor control unit connector M96.
M96
30
D28
6
Yes
29 18
Around view monitor control unit
Ground Continuity
Connector Terminal
M96 29 No
Around view monitor control unit M96
Condition
Voltage
(Approx.)
(+) ()
Terminal Terminal
30 29
CAMERA switch is ON or shift
position is R.
6.0 V
Around view monitor control unit RH side camera
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
M96
34
D128
6
Yes
33 18
Around view monitor control unit
Ground Continuity
Connector Terminal
M96 33 No
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
U1302 CAMERA POWER VOLT
AV-537
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> Replace RH side camera. Refer to AV-632, "Removal and Installation".
NO >> Replace around view monitor control unit. Refer to AV-629, "Removal and Installation".
Around view monitor control unit M96
Condition
Voltage
(Approx.)
(+) ()
Terminal Terminal
34 33
CAMERA switch is ON or shift
position is R.
6.0 V
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-538
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
U1303 LED POWER SUPPLY VOLT
U1303 LED POWER SUPPLY VOLT
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174745
DTC DETECTION LOGIC
Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174746
Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-442, "Wiring Diagram".
1.CHECK CAMERA DATA MONITOR
Check CAMERA IMAGE SIG, CAMERA COMM STATUS and CAMERA COMM LINE for each camera in
DATA MONITOR of AVM.
Is OK displayed for all cameras?
YES >> Refer to GI-49, "Intermittent Incident".
NO-1 (LH side camera)>>GO TO 2.
NO-2 (RH side camera)>>GO TO 4.
2.CHECK LH SIDE CAMERA POWER SUPPLY AND POWER SUPPLY GROUND CIRCUIT CONTINUITY
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect around view monitor control unit connector M96 and LH side camera connector D28.
3. Check continuity between around view monitor control unit connector M96 and LH side camera connector
D28.
4. Check continuity between around view monitor control unit connector M96 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 3.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
3.CHECK AROUND VIEW MONITOR CONTROL UNIT VOLTAGE
1. Connect around view monitor control unit connector M96 and LH side camera connector D6.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check the voltage between the terminals of around view monitor control unit connector M96.
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
LED SUPPLY POWER SUP-
PLY VOLTAGE ABNORMAL-
ITY
[U1303]
Short in camera power circuit.
Harness or connectors.
Camera.
Around view monitor control unit.
Around view monitor control unit LH side camera
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
M96
30
D28
6
Yes
29 18
Around view monitor control unit
Ground Continuity
Connector Terminal
M96 29 No
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
U1303 LED POWER SUPPLY VOLT
AV-539
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> Replace LH side camera. Refer to AV-632, "Removal and Installation".
NO >> Replace around view monitor control unit. Refer to AV-629, "Removal and Installation".
4.CHECK RH SIDE CAMERA POWER SUPPLY AND POWER SUPPLY GROUND CIRCUIT CONTINUITY
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect around view monitor control unit connector M96 and RH side camera connector D128.
3. Check continuity between around view monitor control unit connector M96 and RH side camera connector
D128.
4. Check continuity between around view monitor control unit connector M96 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 5.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
5.CHECK AROUND VIEW MONITOR CONTROL UNIT VOLTAGE
1. Connect around view monitor control unit connector M96 and RH side camera connector D128.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check the voltage between around the terminals of view monitor control unit connector M96.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> Replace RH side camera. Refer to AV-632, "Removal and Installation".
NO >> Replace around view monitor control unit. Refer to AV-629, "Removal and Installation".
Around view monitor control unit M96
Condition
Voltage
(Approx.)
(+) ()
Terminal Terminal
30 29
CAMERA switch is ON or shift
position is R.
6.0 V
Around view monitor control unit RH side camera
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
M96
34
D128
6
Yes
33 18
Around view monitor control unit
Ground Continuity
Connector Terminal
M96 33 No
Around view monitor control unit M96
Condition
Voltage
(Approx.)
(+) ()
Terminal Terminal
34 33
CAMERA switch is ON or shift
position is R.
6.0 V
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-540
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
U1304 CAMERA IMAGE CALIBRATION
U1304 CAMERA IMAGE CALIBRATION
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174747
DTC DETECTION LOGIC
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
NON-COMPLETION OF
THE CALIBRATION
[U1304]
Camera calibration malfunction.
Cameras are not calibrated. Refer to AV-494, "CAL-
IBRATING CAMERA IMAGE (AROUND VIEW
MONITOR) : Work Procedure".
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
U1305 CONFIG UNFINISH
AV-541
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
U1305 CONFIG UNFINISH
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174748
DTC DETECTION LOGIC
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
NON-COMPLETION OF
THE WRITE CONFIGURA-
TION
[U1305]
Around view monitor control unit configuration
malfunction.
Around view monitor control unit not configurated.
Refer to AV-492, "CONFIGURATION (AROUND
VIEW MONITOR CONTROL UNIT) : Work Proce-
dure".
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-542
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
U1310 AV CONTROL UNIT
U1310 AV CONTROL UNIT
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174749
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
CONTROL UNIT (AV)
[U1310]
An initial diagnosis error is detected in AV com-
munication circuit.
Replace AV control unit if malfunction occurs con-
stantly.
Refer to AV-611, "Removal and Installation".
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
U1601, U1603, U1609, U160B FRONT DOOR SPEAKER/TWEETER
AV-543
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
U1601, U1603, U1609, U160B FRONT DOOR SPEAKER/TWEETER
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174750
DTC DETECTION LOGIC
Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174751
1.PERFORM SELF DIAGNOSTIC RESULT
1. Perform Self Diagnostic Result for MULTI AV.
2. Erase Self Diagnostic Result. Turn ignition switch OFF.
3. Turn ignition switch ON. Perform Self Diagnostic Result again.
Is DTC U1601, U1603, U1609 or U160B detected?
YES >> Refer to AV-564, "Diagnosis Procedure".
NO >> Refer to GI-49, "Intermittent Incident".
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
FL-DOOR WOOFER
(OPEN, SHORT, GND-
SHORT)
[U1601]
FL-DOOR WOOFER
(VB-SHOR]
[U1603]
When any of the following is detected:
Sound signal circuit malfunction between BOSE
speaker amp. and front door speaker LH.
Sound signal circuit malfunction between BOSE
speaker amp. and front tweeter LH.
Sound signal circuits between BOSE speaker
amp. and front door speaker LH.
Refer to AV-564, "Diagnosis Procedure".
Sound signal circuits between BOSE speaker
amp. and front tweeter LH.
Refer to AV-561, "Diagnosis Procedure".
FR-DOOR WOOFER
(OPEN, SHORT, GND-
SHORT)
[U1609]
FR-DOOR WOOFER
(VB-SHOR)
[U160B]
When any of the following is detected:
Sound signal circuit malfunction between BOSE
speaker amp. and front door speaker RH.
Sound signal circuit malfunction between BOSE
speaker amp. and front tweeter RH.
Sound signal circuits between BOSE speaker
amp. and front door speaker RH.
Refer to AV-564, "Diagnosis Procedure".
Sound signal circuits between BOSE speaker
amp. and front tweeter RH.
Refer to AV-561, "Diagnosis Procedure".
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-544
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
U1627, U162F TWEETER
U1627, U162F TWEETER
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174752
DTC DETECTION LOGIC
Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174753
1.PERFORM SELF DIAGNOSTIC RESULT
1. Perform Self Diagnostic Result for MULTI AV.
2. Erase Self Diagnostic Result. Turn ignition switch OFF.
3. Turn ignition switch ON. Perform Self Diagnostic Result again.
Is DTC U1627 or U162F detected?
YES >> Refer to AV-558, "Diagnosis Procedure".
NO >> Refer to GI-49, "Intermittent Incident".
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
F-INST L-TWEETER
(OPEN, SHORT, GND-
SHORT or VB-SHOR)
[U1627]
Sound signal circuit malfunction between BOSE
speaker amp. and instrument panel tweeter LH.
Sound signal circuits between BOSE speaker amp.
and instrument panel tweeter LH.
Refer to AV-558, "Diagnosis Procedure".
F-INST R-TWEETER
(OPEN, SHORT, GND-
SHORT or VB-SHOR)
[U162F]
Sound signal circuit malfunction between BOSE
speaker amp. and instrument panel tweeter RH.
Sound signal circuits between BOSE speaker amp.
and instrument panel tweeter RH.
Refer to AV-558, "Diagnosis Procedure".
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
U162A CENTER SPEAKER
AV-545
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
U162A CENTER SPEAKER
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174754
DTC DETECTION LOGIC
Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174755
1.PERFORM SELF DIAGNOSTIC RESULT
1. Perform Self Diagnostic Result for MULTI AV.
2. Erase Self Diagnostic Result. Turn ignition switch OFF.
3. Turn ignition switch ON. Perform Self Diagnostic Result again.
Is DTC U162A detected?
YES >> Refer to AV-556, "Diagnosis Procedure".
NO >> Refer to GI-49, "Intermittent Incident".
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
F-INST C-SQUAWK
(OPEN, SHORT, GND-
SHORT, or VB-SHORT)
[U162A]
Sound signal circuit malfunction between BOSE
speaker amp. and center speaker.
Sound signal circuits between BOSE speaker
amp. and center speaker.
Refer to AV-556, "Diagnosis Procedure".
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-546
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
U1684, U1687, U168C, U168F REAR DOOR SPEAKER/TWEETER
U1684, U1687, U168C, U168F REAR DOOR SPEAKER/TWEETER
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174756
DTC DETECTION LOGIC
Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174757
1.PERFORM SELF DIAGNOSTIC RESULT
1. Perform Self Diagnostic Result for MULTI AV.
2. Erase Self Diagnostic Result. Turn ignition switch OFF.
3. Turn ignition switch ON. Perform Self Diagnostic Result again.
Is DTC U1684 or U168C detected?
YES >> Refer to AV-567, "Diagnosis Procedure".
NO >> Refer to GI-49, "Intermittent Incident".
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
2L-DOOR SPEAKER
(OPEN, SHORT, GND-
SHORT)
[U1684]
Sound signal circuit malfunction between BOSE
speaker amp. and rear door speaker LH is detected:
Sound signal circuits between BOSE speaker amp.
and rear door speaker LH.
Refer to AV-567, "Diagnosis Procedure".
2R-DOOR SPEAKER
(OPEN, SHORT, GND-
SHORT)
[U168C]
Sound signal circuit malfunction between BOSE
speaker amp. and rear door speaker RH is detected:
Sound signal circuits between BOSE speaker amp.
and rear door speaker RH.
Refer to AV-567, "Diagnosis Procedure".
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
U175D WOOFER
AV-547
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
U175D WOOFER
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174758
DTC DETECTION LOGIC
Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174759
1.PERFORM SELF DIAGNOSTIC RESULT
1. Perform Self Diagnostic Result for MULTI AV.
2. Erase Self Diagnostic Result. Turn ignition switch OFF.
3. Turn ignition switch ON. Perform Self Diagnostic Result again.
Is DTC U175D detected?
YES >> Refer to AV-573, "Diagnosis Procedure".
NO >> Refer to GI-49, "Intermittent Incident".
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
R-LUGGAGE L-WOOFER
(OPEN, SHORT, GND-
SHORT or VB-SHOR)
[U175D]
Sound signal circuit malfunction between BOSE
speaker amp. and subwoofer.
Sound signal circuits between BOSE speaker
amp. and subwoofer.
Refer to AV-573, "Diagnosis Procedure".
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-548
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
U176A, U1772 ROOF SPEAKER
U176A, U1772 ROOF SPEAKER
DTC Logic INFOID:0000000009174760
DTC DETECTION LOGIC
Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174761
1.PERFORM SELF DIAGNOSTIC RESULT
1. Perform Self Diagnostic Result for MULTI AV.
2. Erase Self Diagnostic Result. Turn ignition switch OFF.
3. Turn ignition switch ON. Perform Self Diagnostic Result again.
Is DTC U176A or U1772 detected?
YES >> Refer to AV-570, "Diagnosis Procedure".
NO >> Refer to GI-49, "Intermittent Incident".
CONSULT Display DTC Detection Condition Possible Cause
R-ROOF L-SQAWK
(OPEN, SHORT, GND-
SHORT or VB-SHOR)
[U176A]
Sound signal circuit malfunction between BOSE
speaker amp. and rear side speaker LH.
Sound signal circuits between BOSE speaker
amp. and rear side speaker LH.
Refer to AV-570, "Diagnosis Procedure".
R-ROOF R-SQAWK
(OPEN, SHORT, GND-
SHORT or VB-SHOR)
[U1772]
Sound signal circuit malfunction between BOSE
speaker amp. and rear side speaker RH.
Sound signal circuits between BOSE speaker
amp. and rear side speaker RH.
Refer to AV-570, "Diagnosis Procedure".
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT
AV-549
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT
AV CONTROL UNIT
AV CONTROL UNIT : Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174762
Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-442, "Wiring Diagram".
1.CHECK FUSE
Check that the following fuses are not blown.
Are the fuses blown?
YES >> Replace the blown fuse after repairing the affected circuit.
NO >> GO TO 2.
2.CHECK POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect AV control unit connectors M161 and M163.
3. Check voltage between AV control unit connectors and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 3.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
3.CHECK GROUND CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Check continuity between AV control unit connector M161 terminal 20 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> Inspection End.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
DISPLAY UNIT
DISPLAY UNIT : Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174763
Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-442, "Wiring Diagram".
1.CHECK FUSE
Check that the following fuses are not blown.
Terminal No. Signal name Fuse No.
68 Ignition signal 29 (5A)
19 Battery power supply 15 (15A)
AV control unit
Ground Condition
Voltage
(Approx.)
Connector Terminal
M163 68
Ignition switch: ON
Battery voltage
M161
7 Ignition switch: ACC
19 Ignition switch: OFF
AV control unit
Ground Continuity
Connector Terminal
M161 20 Yes
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-550
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT
Are the fuses blown?
YES >> Replace the blown fuse after repairing the affected circuit.
NO >> GO TO 2.
2.CHECK POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect display unit connector.
3. Check voltage between display connector M92 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 3.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
3.CHECK GROUND CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Check continuity between display unit connector M92 terminal 12 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> Inspection End.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
BOSE AMP.
BOSE AMP. : Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174764
Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-442, "Wiring Diagram".
1.CHECK FUSE
Check that the following fuses are not blown.
Are the fuses blown?
YES >> Replace the blown fuse after repairing the affected circuit.
NO >> GO TO 2.
2.CHECK POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Disconnect BOSE speaker amp. connector B129.
2. Check voltage between BOSE speaker amp. connector B129 and ground.
Terminal No. Signal name Fuse No.
11 Battery power supply 15 (15A)
23 ACC power supply 65 (10A)
Display unit
Ground Condition
Voltage
(Approx.)
Connector Terminal
M92
23
Ignition switch: ON
Battery voltage
2 Ignition switch: OFF
Around view monitor control unit
Ground Continuity
Connector Terminal
M96 1 Yes
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-556
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
CENTER SPEAKER
CENTER SPEAKER
Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174770
Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-442, "Wiring Diagram".
1.CONNECTOR CHECK
Check the BOSE speaker amp. and speaker connectors for the following:
Proper connection
Damage
Disconnected or loose terminals
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 2.
NO >> Repair the terminals or connectors.
2.CHECK CENTER SPEAKER SIGNAL CIRCUIT CONTINUITY
1. Disconnect BOSE speaker amp. connector B130 and center speaker connector.
2. Check continuity between BOSE speaker amp. connector B130 and center speaker connector.
3. Check continuity between BOSE speaker amp. connector B130 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 3.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
3.CHECK CENTER SPEAKER SIGNAL
1. Connect BOSE speaker amp. connector B130 and center speaker connector.
2. Turn ignition switch to ACC.
3. Push AV control unit POWER switch.
4. Check the signal between the terminals of BOSE speaker amp. connector B130.
Is the inspection result normal?
BOSE speaker amp. Center speaker
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
B130
69
M110
1
Yes
70 2
BOSE speaker amp.
Ground Continuity
Connector Terminal
B130
69
No
70
BOSE speaker amp. connector B130
Condition Reference value (+) ()
Terminal Terminal
69 70 Audio signal output
SKIB3609E
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
CENTER SPEAKER
AV-557
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
YES >> Replace center speaker. Refer to AV-622, "Removal and Installation".
NO >> GO TO 4.
4.CHECK PRE-AMP SIGNAL CIRCUIT CONTINUITY
1. Disconnect AV control unit connector M161 and BOSE speaker amp. connector B130.
2. Check continuity between AV control unit connector M161 and BOSE speaker amp. connector B130.
3. Check continuity between AV control unit connector M161 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 5.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
5.CHECK PRE-AMP SIGNAL
1. Connect AV control unit connector M161 and BOSE speaker amp. connector B130.
2. Turn ignition switch to ACC.
3. Push AV control unit POWER switch.
4. Check signal between the terminals of AV control unit connector M161.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> Replace BOSE speaker amp. Refer to AV-618, "Removal and Installation".
NO >> Replace AV control unit. Refer to AV-611, "Removal and Installation".
AV control unit BOSE speaker amp.
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
M161
2
B130
75
Yes
3 76
11 73
12 74
AV control unit
Ground Continuity
Connector Terminal
M161
2
No
3
11
12
AV control unit connector M161
Condition Reference value (+) ()
Terminal Terminal
2 3
Audio signal output
11 12
SKIB3609E
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-558
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
INSTRUMENT PANEL SPEAKER/TWEETER
INSTRUMENT PANEL SPEAKER/TWEETER
Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174771
Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-442, "Wiring Diagram".
1.CONNECTOR CHECK
Check the BOSE speaker amp. and speaker connectors for the following:
Proper connection
Damage
Disconnected or loose terminals
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 2.
NO >> Repair the terminals or connectors.
2.CHECK INSTRUMENT PANEL TWEETER SIGNAL CIRCUIT CONTINUITY
1. Disconnect BOSE speaker amp. connector B129 and suspect instrument panel tweeter connector.
2. Check continuity between BOSE speaker amp. connector B129 and suspect instrument panel tweeter
connector.
3. Check continuity between BOSE speaker amp. connector B129 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 3.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
3.CHECK INSTRUMENT PANEL TWEETER SIGNAL
1. Connect BOSE speaker amp. connector B129 and suspect instrument panel tweeter connector.
2. Turn ignition switch to ACC.
3. Push AV control unit POWER switch.
4. Check the signal between the terminals of BOSE speaker amp. connector B129.
BOSE speaker amp. Instrument panel tweeter
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
B129
41
M62 (LH)
1
Yes
42 2
45
M73 (RH)
1
46 2
BOSE speaker amp.
Ground Continuity
Connector Terminal
B129
41
No
42
45
46
BOSE speaker amp. connector B129
Condition Reference value (+) ()
Terminal Terminal
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
INSTRUMENT PANEL SPEAKER/TWEETER
AV-559
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> Replace instrument panel tweeter. Refer to AV-621, "Removal and Installation".
NO >> GO TO 4.
4.CHECK PRE-AMP SIGNAL CIRCUIT CONTINUITY
1. Disconnect AV control unit connector M161 and BOSE speaker amp. connector B130.
2. Check continuity between AV control unit connector M161 and BOSE speaker amp. connector B130.
3. Check continuity between AV control unit connector M161 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 5.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
5.CHECK PRE-AMP SIGNAL
1. Connect AV control unit connector M161 and BOSE speaker amp. connector B130.
2. Turn ignition switch to ACC.
3. Push AV control unit POWER switch.
4. Check signal between the terminals of AV control unit connector M161.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> Replace BOSE speaker amp. Refer to AV-618, "Removal and Installation".
41 42
Audio signal output
45 46
SKIB3609E
AV control unit BOSE speaker amp.
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
M161
2
B130
75
Yes
3 76
11 73
12 74
AV control unit
Ground Continuity
Connector Terminal
M161
2
No
3
11
12
AV control unit connector M161
Condition Reference value (+) ()
Terminal Terminal
2 3
Audio signal output
11 12
SKIB3609E
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-560
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
INSTRUMENT PANEL SPEAKER/TWEETER
NO >> Replace AV control unit. Refer to AV-611, "Removal and Installation".
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
FRONT TWEETER
AV-561
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
FRONT TWEETER
Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174772
Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-442, "Wiring Diagram".
1.CONNECTOR CHECK
Check the BOSE speaker amp. and speaker connectors for the following:
Proper connection
Damage
Disconnected or loose terminals
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 2.
NO >> Repair the terminals or connectors.
2.CHECK FRONT TWEETER SIGNAL CIRCUIT CONTINUITY
1. Disconnect BOSE speaker amp. connector B130 and suspect front tweeter connector.
2. Check continuity between BOSE speaker amp. connector B130 and suspect front door speaker connec-
tor.
3. Check continuity between BOSE speaker amp. connector B130 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 3.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
3.CHECK FRONT TWEETER SIGNAL
1. Connect BOSE speaker amp. connector B130 and suspect front tweeter connector.
2. Turn ignition switch to ACC.
3. Push AV control unit POWER switch.
4. Check the signal between the terminals of BOSE speaker amp. connector B130.
BOSE speaker amp. Front tweeter
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
B130
58
M109 (LH)
1
Yes
59 2
71
M111 (RH)
1
72 2
BOSE speaker amp.
Ground Continuity
Connector Terminal
B130
58
No
59
71
72
BOSE speaker amp. connector B130
Condition Reference value (+) ()
Terminal Terminal
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-562
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
FRONT TWEETER
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> Replace front tweeter. Refer to AV-620, "Removal and Installation".
NO >> GO TO 4.
4.CHECK PRE-AMP SIGNAL CIRCUIT CONTINUITY
1. Disconnect AV control unit connector M161 and BOSE speaker amp. connector B130.
2. Check continuity between AV control unit connector M161 and BOSE speaker amp. connector B130.
3. Check continuity between AV control unit connector M161 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 5.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
5.CHECK PRE-AMP SIGNAL
1. Connect AV control unit connector M161 and BOSE speaker amp. connector B130.
2. Turn ignition switch to ACC.
3. Push AV control unit POWER switch.
4. Check signal between the terminals of AV control unit connector M161.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> Replace BOSE speaker amp. Refer to AV-618, "Removal and Installation".
58 59
Audio signal output
71 72
SKIB3609E
AV control unit BOSE speaker amp.
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
M161
2
B130
75
Yes
3 76
11 73
12 74
AV control unit
Ground Continuity
Connector Terminal
M161
2
No
3
11
12
AV control unit connector M161
Condition Reference value (+) ()
Terminal Terminal
2 3
Audio signal output
11 12
SKIB3609E
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
FRONT TWEETER
AV-563
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
NO >> Replace AV control unit. Refer to AV-611, "Removal and Installation".
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-564
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
FRONT DOOR SPEAKER
FRONT DOOR SPEAKER
Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174773
Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-442, "Wiring Diagram".
1.CONNECTOR CHECK
Check the BOSE speaker amp. and speaker connectors for the following:
Proper connection
Damage
Disconnected or loose terminals
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 2.
NO >> Repair the terminals or connectors.
2.CHECK FRONT DOOR SPEAKER SIGNAL CIRCUIT CONTINUITY
1. Disconnect BOSE speaker amp. connector B130 and suspect front door speaker connector.
2. Check continuity between BOSE speaker amp. connector B130 and suspect front door speaker connec-
tor.
3. Check continuity between BOSE speaker amp. connector B130 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 3.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
3.CHECK FRONT DOOR SPEAKER SIGNAL
1. Connect BOSE speaker amp. connector B130 and suspect front door speaker connector.
2. Turn ignition switch to ACC.
3. Push AV control unit POWER switch.
4. Check the signal between the terminals of BOSE speaker amp. connector B130.
BOSE speaker amp. Front door speaker
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
B130
58
D12 (LH)
1
Yes
59 2
71
D112 (RH)
1
72 2
BOSE speaker amp.
Ground Continuity
Connector Terminal
B130
58
No
59
71
72
BOSE speaker amp. connector B130
Condition Reference value (+) ()
Terminal Terminal
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
FRONT DOOR SPEAKER
AV-565
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> Replace front door speaker. Refer to AV-619, "Removal and Installation".
NO >> GO TO 4.
4.CHECK PRE-AMP SIGNAL CIRCUIT CONTINUITY
1. Disconnect AV control unit connector M161 and BOSE speaker amp. connector B130.
2. Check continuity between AV control unit connector M161 and BOSE speaker amp. connector B130.
3. Check continuity between AV control unit connector M161 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 5.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
5.CHECK PRE-AMP SIGNAL
1. Connect AV control unit connector M161 and BOSE speaker amp. connector B130.
2. Turn ignition switch to ACC.
3. Push AV control unit POWER switch.
4. Check signal between the terminals of AV control unit connector M161.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> Replace BOSE speaker amp. Refer to AV-618, "Removal and Installation".
58 59
Audio signal output
71 72
SKIB3609E
AV control unit BOSE speaker amp.
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
M161
2
B130
75
Yes
3 76
11 73
12 74
AV control unit
Ground Continuity
Connector Terminal
M161
2
No
3
11
12
AV control unit connector M161
Condition Reference value (+) ()
Terminal Terminal
2 3
Audio signal output
11 12
SKIB3609E
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-566
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
FRONT DOOR SPEAKER
NO >> Replace AV control unit. Refer to AV-611, "Removal and Installation".
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
REAR DOOR SPEAKER
AV-567
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
REAR DOOR SPEAKER
Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174774
Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-442, "Wiring Diagram".
1.CONNECTOR CHECK
Check the BOSE speaker amp. and speaker connectors for the following:
Proper connection
Damage
Disconnected or loose terminals
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 2.
NO >> Repair the terminals or connectors.
2.CHECK REAR DOOR SPEAKER SIGNAL CIRCUIT CONTINUITY
1. Disconnect BOSE speaker amp. connector B129 or B130 and suspect rear door speaker connector.
2. Check continuity between BOSE speaker amp. connector B129 or B130 and suspect rear door speaker
connector.
3. Check continuity between BOSE speaker amp. connector B129 or B130 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 3.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
3.CHECK REAR DOOR SPEAKER SIGNAL
1. Connect BOSE speaker amp. connector B129 or B130 and suspect rear door speaker connector.
2. Turn ignition switch to ACC.
3. Push AV control unit POWER switch.
4. Check the signal between the terminals of BOSE speaker amp. connectors.
BOSE speaker amp. Rear door speaker
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
B130
68
D207 (LH)
1
Yes
55 2
B129
54
D307 (RH)
1
49 2
BOSE speaker amp.
Ground Continuity
Connector Terminal
B130
68
No
55
B129
54
49
BOSE speaker amp. Condition Reference value
Connector
(+) ()
Terminal Terminal
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-568
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
REAR DOOR SPEAKER
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> Replace rear door speaker. Refer to AV-623, "Removal and Installation".
NO >> GO TO 4.
4.CHECK PRE-AMP SIGNAL CIRCUIT CONTINUITY
1. Disconnect AV control unit connector M161 and BOSE speaker amp. connector B130.
2. Check continuity between AV control unit connector M161 and BOSE speaker amp. connector B130.
3. Check continuity between AV control unit connector M161 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 5.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
5.CHECK PRE-AMP SIGNAL
1. Connect AV control unit connector M161 and BOSE speaker amp. connector B130.
2. Turn ignition switch to ACC.
3. Push AV control unit POWER switch.
4. Check signal between the terminals of AV control unit connector M161.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> Replace BOSE speaker amp. Refer to AV-618, "Removal and Installation".
B130 68 55
Audio signal output
B129 54 49
SKIB3609E
AV control unit BOSE speaker amp.
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
M161
4
B130
64
Yes
5 63
13 66
14 65
AV control unit
Ground Continuity
Connector Terminal
M161
4
No
5
13
14
AV control unit connector M161
Condition Reference value (+) ()
Terminal Terminal
4 5
Audio signal output
13 14
SKIB3609E
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
REAR DOOR SPEAKER
AV-569
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
NO >> Replace AV control unit. Refer to AV-611, "Removal and Installation".
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-570
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
REAR SPEAKER
REAR SPEAKER
Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174775
Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-442, "Wiring Diagram".
1.CONNECTOR CHECK
Check the BOSE speaker amp. and speaker connectors for the following:
Proper connection
Damage
Disconnected or loose terminals
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 2.
NO >> Repair the terminals or connectors.
2.CHECK REAR SIDE SPEAKER SIGNAL CIRCUIT CONTINUITY
1. Disconnect BOSE speaker amp. connector B129 and suspect rear side speaker connector.
2. Check continuity between BOSE speaker amp. connector B129 and suspect rear side speaker connector.
3. Check continuity between BOSE speaker amp. connector B129 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 3.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
3.CHECK REAR SIDE SPEAKER SIGNAL
1. Connect BOSE speaker amp. connector B129 and suspect rear side speaker connector.
2. Turn ignition switch to ACC.
3. Push AV control unit POWER switch.
4. Check the signal between the terminals of BOSE speaker amp. connector B129.
BOSE speaker amp. Rear side speaker
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
B129
53
B1 (LH)
1
Yes
48 2
44
B153 (RH)
1
43 2
BOSE speaker amp.
Ground Continuity
Connector Terminal
B129
53
No
48
44
43
BOSE speaker amp. connector B129 Condition Reference value
(+) ()
Terminal Terminal
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
REAR SPEAKER
AV-571
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> Replace rear side speaker. Refer to AV-624, "Removal and Installation".
NO >> GO TO 4.
4.CHECK PRE-AMP SIGNAL CIRCUIT CONTINUITY
1. Disconnect AV control unit connector M161 and BOSE speaker amp. connector B130.
2. Check continuity between AV control unit connector M161 and BOSE speaker amp. connector B130.
3. Check continuity between AV control unit connector M161 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 5.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
5.CHECK PRE-AMP SIGNAL
1. Connect AV control unit connector M161 and BOSE speaker amp. connector B130.
2. Turn ignition switch to ACC.
3. Push AV control unit POWER switch.
4. Check signal between the terminals of AV control unit connector M161.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> Replace BOSE speaker amp. Refer to AV-618, "Removal and Installation".
53 48
Audio signal output
44 43
SKIB3609E
AV control unit BOSE speaker amp.
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
M161
4
B130
64
Yes
5 63
13 66
14 65
AV control unit
Ground Continuity
Connector Terminal
M161
4
No
5
13
14
AV control unit connector M161
Condition Reference value (+) ()
Terminal Terminal
4 5
Audio signal output
13 14
SKIB3609E
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-572
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
REAR SPEAKER
NO >> Replace AV control unit. Refer to AV-611, "Removal and Installation".
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
SUBWOOFER
AV-573
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
SUBWOOFER
Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174776
Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-442, "Wiring Diagram".
1.CONNECTOR CHECK
Check the AV control unit, BOSE speaker amp. and subwoofer connectors for the following:
Proper connection
Damage
Disconnected or looses terminals
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 2.
NO >> Repair the terminal and connector.
2.VERIFY SUBWOOFER POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND
Check subwoofer power supply and ground. Refer to AV-551, "SUBWOOFER : Diagnosis Procedure".
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 3.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
3.CHECK SUBWOOFER AMP ON CIRCUIT CONTINUITY
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect Bose speaker amp. connector B130 and subwoofer connector.
3. Check continuity between Bose speaker amp. connector B130 and subwoofer connector B73.
4. Check continuity between Bose speaker amp. connector B130 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 4.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
4.CHECK SUBWOOFER AMP ON CIRCUIT VOLTAGE
1. Connect Bose speaker amp. connector B130.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check voltage between Bose speaker amp. connector B130 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 5.
NO >> Replace Bose speaker amp. Refer to AV-618, "Removal and Installation".
Bose speaker amp. Subwoofer
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
B130 62 B73 4 Yes
Bose speaker amp.
Ground Continuity
Connector Terminal
B130 62 No
Bose speaker amp. Ground
Voltage
(Approx.)
(+)
()
Connector Terminal
B130 62 Battery voltage
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-574
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
SUBWOOFER
5.CHECK SUBWOOFER SIGNAL CIRCUIT CONTINUITY
1. Disconnect BOSE speaker amp. connector B130 and subwoofer connector.
2. Check continuity between BOSE speaker amp. connector B130 and subwoofer connector.
3. Check continuity between BOSE speaker amp. connector B130 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 6.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
6.CHECK SUBWOOFER SIGNAL
1. Connect BOSE speaker amp. connector B130 and subwoofer connector.
2. Turn ignition switch to ACC.
3. Push AV control unit POWER switch.
4. Check the signal between the terminals of BOSE speaker amp. connector B130.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> Replace subwoofer. Refer to AV-625, "Removal and Installation".
NO >> GO TO 7.
7.CHECK PRE-AMP SIGNAL CIRCUIT CONTINUITY
1. Disconnect AV control unit connector M161 and BOSE speaker amp. connector B130.
2. Check continuity between AV control unit connector M161 and BOSE speaker amp. connector B130.
3. Check continuity between AV control unit connector M161 and ground.
BOSE speaker amp. Subwoofer
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
B130
56
B73
2
Yes
57 1
BOSE speaker amp.
Ground Continuity
Connector Terminal
B130
56
No
57
BOSE speaker amp. connector B130
Condition Reference value (+) ()
Terminal Terminal
56 57 Audio signal output
SKIB3609E
AV control unit BOSE speaker amp.
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
M161
4
B130
64
Yes
5 63
13 66
14 65
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
SUBWOOFER
AV-575
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 8.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
8.CHECK PRE-AMP SIGNAL
1. Connect AV control unit connector M161 and BOSE speaker amp. connector B130.
2. Turn ignition switch to ACC.
3. Push AV control unit POWER switch.
4. Check signal between the terminals of AV control unit connector M161.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> Replace BOSE speaker amp. Refer to AV-618, "Removal and Installation".
NO >> Replace AV control unit. Refer to AV-611, "Removal and Installation".
AV control unit
Ground Continuity
Connector Terminal
M161
4
No
5
13
14
AV control unit connector M161
Condition Reference value (+) ()
Terminal Terminal
4 5
Audio signal output
13 14
SKIB3609E
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-576
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
FRONT AUXILIARY INPUT JACK AUDIO SIGNAL CIRCUIT
FRONT AUXILIARY INPUT JACK AUDIO SIGNAL CIRCUIT
Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174777
Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-442, "Wiring Diagram".
1.CHECK AUX SOUND SIGNAL CIRCUIT CONTINUITY
1. Turn ignition OFF.
2. Disconnect AV control unit connector M162 and front auxiliary input jacks connector.
3. Check continuity between AV control unit connector M162 and front auxiliary input jacks connector.
4. Check continuity between AV control unit connector M162 and ground.
Is inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 2.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
2.CHECK AUX SOUND SIGNAL GROUND CIRCUIT CONTINUITY
Check continuity between AV control unit connector M162 and front auxiliary input jacks connector M205.
Is inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 3.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
3.CHECK AUX SOUND SIGNAL
1. Connect AV control unit connector M162 and front auxiliary input jacks connector.
2. Turn ignition switch to ACC.
3. Select AUX mode.
4. Check the signal between the terminals of AV control unit connector M162.
AV control unit Front auxiliary input jacks
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
M162
24
M205
3
Yes
38 1
AV control unit
Ground Continuity
Connector Terminal
M162
24
No
38
AV control unit Front auxiliary input jacks
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
M162 39 M205 2 Yes
AV control unit connector M162 Condition Reference value
(+) ()
Terminal Terminal
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
FRONT AUXILIARY INPUT JACK AUDIO SIGNAL CIRCUIT
AV-577
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> Replace front auxiliary input jacks. Refer to AV-627, "Removal and Installation".
NO >> Replace AV control unit. Refer to AV-611, "Removal and Installation".
24 39
AUX mode selected
38 39
SKIB3609E
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-578
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
COMPOSITE IMAGE SIGNAL CIRCUIT (AV CONTROL UNIT TO FRONT DIS-
PLAY UNIT)
COMPOSITE IMAGE SIGNAL CIRCUIT (AV CONTROL UNIT TO FRONT
DISPLAY UNIT)
Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174778
Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-442, "Wiring Diagram".
1.CHECK COMPOSITE IMAGE SIGNAL CIRCUIT CONTINUITY
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect AV control unit connector M163 and display unit connector M92.
3. Check continuity between AV control unit connector M163 and display unit connector M92.
4. Check continuity between AV control unit connector M163 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 2.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
2.CHECK COMPOSITE IMAGE SIGNAL
1. Connect AV control unit connector M163 and display unit connector M92.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check the signal between the terminals of AV control unit connector M163.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> Replace display unit. Refer to AV-615, "Removal and Installation".
NO >> Replace AV control unit. Refer to AV-611, "Removal and Installation".
AV control unit Display unit
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
M163
56
M92
18
Yes
55 19
AV control unit
Ground Continuity
Connector Terminal
M163 56 No
AV control unit connector M163
Condition Reference value (+) ()
Terminal Terminal
56 55 DVD image is displayed.
SKIB2251J
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
A V
COMPOSITE IMAGE SIGNAL CIRCUIT (AV CONTROL UNIT TO VIDEO DISTRIB-
UTOR)
AV-579
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
COMPOSITE IMAGE SIGNAL CIRCUIT (AV CONTROL UNIT TO VIDEO
DISTRIBUTOR)
Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174779
Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-442, "Wiring Diagram".
1.CHECK COMPOSITE IMAGE SIGNAL CIRCUIT CONTINUITY
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect AV control unit connector M164 and video distributor connector B25.
3. Check continuity between AV control unit connector M164 and video distributor connector B25.
4. Check continuity between AV control unit connector M164 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 2.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
2.CHECK COMPOSITE IMAGE SIGNAL
1. Connect AV control unit connector M164 and video distributor connector B25.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check the signal between the terminals of video distributor connector B25.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> Replace video distributor. Refer to AV-633, "Removal and Installation".
NO >> Replace AV control unit. Refer to AV-611, "Removal and Installation".
AV control unit Video distributor
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
M164
107
B25
34
Yes
105 33
AV control unit
Ground Continuity
Connector Terminal
M164 107 No
Video distributor connector B25
Condition Reference value (+) ()
Terminal Terminal
34 33
DVD, USB or front auxiliary in-
put jacks image is displayed on
headrest display.
SKIB2251J
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-580
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
COMPOSITE IMAGE SIGNAL CIRCUIT (VIDEO DISTRIBUTOR TO HEADREST
DISPLAY UNIT)
COMPOSITE IMAGE SIGNAL CIRCUIT (VIDEO DISTRIBUTOR TO HEAD-
REST DISPLAY UNIT)
Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174780
Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-442, "Wiring Diagram".
1.CHECK COMPOSITE IMAGE SIGNAL CIRCUIT CONTINUITY
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect video distributor connector B24 and headrest display unit connectors.
3. Check continuity between video distributor connector B24 and headrest display unit connectors.
4. Check continuity between video distributor connector B24 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 2.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
2.CHECK COMPOSITE IMAGE SIGNAL
1. Connect video distributor connector B24 and headrest display unit connectors.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check the signal between the terminals of headrest display unit connectors.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> Replace headrest display unit. Refer to AV-616, "Removal and Installation".
NO >> Replace video distributor. Refer to AV-633, "Removal and Installation".
Video distributor Headrest display unit
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
B24
32
B223 (driver seat)
5
Yes
31 21
28
B317 (passenger seat)
5
Yes
27 21
Video distributor
Ground Continuity
Connector Terminal
B24
32
No
28
Headrest display unit
Condition Reference value
Connector
(+) ()
Terminal Terminal
B223 (driver seat) 5 21
DVD, USB or front
auxiliary input jacks
image is displayed on
headrest display.
B317 (passenger
seat)
5 21
SKIB2251J
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
A V
AUX IMAGE SIGNAL CIRCUIT (FRONT AUXILIARY INPUT JACKS TO AV CON-
TROL UNIT)
AV-581
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
AUX IMAGE SIGNAL CIRCUIT (FRONT AUXILIARY INPUT JACKS TO AV
CONTROL UNIT)
Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174781
Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-442, "Wiring Diagram".
1.CHECK AUX IMAGE SIGNAL CIRCUIT CONTINUITY
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect AV control unit connector M163 and front auxiliary input jacks connector M205.
3. Check continuity between AV control unit connector M163 and front auxiliary input jacks connector M205.
4. Check continuity between AV control unit connector M163 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 2.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
2.CHECK AUX IMAGE SIGNAL
1. Connect AV control unit connector M163 and front auxiliary input jacks connector M205.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check the signal between the terminals of front auxiliary input jacks connector M205.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> Replace front auxiliary input jacks. Refer to AV-627, "Removal and Installation".
NO >> Replace AV control unit. Refer to AV-611, "Removal and Installation".
AV control unit Front auxiliary input jacks
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
M163
91
M205
7
Yes
92 8
AV control unit
Ground Continuity
Connector Terminal
M163 91 No
Front auxiliary input jacks connector M205
Condition Reference value (+) ()
Terminal Terminal
7 8
Front auxiliary input jacks im-
age is displayed.
SKIB2251J
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-582
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
IMAGE SWITCH SIGNAL CIRCUIT
IMAGE SWITCH SIGNAL CIRCUIT
Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174782
Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-442, "Wiring Diagram".
1.CHECK CONTINUITY IMAGE SWITCH SIGNAL CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect video distributor connector B24 and headrest display unit connectors.
3. Check continuity between video distributor connector B24 and headrest display unit connectors.
4. Check continuity between video distributor connector B24 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 2.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
2.CHECK VIDEO DISTRIBUTOR VOLTAGE
1. Connect video distributor connector B24 and headrest display unit connectors.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check the voltage between the terminals of video distributor connector B24.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> Replace headrest display unit. Refer to AV-616, "Removal and Installation".
NO >> Replace video distributor. Refer to AV-633, "Removal and Installation".
Video distributor Headrest display unit
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
B24
10
B223 (driver seat)
7
Yes
7 23
9
B317 (passenger seat)
7
5 23
Video distributor
Ground Continuity
Connector Terminal
B24
10
No
9
Video distributor connector B24
Condition
Voltage
(Approx.)
(+) ()
Terminal Terminal
10 7
DVD, USB or front auxiliary in-
put jacks image is displayed on
headrest display.
0.5 V
DVD, USB or rear auxiliary in-
put jacks image is displayed on
headrest display.
4.5 V
9 5
DVD, USB or front auxiliary in-
put jacks image is displayed on
headrest display.
0.5 V
DVD, USB or rear auxiliary in-
put jacks image is displayed on
headrest display.
4.5 V
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
DISK EJECT SIGNAL CIRCUIT
AV-583
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
DISK EJECT SIGNAL CIRCUIT
Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174783
Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-442, "Wiring Diagram".
1.CHECK DISK EJECT SIGNAL CIRCUIT CONTINUITY
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect AV control unit connector M164 and A/C and AV switch assembly connector.
3. Check continuity between AV control unit connector M164 terminal 97 and A/C and AV switch assembly
connector M98 terminal 14.
4. Check continuity between AV control unit connector M164 terminal 97 and ground.
Is inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 2.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
2.CHECK AV CONTROL UNIT VOLTAGE
1. Connect AV control unit connector M164 and A/C and AV switch assembly connector.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check voltage between AV control unit connector M164 terminal 97 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> Replace A/C and AV switch assembly. Refer to AV-613, "Removal and Installation".
NO >> Replace AV control unit. Refer to AV-611, "Removal and Installation".
AV control unit A/C and AV switch assembly
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
M164 97 M98 14 Yes
AV control unit
Ground
Continuity
Connector Terminal
M164 97 No
AV control unit Ground
Condition
Voltage
(Approx.)
(+)
()
Connector Terminal
M164 97
Pressing eject switch 0 V
Except above 5.0 V
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-584
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
MICROPHONE SIGNAL CIRCUIT
MICROPHONE SIGNAL CIRCUIT
Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174784
Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-442, "Wiring Diagram".
1.CHECK MICROPHONE SIGNAL CIRCUIT CONTINUITY
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect AV control unit connector M163 and microphone connector.
3. Check continuity between AV control unit connector M163 and microphone connector R109.
4. Check continuity between AV control unit connector M163 and ground.
Is inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 2.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
2.CHECK MICROPHONE VCC VOLTAGE
1. Connect AV control unit connector M163.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check voltage between terminals of AV control unit connector M163.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 3.
NO >> Replace AV control unit. Refer to AV-611, "Removal and Installation".
3.CHECK MICROPHONE SIGNAL
1. Connect microphone connector.
2. Check signal between terminals of AV control unit connector M163.
AV control unit Microphone
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
M163
59
R109
5
Yes 60 3
75 6
AV control unit
Ground Continuity
Connector Terminal
M163
59
No 60
75
AV control unit connector M163
Voltage
(Approx.)
(+) ()
Terminal Terminal
60 59 5.0 V
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
MICROPHONE SIGNAL CIRCUIT
AV-585
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> Replace AV control unit. Refer to AV-611, "Removal and Installation".
NO >> Replace microphone. Refer to AV-628, "Removal and Installation".
AV control unit connector M163
Condition Reference value (+) ()
Terminal Terminal
75 59 Speak into microphone.
PKIB5037J
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-586
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
STEERING SWITCH
STEERING SWITCH
Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174785
Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-442, "Wiring Diagram".
1.CHECK STEERING WHEEL AUDIO CONTROL SWITCH RESISTANCE
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect combination switch connector M149.
3. Check the resistance between the terminals of combination switch connector M149.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 2.
NO >> Replace steering wheel audio control switch. Refer to AV-614, "Removal and Installation".
2.CHECK HARNESS BETWEEN COMBINATION SWITCH AND COMBINATION METER
1. Disconnect combination meter connector M24 and combination switch connector M30.
2. Check continuity between combination meter connector M24 and combination switch connector M30.
3. Check continuity between combination meter connector M24 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
Combination switch connector M149
Condition
Resistance
(Approx.)
Terminal Terminal
14
17
Depress SOURCE switch. 1
Depress switch.
121
Depress switch.
321
Depress switch.
723
Depress ENTER switch. 2023
15
Depress switch.
1
Depress switch.
121
Depress switch.
321
Depress switch.
723
Depress DISP switch. 2023
Combination meter Combination switch
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
M24
3
M30
24
Yes 24 33
4 31
Combination meter
Ground Continuity
Connector Terminal
M24
3
No 24
4
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
STEERING SWITCH
AV-587
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
YES >> GO TO 3.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
3.CHECK COMBINATION SWITCH
Check continuity between combination switch connectors M30 and M149.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 4.
NO >> Replace spiral cable. Refer to SR-15, "Removal and Installation".
4.CHECK HARNESS BETWEEN COMBINATION METER AND AV CONTROL UNIT
1. Disconnect AV control unit connector M161.
2. Check continuity between combination meter connector M24 and AV control unit connector M161.
3. Check continuity between combination meter connector M24 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 5.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
5.CHECK AV CONTROL UNIT VOLTAGE
1. Connect combination meter connector M24 and AV control unit connector M161.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check the voltage between the terminals of AV control unit connector M161.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> Replace combination meter. Refer to MWI-82, "Removal and Installation".
NO >> Replace AV control unit. Refer to AV-611, "Removal and Installation".
Combination switch
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
M30
24
M149
14
Yes 31 15
33 17
Combination meter AV control unit
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
M24
14
M161
6
Yes 15 16
16 15
Combination meter
Ground Continuity
Connector Terminal
M24
14
No 15
16
AV control unit M161
Voltage
(Approx.)
(+) ()
Terminal Terminal
6
15 5.0 V
16
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-588
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
USB CONNECTOR
USB CONNECTOR
Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174786
Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-442, "Wiring Diagram".
1.CHECK USB INTERFACE HARNESS CONTINUITY
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect AV control unit connector M145 and USB interface connector M209.
3. Check continuity between AV control unit connector M145 and USB interface connector M209.
4. Check continuity between AV control unit connector M145 and ground.
Is the inspection result normal?
YES >> Replace the USB interface. Refer to AV-626, "Removal and Installation".
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
AV control unit USB interface
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
M145
121
M209
2
Yes
122 1
123 4
124 3
125 5
AV control unit
Continuity
Connector Terminal
M145
137
Ground No
139
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
FRONT CAMERA IMAGE SIGNAL CIRCUIT
AV-589
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
FRONT CAMERA IMAGE SIGNAL CIRCUIT
Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174787
Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-442, "Wiring Diagram".
1.CHECK FRONT CAMERA IMAGE SIGNAL CIRCUIT CONTINUITY
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect around view monitor control unit connector M96 and front camera connector E226.
3. Check continuity between around view monitor control unit connector M96 and front camera connector
E226.
4. Check continuity between around view monitor control unit connector M96 and ground.
Is inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 2.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
2.CHECK FRONT CAMERA IMAGE SIGNAL
1. Connect around view monitor control unit connector M96 and front camera connector E226.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check the signal between the terminals of around view monitor control unit connector M96.
Is inspection result normal?
YES >> Replace around view monitor control unit. Refer to AV-629, "Removal and Installation".
NO >> Replace front camera. Refer to AV-630, "Removal and Installation".
Around view monitor control unit Front camera
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
M96
40
E226
3
Yes
39 4
Around view monitor control unit
Ground Continuity
Connector Terminal
M96 40 No
Around view monitor control unit connector M96
Condition Reference value (+) ()
Terminal Terminal
40 39
CAMERA switch is ON or shift
position is R.
JSNIA0834GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-590
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
REAR CAMERA IMAGE SIGNAL CIRCUIT
REAR CAMERA IMAGE SIGNAL CIRCUIT
Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174788
Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-442, "Wiring Diagram".
WITH AROUND VIEW MONITOR
1.CHECK REAR CAMERA IMAGE SIGNAL CIRCUIT CONTINUITY
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect around view monitor control unit connector M96 and rear camera connector D511.
3. Check continuity between around view monitor control unit connector M96 and rear camera connector
D511.
4. Check continuity between around view monitor control unit connector M96 and ground.
Is inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 2.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
2.CHECK REAR CAMERA IMAGE SIGNAL
1. Connect around view monitor control unit connector M96 and rear camera connector D511.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check the signal between the terminals of around view monitor control unit connector M96.
Is inspection result normal?
YES >> Replace around view monitor control unit. Refer to AV-629, "Removal and Installation".
NO >> Replace rear camera. Refer to AV-631, "Removal and Installation".
WITHOUT AROUND VIEW MONITOR
1.CHECK CAMERA POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT CONTINUITY
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect AV control unit connector M164 and rear view camera connector.
3. Check continuity between AV control unit connector M164 and rear view camera connector D504.
Around view monitor control unit Rear camera
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
M96
28
D511
5
Yes
27 1
Around view monitor control unit
Ground Continuity
Connector Terminal
M96 28 No
Around view monitor control unit connector M96
Condition Reference value (+) ()
Terminal Terminal
28 27
CAMERA switch is ON or shift
position is R.
JSNIA0834GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
REAR CAMERA IMAGE SIGNAL CIRCUIT
AV-591
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
4. Check continuity between AV control unit connector M164 and ground.
Is inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 2.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
2.CHECK CAMERA GROUND CIRCUIT CONTINUITY
Check continuity between AV control unit connector M164 and rear view camera connector D504.
Is inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 3.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
3.CHECK CAMERA POWER SUPPLY VOLTAGE
1. Connect AV control unit connector M164 and rear view camera connector.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Shift the selector lever to R.
4. Check voltage between AV control unit connector M164 and ground.
Is inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 4.
NO >> Replace AV control unit. Refer to AV-611, "Removal and Installation".
4.CHECK CAMERA IMAGE SIGNAL CIRCUIT CONTINUITY
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect display unit connector M92 and rear view camera connector.
3. Check continuity between display unit connector M92 and rear view camera connector D504.
4. Check continuity between display unit connector M92 and ground.
Is inspection result normal?
AV control unit Rear view camera
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
M164 83 D504 1 Yes
AV control unit
Ground
Continuity
Connector Terminal
M164 83 No
AV control unit Rear view camera
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
M164 84 D504 2 Yes
AV control unit Ground
Condition
Voltage
(Approx.)
(+)
()
Connector Terminal
M164 83 Selector lever is in R. 6.0 V
Display unit Rear view camera
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
M92 8 D504 3 Yes
Display unit
Ground
Continuity
Connector Terminal
M92 8 No
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-592
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
REAR CAMERA IMAGE SIGNAL CIRCUIT
YES >> GO TO 5.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
5.CHECK CAMERA IMAGE SIGNAL
1. Connect display unit connector M92 and rear view camera connector.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Shift the selector lever to R.
4. Check signal between display unit connector M92 and ground.
Is inspection result normal?
YES >> Replace display unit. Refer to AV-615, "Removal and Installation".
NO >> Replace rear view camera. Refer to AV-631, "Removal and Installation".
Display unit Ground
Condition Reference value (+)
()
Connector Terminal
M92 8
Camera image dis-
played.
SKIB2251J
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
SIDE CAMERA LH IMAGE SIGNAL CIRCUIT
AV-593
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
SIDE CAMERA LH IMAGE SIGNAL CIRCUIT
Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174789
Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-442, "Wiring Diagram".
1.CHECK LH SIDE CAMERA IMAGE SIGNAL CIRCUIT CONTINUITY
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect around view monitor control unit connector M96 and LH side camera connector D20.
3. Check continuity between around view monitor control unit connector M96 and LH side camera connector
D20.
4. Check continuity between around view monitor control unit connector M96 and ground.
Is inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 2.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
2.CHECK LH SIDE CAMERA IMAGE SIGNAL
1. Connect around view monitor control unit connector M96 and LH side camera connector D20.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check the signal between the terminals of around view monitor control unit connector M96.
Is inspection result normal?
YES >> Replace around view monitor control unit. Refer to AV-629, "Removal and Installation".
NO >> Replace LH side camera. Refer to AV-632, "Removal and Installation".
Around view monitor control unit LH side camera
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
M96
32
D20
5
Yes
31 17
Around view monitor control unit
Ground Continuity
Connector Terminal
M96 32 No
Around view monitor control unit connector M96
Condition Reference value (+) ()
Terminal Terminal
32 31
CAMERA switch is ON or shift
position is R.
JSNIA0834GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-594
< DTC/CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
SIDE CAMERA RH IMAGE SIGNAL CIRCUIT
SIDE CAMERA RH IMAGE SIGNAL CIRCUIT
Diagnosis Procedure INFOID:0000000009174790
Regarding Wiring Diagram information, refer to AV-442, "Wiring Diagram".
1.CHECK RH SIDE CAMERA IMAGE SIGNAL CIRCUIT CONTINUITY
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect around view monitor control unit connector M96 and RH side camera connector D113.
3. Check continuity between around view monitor control unit connector M96 and fRH side camera connec-
tor D113.
4. Check continuity between around view monitor control unit connector M96 and ground.
Is inspection result normal?
YES >> GO TO 2.
NO >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
2.CHECK RH SIDE CAMERA IMAGE SIGNAL
1. Connect around view monitor control unit connector M96 and RH side camera connector D113.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check the signal between the terminals of around view monitor control unit connector M96.
Is inspection result normal?
YES >> Replace around view monitor control unit. Refer to AV-629, "Removal and Installation".
NO >> Replace RH side camera. Refer to AV-632, "Removal and Installation".
Around view monitor control unit RH side camera
Continuity
Connector Terminal Connector Terminal
M96
36
D113
5
Yes
35 17
Around view monitor control unit
Ground Continuity
Connector Terminal
M96 36 No
Around view monitor control unit onnector M96
Condition Reference value (+) ()
Terminal Terminal
36 35
CAMERA switch is ON or shift
position is R.
JSNIA0834GB
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
MULTI AV SYSTEM
AV-595
< SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS
MULTI AV SYSTEM
Symptom Table INFOID:0000000009174791
RELATED TO AUDIO
Symptoms Check items Probable malfunction location
The disk cannot be removed. AV control unit
Malfunction in AV control unit.
Refer to AV-403, "On Board Diagnosis Function".
No sound comes out or the level of
the sound is low.
No sound from all speakers.
Speaker circuit shorted to ground.
Refer to AV-442, "Wiring Diagram".
Bose amp. ON signal circuit malfunction.
Refer to AV-532, "Diagnosis Procedure".
Bose speaker amp. power supply and ground cir-
cuits malfunction.
Refer to AV-532, "Diagnosis Procedure".
Only a certain speaker (front door
speaker LH, front door speaker RH, front
tweeter LH, front tweeter RH, instrument
panel tweeter LH, instrument panel
tweeter RH, center speaker, rear door
speaker LH, rear door speaker RH, rear
side speaker LH, rear side speaker RH,
subwoofer) does not output sound.
Poor connector connection of speaker.
Sound signal circuit malfunction between AV con-
trol unit and Bose speaker amp.
Refer to:
- AV-564, "Diagnosis Procedure" (front door speak-
er).
- AV-561, "Diagnosis Procedure" (front tweeter).
- AV-558, "Diagnosis Procedure" (instrument panel
tweeter).
- AV-556, "Diagnosis Procedure" (center speaker).
- AV-567, "Diagnosis Procedure" (rear door speak-
er).
- AV-570, "Diagnosis Procedure" (rear side speaker).
- AV-573, "Diagnosis Procedure" (subwoofer).
Sound signal circuit malfunction between Bose
speaker amp. and speaker.
Refer to:
- AV-564, "Diagnosis Procedure" (front door speak-
er).
- AV-561, "Diagnosis Procedure" (front tweeter).
- AV-558, "Diagnosis Procedure" (instrument panel
tweeter).
- AV-556, "Diagnosis Procedure" (center speaker).
- AV-567, "Diagnosis Procedure" (rear door speak-
er).
- AV-570, "Diagnosis Procedure" (rear side speaker).
- AV-573, "Diagnosis Procedure" (subwoofer).
Malfunction in speaker.
Refer to:
- AV-619, "Removal and Installation" (front door
speaker).
- AV-620, "Removal and Installation" (front tweeter).
- AV-621, "Removal and Installation" (instrument
panel tweeter).
- AV-622, "Removal and Installation" (center speak-
er).
- AV-623, "Removal and Installation" (rear door
speaker).
- AV-624, "Removal and Installation" (rear side
speaker).
- AV-625, "Removal and Installation" (subwoofer).
Malfunction in AV control unit.
Refer to AV-403, "On Board Diagnosis Function".
Malfunction in Bose speaker amp.
Replace Bose speaker amp. Refer to AV-618, "Re-
moval and Installation".
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-596
< SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
MULTI AV SYSTEM
Noise is mixed with audio.
Noise comes out from all speakers.
Malfunction in AV control unit.
Refer to AV-403, "On Board Diagnosis Function".
Malfunction in Bose speaker amp.
Replace Bose speaker amp. Refer to AV-618, "Re-
moval and Installation".
Noise comes out only from a certain
speaker (front door speaker LH, front
door speaker RH, front tweeter LH, front
tweeter RH, instrument panel tweeter
LH, instrument panel tweeter RH, center
speaker, rear door speaker LH, rear door
speaker RH, rear side speaker LH, rear
side speaker RH, subwoofer).
Poor connector connection of speaker.
Sound signal circuit malfunction between AV con-
trol unit and Bose speaker amp.
Refer to:
- AV-564, "Diagnosis Procedure" (front door speak-
er).
- AV-561, "Diagnosis Procedure" (front tweeter).
- AV-558, "Diagnosis Procedure" (instrument panel
tweeter).
- AV-556, "Diagnosis Procedure" (center speaker).
- AV-567, "Diagnosis Procedure" (rear door speak-
er).
- AV-570, "Diagnosis Procedure" (rear side speaker).
- AV-573, "Diagnosis Procedure" (subwoofer).
Sound signal circuit malfunction between Bose
speaker amp. and speaker.
Refer to:
- AV-564, "Diagnosis Procedure" (front door speak-
er).
- AV-561, "Diagnosis Procedure" (front tweeter).
- AV-558, "Diagnosis Procedure" (instrument panel
tweeter).
- AV-556, "Diagnosis Procedure" (center speaker).
- AV-567, "Diagnosis Procedure" (rear door speak-
er).
- AV-570, "Diagnosis Procedure" (rear side speaker).
- AV-573, "Diagnosis Procedure" (subwoofer).
Malfunction in speaker.
Poor Installation of speaker (e.g. backlash and
looseness).
Refer to:
- AV-619, "Removal and Installation" (front door
speaker).
- AV-620, "Removal and Installation" (front tweeter).
- AV-621, "Removal and Installation" (instrument
panel tweeter).
- AV-622, "Removal and Installation" (center speak-
er).
- AV-623, "Removal and Installation" (rear door
speaker).
- AV-624, "Removal and Installation" (rear side
speaker).
- AV-625, "Removal and Installation" (subwoofer).
Malfunction in AV control unit.
Refer to AV-403, "On Board Diagnosis Function".
Malfunction in Bose speaker amp.
Replace Bose speaker amp. Refer to AV-618, "Re-
moval and Installation".
Noise is mixed with radio only (when the
vehicle hits a bump or while driving over
bad roads)
Poor connector connection of antenna or antenna
feeder.
Refer to AV-635, "Location of Antennas".
No radio reception or poor recep-
tion.
Other audio sounds are normal.
Any radio station cannot be received
or poor reception is caused even after
moving to a service area with good re-
ception (e.g. a place with clear view
and no obstacles generating external
noises).
Antenna amp. ON signal circuit malfunction.
Refer to AV-531, "Diagnosis Procedure".
Poor connector connection of antenna or antenna
feeder.
Refer to AV-635, "Location of Antennas".
Symptoms Check items Probable malfunction location
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
MULTI AV SYSTEM
AV-597
< SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
RELATED TO HANDS-FREE PHONE
RELATED TO NAVIGATION
No satellite radio reception.
There is malfunction in the CONSULT
self diagnosis result.
Refer to AV-413, "CONSULT Function".
Malfunction in antenna, antenna feeder or AV con-
trol unit. Perform DTC diagnosis.
Refer to AV-413, "CONSULT Function".
Poor continuity in antenna feeder.
Poor connector connection of antenna or antenna
feeder.
Refer to AV-635, "Location of Antennas".
There is no malfunction in the CONSULT
self diagnosis result.
Refer to AV-413, "CONSULT Function".
Poor continuity in antenna feeder.
Poor connector connection of antenna or antenna
feeder.
Loose satellite radio antenna mounting nut.
Refer to AV-635, "Location of Antennas".
Buzz/rattle sound from speaker
The majority of buzz/rattle sounds are
not indicative of an issue with the speak-
er, usually something nearby the speak-
er is causing the buzz/rattle.
Refer to "SQUEAK AND RATTLE TROUBLE DIAG-
NOSIS" in the appropriate interior trim section.
Symptoms Check items Probable malfunction location
Symptoms Check items Probable malfunction location
Does not recognize cellular phone
connection (no connection is dis-
played on the display at the guide).
Repeat the registration of cellular phone.
Malfunction in AV control unit.
Replace AV control unit. Refer to AV-611, "Removal
and Installation".
Hands-free phone cannot be estab-
lished.
Hands-free phone operation can be
made, but the communication cannot
be established.
Hands-free phone operation can be
performed, however, voice between
each other cannot be heard during the
conversation.
The other partys voice cannot be
heard by hands-free phone.
Check the microphone speaker in In-
spection & Adjustment Mode if sound is
heard.
Originating sound is not heard by
the other party with hands-free
phone communication.
Sound operation function is normal.
Sound operation function does not work.
Microphone signal circuit malfunction.
Refer to AV-584, "Diagnosis Procedure".
The system cannot be operated.
The voice recognition can be con-
trolled.
Steering switchs , , and
switch works, but does not
work.
Steering switch malfunction.
Replace steering switch. Refer to AV-614, "Removal
and Installation".
Steering switchs , , , and
switches do not work.
Steering switch signal circuit malfunction.
Refer to AV-586, "Diagnosis Procedure".
All steering switches do not work.
Steering switch ground circuit malfunction.
Refer to AV-586, "Diagnosis Procedure".
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-598
< SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
MULTI AV SYSTEM
RELATED TO AROUND VIEW MONITOR
Symptoms Check items Probable malfunction location
Navigation system is inoperative.
Navigation malfunction.
Malfunction in hard disk drive (HDD).
Malfunction in AV control unit.
Refer to AV-403, "On Board Diagnosis Function".
Steering switches malfunction.
Steering switch signal circuit malfunction.
Refer to AV-586, "Diagnosis Procedure".
Voice activated control malfunction.
Microphone signal circuit malfunction.
Refer to AV-584, "Diagnosis Procedure".
Steering switch signal circuit malfunction.
Refer to AV-586, "Diagnosis Procedure".
Symptoms Check items Probable malfunction location
Display does not switch to camera
image when CAMERA switch is
pressed or selector lever is in R (re-
verse).
Around view monitor control unit mal-
function.
Around view monitor control unit power supply and
ground circuits malfunction.
Refer to AV-554, "AROUND VIEW MONITOR CON-
TROL UNIT : Diagnosis Procedure".
AV communication circuits malfunction.
AV communication circuits malfunction between
around view monitor control unit and AV control unit.
Refer to AV-439, "Reference Value".
Camera image signal circuit (output)
malfunction.
Camera image signal circuit (output) malfunction be-
tween around view monitor control unit and display
unit.
Refer to AV-439, "Reference Value".
Display switches to camera image
when CAMERA switch is pressed
or selector lever is in R (reverse),
but all views are not displayed.
Camera image signal circuit (input) mal-
function.
Camera image signal circuit (input) malfunction be-
tween camera and around view monitor control unit.
Refer to:
AV-589, "Diagnosis Procedure" (front camera).
AV-590, "Diagnosis Procedure" (rear camera).
AV-593, "Diagnosis Procedure" (side camera LH).
AV-594, "Diagnosis Procedure" (side camera RH).
Camera communication signal circuits
malfunction.
Camera communication circuits malfunction between
camera and around view monitor control unit.
Refer to:
AV-589, "Diagnosis Procedure" (front camera).
AV-590, "Diagnosis Procedure" (rear camera).
AV-593, "Diagnosis Procedure" (side camera LH).
AV-594, "Diagnosis Procedure" (side camera RH).
Camera image is rolling.
Camera image signal circuit (output)
malfunction.
Camera image signal circuit (output) malfunction be-
tween around view monitor control unit and display
unit.
Refer to AV-439, "Reference Value".
Display does not switch to rear view
monitor even when selector lever is
in R (reverse).
Reverse signal circuit malfunction.
Reverse signal circuit between BCM and around view
monitor control unit.
Refer to AV-439, "Reference Value".
Predicted course line display in front
view and rear view is malfunction-
ing.
Steering angle sensor malfunction.
Predicted course line center position is malfunction-
ing.
Refer to AV-493, "PREDICTED COURSE LINE CEN-
TER POSITION ADJUSTMENT : Work Procedure".
Front view and front of birds-eye
view is not displayed.
Front camera malfunction.
Front camera power supply and ground circuits mal-
function.
Refer to AV-554, "AROUND VIEW MONITOR CON-
TROL UNIT : Diagnosis Procedure".
Front camera image signal circuit mal-
function.
Front camera image signal circuit malfunction be-
tween front camera and around view monitor control
unit.
Refer to AV-589, "Diagnosis Procedure".
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
MULTI AV SYSTEM
AV-599
< SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
RELATED TO REAR DISPLAY (HEADREST-MOUNTED)
Perform diagnosis of the Power supply and ground circuit before starting diagnosis by symptom. Refer to AV-
554, "HEADREST DISPLAY UNIT : Diagnosis Procedure".
Rear view and rear of birds-eye
view is not displayed.
Rear camera malfunction.
Rear camera power supply and ground circuits mal-
function.
Refer to AV-554, "AROUND VIEW MONITOR CON-
TROL UNIT : Diagnosis Procedure".
Rear camera image signal circuit mal-
function.
Rear camera image signal circuit malfunction be-
tween rear camera and around view monitor control
unit.
Refer to AV-590, "Diagnosis Procedure".
Front-side and driver side of birds-
eye view is not displayed.
Side camera LH malfunction.
Side camera LH power supply and ground circuits
malfunction.
Refer to AV-554, "AROUND VIEW MONITOR CON-
TROL UNIT : Diagnosis Procedure".
Side camera LH image signal circuit
malfunction.
Side camera LH image signal circuit malfunction be-
tween side camera LH and around view monitor con-
trol unit.
Refer to AV-593, "Diagnosis Procedure".
Front-side and passenger side of
birds-eye view is not displayed.
Side camera RH malfunction.
Side camera RH power supply and ground circuits
malfunction.
Refer to AV-534, "Diagnosis Procedure".
Side camera RH image signal circuit
malfunction.
Side camera RH image signal circuit malfunction be-
tween side camera RH and around view monitor con-
trol unit.
Refer to AV-594, "Diagnosis Procedure".
Selector lever is in a position other
than R (reverse) and front, rear,
front-side and Birds-Eye views are
displayed even as vehicle speed in-
creases.
Vehicle speed signal malfunction.
Vehicle speed signal malfunction between ABS actu-
ator and electric unit (control unit) and around view
monitor control unit.
Refer to LAN-20, "Trouble Diagnosis Flow Chart".
Symptoms Check items Probable malfunction location
Symptom Check item Possible malfunction location/Action to take
Video is not shown on the
headrest display unit
screen.
Use the touch button in
front display to switch vid-
eo images on the head-
rest display unit.
Video is shown.
Operate with the remote to see if videos can be
switched.
Video is not shown.
Replace headrest display unit.
Refer to AV-616, "Removal and Installation".
Headrest display unit in-
operative with the re-
mote.
All keys inoperative.
Check battery polarity.
Replace battery.
Check with a remote from the same vehicle fam-
ily.
Check infrared* of the luminescent part (LED) of
the remote.
Some keys inoperative.
Check with a remote
from the same vehicle
family.
Check infrared* of the
luminescent part (LED)
of the remote.
The function corresponding to the remote operation
is not included (this is not a malfunction).
Headrest display unit
screen is black.
Play a DVD.
Video is not shown.
Switch from AUX mode to DVD mode and check
video.
Screen is dark.
Adjust screen for image quality (this is not a mal-
function).
Screen is black.
Replace headrest display unit.
Refer to AV-616, "Removal and Installation".
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-600
< SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
MULTI AV SYSTEM
*: To check infrared, check light of the luminescent part (LED)
through the lens of digital camera when operating the remote.
RELATED TO HEADPHONES (HEADREST-MOUNTED)
Video shown on headrest
display unit screen be-
comes distorted or rolls
up/down
Adjust the color settings using the display screen
menu items.
If the symptom does not change, replace headrest
display unit.
Refer to AV-616, "Removal and Installation".
Headrest display unit
screen is blue.
wire-
less connection, the battery power of the cellular phone may dis-
charge quicker than usual. The Bluetooth
Hands-Free Phone
System cannot charge cellular phones.
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-602
< SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
NORMAL OPERATING CONDITION
RELATED TO NAVIGATION
Basic Operation
Vehicle Mark
The other partys voice cannot be heard by hands-free phone.
When the radio wave condition is not ideal or ambient sound is too
loud, it may be difficult to hear the other persons voice during a
call.
Poor sound quality.
Do not place the cellular phone in an area surrounded by metal or
far away from the in-vehicle phone module to prevent tone quality
degradation and wireless connection disruption.
Symptom Cause and Counter measure
Symptom Cause Remedy
No image is shown. Display brightness adjustment is set fully to DARK
side.
Adjust the display brightness.
No guide sound is heard.
Audio guide volume is too low or
too high.
Volume control is set to OFF, MIN or MAX. Adjust the audio guide volume.
Audio guidance is not available while the vehicle is
driving on a dark pink route.
System is not malfunctioning.
Screen is too dark.
Motion of the image is too slow.
Temperature inside the vehicle is low. Wait until the temperature inside the vehicle
reaches the proper temperature.
Small black or bright spots appear
on the screen.
Symptom peculiar to a liquid crystal display (dis-
play unit).
System is not malfunction.
Symptom Cause Remedy
Map screen and BIRDVIEW
Name of the place vary with the
screen.
Some thinning of the character data is done to pre-
vent the display becoming to complex. In some
cases and in some locations, the display contents
may differ.
The same place name, street name, etc. may not
be displayed every time on account of the data
processing.
System is not malfunctioning.
Vehicle mark is not positioned cor-
rectly.
Vehicle is transferred by ferry or by towing after its
ignition switch is turned to OFF.
Drive the vehicle for a while in the GPS sat-
ellite signal receiving condition.
Screen will not switch to nighttime
mode after the lighting switch is
turned ON.
The daytime screen is selected by the SWITCH
SCREENS when the last time the screen dim-
ming setting is done.
Switching between daytime/nighttime screen may
be inhibited by the automatic illumination adjust-
ment function.
Perform screen dimming and select the
nighttime screen by SWITCH SCREENS.
Map screen will not scroll in accor-
dance with the vehicle travel.
Current location is not displayed. Press MAP button to display the current lo-
cation.
Vehicle mark will not be shown. Current location is not displayed. Press MAP button to display the current lo-
cation.
Accuracy indicator (GPS satellite
mark) on the map screen stays
gray.
GPS satellite signal is intercepted because the ve-
hicle is in or behind a building.
Move the vehicle out to an open space.
GPS satellite signal cannot be received because
an obstacle is placed on top of the instrument pan-
el.
Do not place anything on top of the meter dis-
play (instrument panel).
GPS satellites are not visible from current location. Wait until GPS satellites are visible by mov-
ing the vehicle.
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
NORMAL OPERATING CONDITION
AV-603
< SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
Destination, Passing Points and Menu Items Cannot be Selected/Set
Voice Guide
Vehicle location accuracy is low. Accuracy indicator (GPS satellite mark) on the
map screen stays gray.
Current location is not determined.
Vehicle speed setting by the vehicle speed pulse
has been deviated (advanced or retarded) from
the actual vehicle speed because tire chain is fit-
ted or the system has been used on another vehi-
cle.
Drive the vehicle for a while [for approx. 30
minutes at approx. 30 km/h (19 MPH)] and
the deviation will be automatically adjusted. If
advancement or retard still occur, perform
the distance adjustment by CONFIRMA-
TION/ADJUSTMENT mode of diagnosis
function.
Map data has error or omission. (Vehicle mark is
always deviated to the same position.)
As a rule, an updated map DVDROM will be
released once a year.
Symptom Cause Remedy
Symptom Cause Remedy
Destination cannot be set. Destination to be set is on an expressway. Set the destination on an ordinary road.
Passing point is not searched
when re-searching the route.
The vehicle has already passed the passing point,
or the system judged so.
To include the passing points that have been
passed into the route again, set the route
again.
Route information will not be dis-
played.
Route searching has not been done. Set the destination and perform route
searching.
Vehicle mark is not on the recommended route. Drive on the recommended route.
Route guide is turned OFF. Turn route guide ON.
Route information is not available on the dark pink
route.
System is not malfunctioning.
After the route searching, no guide
sign will appear as the vehicle
goes near the entrance/exit to the
toll road.
Vehicle mark is not on the recommended route.
(On the display, only guide signs related to the rec-
ommended route will be shown.)
Drive on the recommended route.
Automatic route searching is not
possible.
Vehicle is driving on a highway (gray route), or no
recommended route is available.
Drive on a road to be searched. Or research
the route manually. In this case, however, the
whole route will be searched.
Performed automatic detour
search (or detour search). Howev-
er, the result is the same as that of
the previous search.
Performed search with every conditions consid-
ered. However, the result is the same as that of the
previous search.
System is not malfunctioning.
Passing points cannot be set. More than five passing points were set. Passing points can be set up to five. To stop
at more than five points, perform sharing in
several steps.
When setting the route, the starting
point cannot be selected.
The current vehicle location is always set as the
starting point of a route.
System is not malfunctioning.
Some menu items cannot be se-
lected.
The vehicle is being driven. Stop the vehicle at a safe place and then op-
erate the system.
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-604
< SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
NORMAL OPERATING CONDITION
Route Search
NOTE:
Except for the ordinance-designated cities. (Malfunctioning areas may be changed in the updated map disc.)
Examples of Current-Location Mark Displacement
Symptom Cause Remedy
Voice guide will not operate. Note: Voice guide is only available at intersections
that satisfy certain conditions (indicated by on
the map). Therefore, guidance may not be given
even when the route on the map changes direction.
System is not malfunctioning.
The vehicle is not on the recommended route. Return to the recommended route or re-
search the route.
Voice guide is turned OFF. Turn voice guide ON.
Route guide is turned OFF. Turn route guide ON.
Voice guide does not match the ac-
tual road pattern.
Voice guide may vary with the direction to which
the vehicle is turn and the connection of the road to
other roads.
Drive in conformity to the actual traffic rules.
Symptom Cause Remedy
No route is shown. No road to be searched is found around the des-
tination.
Find wider road (orange road or wider) near-
by and reset the destination and passing
points onto it. Take care of the traveling direc-
tion when there are separate up and down
roads.
Starting point and the destination are too close. Set the destination at more distant point.
Conditional traffic regulation (day of the week/
time of the day) is set at the area around the cur-
rent location or the destination.
Turn the time-regulating search conditions
OFF. Turn Avoid regulation time in the
search conditions OFF.
Indicated route is intermittent. In some areas, highways (gray routes) are not
used for the search
(Note)
Therefore, the route to
the current location or the passing points may be
intermittent.
System is not malfunctioning.
When the vehicle has passed the
recommended route, it is deleted
from the screen.
A recommended route is controlled by each sec-
tion. When the vehicle has passed the passing
point 1, then the map data from the starting point
up to the passing point 1 will be deleted. (The data
may remain undeleted in some area.)
System is not malfunctioning.
Detouring route is recommended. In some areas, highways (gray routes) are not
used for the search. (Note). Therefore, detour
route may be recommended.
Set the route closer to the basic route (gray
route).
A detour route may be shown when some traffic
regulation (one-way traffic, etc.) is set at the area
around the starting point or the destination.
Slightly move the starting point or the destina-
tion, or set the passing point on the route of
your choice.
In the area where highways (gray routes) are
used for the search, left turn has priority around
the current location and the destination (passing
points). For this reason, the recommended route
may be detouring.
System is not malfunctioning.
Landmarks on the map do not
match the actual ones.
This can be happen due to omission or error in
the map data.
As a rule, an updated map DVD-ROM will be
released once a year. Wait until the latest
map has become available.
Recommended route is far from
the starting point, passing points,
and destination.
Starting point, passing points, and destination of
the route guide were set far from the desired
points because route searching data around
these area were not stored.
Reset the destination onto the road nearby. If
this road is one of the highways (gray routes),
an ordinary road nearby may be displayed as
the recommended route.
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
NORMAL OPERATING CONDITION
AV-605
< SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
Vehicle's travel amount is calculated by reading its travel distance and turning angle. Therefore, if the vehicle
is driven in the following manner, an error will occur in the vehicle's current location display. If correct location
has not been restored after driving the vehicle for a while, perform location correction.
SEL698V
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-606
< SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
NORMAL OPERATING CONDITION
Cause (condition) : While driving ooo: Display Driving condition Remarks (correction, etc.)
Road config-
uration
Yintersections
At a Y intersection or similar gradual divi-
sion of roads, an error in the direction of
travel deduced by the sensor may result in
the current-location mark appearing on the
wrong road.
If after travelling about 10 km (6
miles) the correct location has
not been restored, perform lo-
cation correction and, if neces-
sary, direction correction.
Spiral roads
When driving on a large, continuous spiral
road (such as loop bridge), turning angle
error is accumulated and the vehicle mark
may deviate from the correct location.
Straight roads
When driving on a long, straight road and
slow curve without stopping, map-matching
does not work effectively enough and dis-
tance errors may accumulate. As a result,
the vehicle mark may deviate from the cor-
rect location when the vehicle is turned at a
corner.
Zigzag roads
When driving on a zigzag road, the map
may be matched to other roads in the simi-
lar direction nearby at every turn, and the
vehicle mark may deviate from the correct
location.
Roads laid out in a grid pattern
When driving where roads are laid out in a
grid pattern, or where many roads are run-
ning in the similar direction nearby, the map
may be matched to them by mistake and
the vehicle mark may deviate from the cor-
rect location.
Parallel roads
When two roads are running in parallel
(such as highway and sideway), the map
may be matched to the other road by mis-
take and the vehicle mark may deviate from
the correct location.
ELK0192D
ELK0193D
ELK0194D
ELK0195D
ELK0196D
ELK0197D
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
NORMAL OPERATING CONDITION
AV-607
< SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
Place
In a parking lot When driving in a parking lot, or other loca-
tion where there are no roads on the map,
matching may place the vehicle mark on a
nearby road. When the vehicle returns to
the road, the vehicle mark may have devi-
ated from the correct location.
When driving in circle or turning the steer-
ing wheel repeatedly, direction errors accu-
mulate, and the vehicle mark may deviate
from the correct location.
If after travelling about 10 km (6
miles) the correct location has
not been restored, perform lo-
cation correction and, if neces-
sary, direction correction.
Turntable
When the ignition switch is OFF, the navi-
gation system cannot get the signal from
the gyroscope (angular speed sensor).
Therefore, the displayed direction may be
wrong and the correct road may not be eas-
ily returned to after rotating the vehicle on a
turntable with the ignition OFF.
Slippery roads On snow, wet roads, gravel, or other roads
where tires may slip easily, accumulated
mileage errors may cause the vehicle mark
to deviate from the correct road.
Slopes When parking in sloped garages, when
travelling on banked roads, or in other cas-
es where the vehicle turns when tilted, an
error in the turning angle will occur, and the
vehicle mark may deviate from the road.
Map data
Road not displayed on the map screen
When driving on new roads or other roads
not displayed on the map screen, map
matching does not function correctly and
matches the location to a nearby road.
When the vehicle returns to a road which is
on the map, the vehicle mark may deviate
from the correct road.
Different road pattern
(Changed due to repair)
If the road pattern stored in the map data
and the actual road pattern are different,
map matching does not function correctly
and matches the location to a nearby road.
The vehicle mark may deviate from the cor-
rect road.
Vehicle Use of tire chains
When tire chains are used, the mileage is
not correctly detected, and the vehicle mark
may deviate from the correct road.
Drive the vehicle for a while. If
the distance still deviates, ad-
just it by using the distance ad-
justment function. (If the tire
chain is removed, recover the
original value.)
Cause (condition) : While driving ooo: Display Driving condition Remarks (correction, etc.)
SEL709V
SEL710V
SEL699V
ELK0201D
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-608
< SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
NORMAL OPERATING CONDITION
Location Correction by Map-Matching is Slow
The map-matching function needs to refer to the data of the surrounding area. It is necessary to drive some
distance for the function to work.
Because map-matching operates on this principle, when there are many roads running in similar directions
in the surrounding area, no matching determination may be made. The location may not be corrected until
some special feature is found.
Name of Road is Not Displayed
The current road name may not be displayed if there are no road names displayed on the map screen.
Contents of Display Differ for Birdview and the (Flat) Map Screen
Difference of the BIRDVIEW screen from the flat map screen are as follows.
The current place name displays names which are primarily in the direction of vehicle travel.
The amount of time before the vehicle travel or turn angle is updated on the screen is longer than for the
(flat) map display.
The conditions for display of place names, roads, and other data are different for nearby areas and for more
distant areas.
Some thinning of the character data is done to prevent the display becoming too complex. In some cases
and in some locations, the display contents may differ.
The same place name, street name, etc. may be displayed multiple times.
Vehicle Mark Shows a Position Which is Completely Wrong
In the following cases, the vehicle mark may appear on completely different position in the map depending on
the GPS satellite signal receiving conditions. In this case, perform location correction and direction correction.
When location correction has not been done
- If the receiving conditions of the GPS satellite signal is poor, if the vehicle mark becomes out of place, it may
move to a completely different location and not come back if location correction is not done. The position will
be corrected if the GPS signal can be received.
When the vehicle has traveled by ferry, or when the vehicle has been being towed
Precautions
for driving
Just after the engine is started
If the vehicle is driven just after the engine
is started when the gyroscope (angular
speed sensor) correction is not completed,
the vehicle can lose its direction and may
have deviated from the correct location.
Wait for a short while before
driving after starting the engine.
Continuous driving without stopping When driving long distances without stop-
ping, direction errors may accumulate, and
the current-location mark may deviate from
the correct road.
Stop and adjust the orientation.
Abusive driving Spinning the wheels or engaging in other
kinds of abusive driving may result in the
system being unable perform correct detec-
tion, and may cause the vehicle mark to de-
viate from the correct road.
If after travelling about 10 km (6
miles) the correct location has
not been restored, perform lo-
cation correction and, if neces-
sary, direction correction.
How to cor-
rect location
Position correction accuracy
If the accuracy of location settings is poor,
accuracy may be reduced when the correct
road cannot be found, particularly in places
where there are many roads.
Enter in the road displayed on
the screen with an accuracy of
approx. 1mm.
Caution: Whenever possible,
use detailed map for the correc-
tion.
Direction when location is corrected
If the accuracy of location settings during
correction is poor, accuracy may be re-
duced afterwards.
Perform direction correction.
Cause (condition) : While driving ooo: Display Driving condition Remarks (correction, etc.)
SEL701V
SEL702V
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
NORMAL OPERATING CONDITION
AV-609
< SYMPTOM DIAGNOSIS >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
- Because calculation of the current location cannot be done when traveling with the ignition off, for example
when traveling by ferry or when being towed, the location before travel is displayed. If the precise location
can be detected with GPS, the location will be corrected.
Vehicle Mark Jumps
In the following cases, the vehicle mark may appear to jump as a result of automatic correction of the current
location.
When map matching has been done
- If the current location and the vehicle mark are different when map matching is done, the vehicle mark may
seem to jump. At this time, the location may be corrected to the wrong road or to a location which is not on
a road.
When GPS location correction has been done
- If the current location and the vehicle mark are different when the location is corrected using GPS measure-
ments, the vehicle mark may seem to jump. At this time, the location may be corrected to a location which
is not on a road.
Vehicle Mark is in a River or Sea
The navigation system moves the vehicle mark with no distinction between land and rivers or sea. If the vehi-
cle mark is somehow out of place, it may appear that the vehicle is driving in a river or the sea.
Vehicle Mark Automatically Rotates
The system wrongly memorizes the rotating status as stopping when the ignition switch is turned ON with the
turntable rotating. That causes the vehicle mark to rotate when the vehicle is stopped.
When Driving on Same Road, Sometimes Vehicle Mark is in Right Place and Sometimes it is in Wrong Place
The conditions of the GPS antenna (GPS data) and gyroscope (angular speed sensor) change gradually.
Depending on the road traveled and the operation of the steering wheel, the location detection results will be
different. Therefore, even on a road on which the location has never been wrong, conditions may cause the
vehicle mark to deviate.
RELATED TO SONAR
Symptom Possible cause
Unstable object detection
The vehicle is on a rough surface, such as stone or gravel.
When used in poor weather conditions, such as heavy snow/rain strong wind.
When subjected to an ultrasonic noise generated from exhaust muffler or brakes.
When left standing in the hot sun or in a cold climate.
When the surface of the sensor is frozen or covered with snow/dirt/moisture.
When a retrofitted xenon lamp, lighted license plate, or harness is close to the sensor body or sen-
sor harness.
When subjected to loop coil noises generated from a vehicle detector placed at an intersection or
coin parking area.
Object undetectable
Air-containing objects, such as cloth, cotton, glass wool, dust, and snow.
Thin objects, such as rope, chain and wire.
Smooth-faced objects placed in a slanting direction.
Fast-moving small animals.
A corner of an angular object.
NOTE:
If the sensor detection part is scratched, obstacles cannot be detected.
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-610
< REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
AV CONTROL UNIT
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
AV CONTROL UNIT
Exploded View INFOID:0000000009763218
Removal and Installation INFOID:0000000009763217
REMOVAL
CAUTION:
Remove battery terminal and AV control unit after a lapse of 30 seconds or more after turning the
ignition switch OFF.
Before replacing AV control unit, perform "READ CONFIGURATION" to save current vehicle specifi-
cation. Refer to AV-491, "CONFIGURATION (AV CONTROL UNIT) : Configuration List".
NOTE:
After the ignition switch is turned OFF, the AV control unit continues operating for approximately 30 seconds.
Therefore, data corruption may occur if battery voltage is cut off within 30 seconds.
1. Disconnect the negative battery terminal. Refer to PG-90, "Removal and Installation".
2. Remove cluster lid C. Refer to IP-22, "CLUSTER LID C : Removal and Installation".
3. Remove the screws, then pull out the AV control unit.
4. Disconnect the harness connectors from the AV control unit and remove.
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
CAUTION:
1. AV control unit bracket (LH) 2. A/C auto amp. 3. AV control unit
4. AV control unit bracket (RH)
ALNIA1436ZZ
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
AV CONTROL UNIT
AV-611
< REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
When replacing AV control unit, perform "WRITE CONFIGURATION". Refer to AV-491, "CONFIGURA-
TION (AV CONTROL UNIT) : Configuration List".
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-612
< REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
A/C AND AV SWITCH ASSEMBLY
A/C AND AV SWITCH ASSEMBLY
Removal and Installation INFOID:0000000009763219
REMOVAL
1. Remove cluster lid C lower. Refer to IP-22, "CLUSTER LID C LOWER : Removal and Installation".
2. Remove the A/C and AV switch assembly lower screws.
3. Release upper pawls and remove A/C and AV switch assembly.
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
STEERING SWITCH
AV-613
< REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
STEERING SWITCH
Exploded View INFOID:0000000009174796
Removal and Installation INFOID:0000000009174797
REMOVAL
NOTE:
The steering switches are serviced as an assembly.
1. Remove steering wheel. Refer to ST-44, "Removal and Installation".
2. Release pawls and remove steering wheel rear finisher (1) from
steering wheel (2).
3. Remove steering switches screws.
4. Remove steering switches (1) from steering wheel (2).
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
1. Steering switches 2. Steering wheel 3. Steering wheel rear finisher
ALOIA0025ZZ
ALOIA0026ZZ
ALOIA0027ZZ
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-614
< REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
DISPLAY UNIT
DISPLAY UNIT
Exploded View INFOID:0000000009174798
Removal and Installation INFOID:0000000009174799
REMOVAL
1. Remove the cluster lid D. Refer to IP-24, "Removal and Installation".
2. Remove the display unit screws, then pull out the display unit and bracket.
3. Disconnect the harness connector from the display unit, then remove the display unit and bracket.
4. Remove the display unit brackets screws and the display unit from the display unit bracket.
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
1. Display unit 2. Display unit bracket A. Display unit bracket screws
ALNIA1429ZZ
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
HEADREST DISPLAY UNIT
AV-615
< REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
HEADREST DISPLAY UNIT
Removal and Installation INFOID:0000000009763248
REMOVAL
CAUTION:
Do not press on the panel surface of display (glass area).
Do not press or pull out the movable part of display.
1. Remove the headrest trim retainer (A).
2. Remove the headrest display harness and upper tube screws
(A), then remove headrest display unit bolts (B).
3. Remove the headrest display escutcheon and headrest display.
a. Insert a suitable tool (A) between lower side of headrest display
escutcheon (1) and headrest trim (2) and pull out lower side of
escutcheon.
b. Pull out headrest display escutcheon (1) to the position that pawl
is visible and disengage pawl.
: Pawl
c. Pull out lower side of headrest display escutcheon from headrest.
JMJIA4069ZZ
JMJIA4070ZZ
JMJIA4071ZZ
AWNIA2554ZZ
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-616
< REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
HEADREST DISPLAY UNIT
CAUTION:
Be careful not to damage pawls on upper side headrest display escutcheon.
d. Pull downward and remove headrest display escutcheon (1) and
headrest display unit (2) by pulling them out and removing pins
on upper side of display.
e. Disconnect inner harness connector.
f. Press headrest display escutcheon to the headrest display unit side. Disconnect pawls on upper side and
remove headrest display escutcheon.
4. Remove the headrest display harness upper tube from headrest trim.
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
JMJIA4233ZZ
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
BOSE SPEAKER AMP
AV-617
< REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
BOSE SPEAKER AMP
Removal and Installation INFOID:0000000009763249
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect the negative battery terminal. Refer to PG-90, "Removal and Installation"
2. Remove third row seat. Refer to SE-107, "Removal and Installation".
3. Remove Bose speaker amp screws (A).
4. Disconnect the harness connectors (B) from the Bose speaker
amp. and remove.
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
ALNIA0918ZZ
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-618
< REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
FRONT DOOR SPEAKER
FRONT DOOR SPEAKER
Exploded View INFOID:0000000009763252
Removal and Installation INFOID:0000000009763251
REMOVAL
1. Remove the front door finisher. Refer to INT-15, "Removal and Installation".
2. Remove the front door speaker bolts.
3. Pull out the front door speaker from the speaker bracket.
4. Disconnect the harness connector from front door speaker and remove.
5. Remove the speaker bracket bolts and the speaker bracket from front door (if necessary).
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
ALNIA1329ZZ
1. Speaker bracket bolt 2. Front door speaker 3. Speaker bolt
4. Speaker bracket
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
FRONT TWEETER
AV-619
< REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
FRONT TWEETER
Removal and Installation INFOID:0000000009763254
REMOVAL
1. Remove the front pillar finisher (1). Refer to INT-19, "FRONT
PILLAR FINISHER : Removal and Installation"
2. Remove the two screws and the front tweeter (2).
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
JSNIA3786ZZ
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-620
< REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
INSTRUMENT PANEL SPEAKER/TWEETER
INSTRUMENT PANEL SPEAKER/TWEETER
Removal and Installation INFOID:0000000009763255
REMOVAL
1. Remove instrument panel tweeter grille. Refer to IP-14, "Exploded View".
2. Remove the bolts (A), then pull out the instrument panel tweeter
(1).
3. Disconnect the harness connector from the instrument panel
tweeter (1) and remove.
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
ALNIA1423ZZ
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
CENTER SPEAKER
AV-621
< REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
CENTER SPEAKER
Removal and Installation INFOID:0000000009763257
REMOVAL
1. Remove center speaker grille. Refer to IP-14, "Exploded View".
2. Remove the center speaker bolts (A).
3. Pull out the center speaker (1).
4. Disconnect the harness connector from the center speaker and
remove.
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
ALNIA1196ZZ
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-622
< REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
REAR DOOR SPEAKER
REAR DOOR SPEAKER
Exploded View INFOID:0000000009763259
Removal and Installation INFOID:0000000009763258
REMOVAL
1. Remove the rear door finisher. Refer to INT-17, "Removal and Installation".
2. Remove the rear door speaker bolts.
3. Disconnect the harness connector from the rear door speaker and remove.
4. Remove the speaker bracket bolts and the speaker bracket from the rear door (if necessary).
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
1. Speaker bracket bolt 2. Rear door speaker 3. Speaker bolt
4. Speaker bracket
ALNIA1330ZZ
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
REAR SPEAKERS
AV-623
< REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
REAR SPEAKERS
Removal and Installation INFOID:0000000009763260
REMOVAL
1. Remove the luggage side lower finisher. Refer to INT-31, "LUGGAGE SIDE LOWER FINISHER :
Removal and Installation".
2. Remove rear side speaker screws (A), then remove the rear
side and grille assembly (1) from the luggage side lower finisher.
3. Remove the screws (B) from the rear side speaker grille, then
remove the rear side speaker (2).
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
ALNIA1428ZZ
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-624
< REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
SUBWOOFER
SUBWOOFER
Exploded View INFOID:0000000009763262
Removal and Installation INFOID:0000000009763261
REMOVAL
1. Open the storage box lid.
2. Remove the spare tire clamp.
3. Lift subwoofer to disconnect the harness connector and remove.
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
ALNIA1328ZZ
1. Spare tire clamp 2. Subwoofer 3. Harness
4. Bracket 5. Rear storage box
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
USB INTERFACE
AV-625
< REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
USB INTERFACE
Removal and Installation INFOID:0000000009763263
REMOVAL
1. Remove shift selector finisher. Refer to IP-18, "Exploded View".
2. Disconnect the harness connector from the USB interface.
3. Release the pawl from the back of USB interface, then remove USB interface.
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-626
< REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
FRONT AUXILIARY INPUT JACKS
FRONT AUXILIARY INPUT JACKS
Removal and Installation INFOID:0000000009763264
REMOVAL
1. Remove shift selector finisher. Refer to IP-18, "Exploded View".
2. Disconnect the harness connector from the front auxiliary input jack.
3. Remove front auxiliary input jack screws and the front auxiliary input jack.
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
MICROPHONE
AV-627
< REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
MICROPHONE
Removal and Installation INFOID:0000000009763265
REMOVAL
1. Remove the front room/map lamp assembly. Refer to INL-58, "Removal and Installation".
2. Remove the microphone (1) from the front room/map lamp
assembly.
CAUTION:
Carefully handle the pawls that retain the microphone to
avoid damaging.
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
NOTE:
Make sure the microphone is firmly secure after installation.
AWNIA2584ZZ
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-628
< REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
AROUND VIEW MONITOR CONTROL UNIT
AROUND VIEW MONITOR CONTROL UNIT
Exploded View INFOID:0000000009174815
Removal and Installation INFOID:0000000009174816
REMOVAL
1. Remove the center console. Refer to IP-18, "Removal and Installation".
2. Remove the around view monitor control unit screws.
3. Disconnect the harness connector from around view monitor control unit and remove.
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
ALNIA1332ZZ
1. Bracket 2. Around view monitor control unit 3. Screw
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
FRONT CAMERA
AV-629
< REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
FRONT CAMERA
Removal and Installation INFOID:0000000009174817
REMOVAL
1. Remove the front grille. Refer to EXT-23, "Removal and Installation".
2. Release the emblem pawls and remove.
: Pawl
3. Remove the front camera screws (A) and the front camera (1)
from the front grille.
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
ALNIA1426ZZ
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-630
< REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
REAR VIEW CAMERA
REAR VIEW CAMERA
Removal and Installation INFOID:0000000009763266
REMOVAL
1. Remove the back door outer finisher. Refer to EXT-43, "Removal and Installation".
2. Remove rear view camera screws (A), then remove rear view
camera (1) from the back door outer finisher (2).
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
ALNIA1427ZZ
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
SIDE CAMERA
AV-631
< REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
SIDE CAMERA
Removal and Installation INFOID:0000000009174819
REMOVAL
1. Remove the door mirror. Refer to MIR-17, "Removal and Installation".
2. Remove the door mirror rear finisher. Refer to MIR-19, "Removal and Installation".
3. Release the side camera finisher pawls using a suitable tool,
disconnect the harness connector from the side camera, then
remove the side camera finisher.
: Pawl
4. Remove the screws (1) and the side camera (2).
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
ALLIA1121ZZ
AWNIA2558ZZ
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-632
< REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
VIDEO DISTRIBUTOR
VIDEO DISTRIBUTOR
Removal and Installation INFOID:0000000009174820
REMOVAL
1. Remove the luggage side lower finisher (LH). Refer to INT-31, "LUGGAGE SIDE LOWER FINISHER :
Removal and Installation".
2. Disconnect the video distributor harness connectors (A).
3. Remove the video distributor nut (2) and bolts (4).
4. Remove the video distributor (3) and brackets (1, 5) from the
vehicle as a single unit.
5. Remove screws (B, C), then remove video distributor (3).
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
AWNIA3156ZZ
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
REAR AUXILIARY INPUT JACKS
AV-633
< REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
REAR AUXILIARY INPUT JACKS
Removal and Installation INFOID:0000000009174821
REMOVAL
1. Remove rear center ventilator duct. Refer to VTL-12, "REAR CENTER VENTILATOR DUCT : Removal
and Installation".
2. Remove rear auxiliary input jack screws and the rear auxiliary input jack.
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-634
< REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
AUDIO ANTENNA
AUDIO ANTENNA
Location of Antennas INFOID:0000000009174822
Window Antenna Repair INFOID:0000000009174823
ELEMENT CHECK
1. Attach probe circuit tester (ohm setting) to antenna terminal on
each side.
1. Antenna base (satellite antenna and antenna
amp)
2. M502 3. M501
4. M503, M504 5. M505 6. Antenna Feeder
7. M95, M151, M500, M509 8. AV control unit M155, M156
AWNIA2589ZZ
SEL250I
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
AUDIO ANTENNA
AV-635
< REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
When measuring continuity, wrap tin foil around the top of
probe. Then, press the foil against the wire with your finger.
2. If an element is broken, no continuity will exist.
3. To locate a break, move probe along element. Tester indication
will change abruptly when probe passes the broken point.
SEL122R
SEL252I
SEL253I
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-636
< REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
GPS ANTENNA
GPS ANTENNA
Removal and Installation INFOID:0000000009174824
REMOVAL
1. Remove the combination meter. Refer to MWI-82, "Removal and Installation".
2. Disconnect the harness connector from AV control unit.
3. Release the harness feeder clips.
4. Remove GPS antenna screw and the GPS antenna (1).
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
AWNIA2586ZZ
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV
SATELLITE RADIO ANTENNA
AV-637
< REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
B
A
O
P
SATELLITE RADIO ANTENNA
Removal and Installation INFOID:0000000009763984
REMOVAL
1. Lower headlining (rear). Refer to INT-27, "Removal and Installation".
2. Disconnect harness connector from antenna feeder.
3. Remove nut from satellite antenna (1) and remove.
: Front
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
CAUTION:
If the satellite antenna nut is not tightened to the specified torque, lower sensitivity of the antenna may
be experienced. If the nut is tightened tighter than the specified torque, this will deform the roof panel.
Disassembly and Assembly INFOID:0000000009763983
DISASSEMBLY
Insert a suitable tool into gaps between satellite antenna (2) and the
cover (1), then remove the cover (1) from satellite antenna (2).
ASSEMBLY
Assembly is in the reverse order of disassembly.
AWNIA2587ZZ
ALNIA1335ZZ
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder
AV-638
< REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION >
[PREMIUM AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION]
SATELLITE RADIO ANTENNA
Revision: May 2013 2014 Pathfinder